JEE Main Online Question Papers & Answer Keys (2014-2017)
JEE Main Online Question Papers & Answer Keys (2014-2017)
JEE Main Online Question Papers & Answer Keys (2014-2017)
(2) 120 s
(1) 110 s
(3) 10 2 s
(3) 10 2 s
(4) 15 s
1 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
3. Two particles A and B of equal mass M 3. ‚◊ÊŸ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ M ∑§ ŒÊ ∑§áÊ A ÃÕÊ B ‚◊ÊŸ
are moving with the same speed v as
øÊ‹ v ‚ ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U ø‹ ⁄U„ „Ò¥– fl„ ¬ÍáʸÃÿÊ •¬˝àÿÊSÕ
shown in the figure. They collide
completely inelastically and move as a ‚¥ÉÊ^ ∑§⁄Uà „Ò¥ ÃÕÊ ‚¥ÉÊ^ ∑§ ’ÊŒ ∞∑§ ∑§áÊ C ∑§Ë Ã⁄U„
single particle C. The angle θ that the path ø‹Ã „Ò¥– ∑§ÊáÊ θ, ¡Ê ∑§áÊ C ∑§Ê ¬Õ X-•ˇÊ ‚
of C makes with the X-axis is given by : ’ŸÊÃÊ „Ò, ∑§Ê ÁŸêŸ ‚ê’㜠‚ ÁŒÿÊ ¡ÊÿªÊ —
3+ 2 3+ 2
(1) tan θ= (1) tan θ=
1− 2 1− 2
3− 2 3− 2
(2) tan θ= (2) tan θ=
1− 2 1− 2
1− 2 1− 2
(3) tan θ= (3) tan θ=
2 (1+ 3 ) 2 (1+ 3 )
1− 3 1− 3
(4) tan θ= (4) tan θ=
1+ 2 1+ 2
2 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
4. The machine as shown has 2 rods of length 4. ÁøòÊ ◊¥ ÁŒπÊÿË ªÿË ∞∑§ ◊‡ÊËŸ ∑§Ë ŒÊ ¿U«∏Ê¥, Á¡Ÿ∑§Ë
1 m connected by a pivot at the top. The
‹ê’Ê߸ 1 m „Ò, ∑§ ™§¬⁄UË Á‚⁄UÊ¥ ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ‚ÊÕ œÈ⁄Uʪ˝SÃ
end of one rod is connected to the floor by
a stationary pivot and the end of the other Á∑§ÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ò– ∞∑§ ¿U«∏ ∑§Ê •ÊÁπ⁄UË Á‚⁄UÊ ∞∑§ ÁSÕ⁄U
rod has a roller that rolls along the floor in œÈ⁄UË mÊ⁄UÊ »§‡Ê¸ ‚ ¡Ê«∏Ê ªÿÊ „Ò ÃÕÊ ŒÍ‚⁄UË ¿U«∏ ∑§
a slot. As the roller goes back and forth, •ÊÁπ⁄UË Á‚⁄U ¬⁄U ∞∑§ ⁄UÊ‹⁄U ‹ªÊ „Ò ¡Ê Á∑§ »§‡Ê¸ ¬⁄U
a 2 kg weight moves up and down. If the
roller is moving towards right at a constant
’Ÿ πÊ°ø ◊¥ ø‹ÃÊ „Ò– ¡’ fl„ ⁄UÊ‹⁄U •Êª ¬Ë¿U
speed, the weight moves up with a : ø‹ÃÊ „Ò ÃÊ ∞∑§ 2 kg ∑§Ê ÷Ê⁄U ™§¬⁄U ŸËø ø‹ÃÊ „Ò–
ÿÁŒ ⁄UÊ‹⁄U ŒÊÁ„ŸË ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ ∞∑§ ‚◊ÊŸ øÊ‹ ‚ ø‹ÃÊ
„Ò ÃÊ fl„ ÷Ê⁄U ø‹ªÊ, ∞∑§ —
3 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
5. A conical pendulum of length 1 m makes 5. ∞∑§ ‡ÊÊ¥∑§fl (conical) ŒÊ‹∑§, Á¡‚∑§Ë ‹ê’Ê߸ 1 m
an angle θ=458 w.r.t. Z-axis and moves
„Ò •ÊÒ⁄U ¡Ê Z-•ˇÊ ‚ θ=458 ∑§ ∑§ÊáÊ ¬⁄U „Ò¥, XY
in a circle in the XY plane. The radius of
the circle is 0.4 m and its center is vertically ‚◊Ë ◊¥ ∞∑§ ªÊ‹Ê∑§Ê⁄U ¬Õ ◊¥ ø‹ÃÊ „Ò– ªÊ‹Ê∑§Ê⁄U
below O. The speed of the pendulum, in ¬Õ ∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ 0.4 m „Ò •ÊÒ⁄U ©‚∑§Ê ∑§ãŒ˝ Á’ãŒÈ O
its circular path, will be : (Take g=10 ms−2) ∑§ ∆UË∑§ ŸËø „Ò– ©‚ ŒÊ‹∑§ ∑§Ë ªÁà ªÊ‹Ê∑§Ê⁄U ¬Õ
◊¥ „ÊªË — (g=10 ms−2)
4 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
219 MR 2
(1)
219 MR 2 256
(1)
256
237 MR 2
(2)
237 MR 2 512
(2)
512
19 MR 2
(3)
19 MR 2 512
(3)
512
197 MR 2
(4)
197 MR 2 256
(4)
256
5 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
7. The mass density of a spherical body is 7. ∞∑§ ªÊ‹Ê∑§Ê⁄U Á¬á«U ∑§Ê Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ ÉÊŸàfl „Ò
k
given by ρ (r)= for r ≤ R and k
r ρ (r)= ¡’ r ≤ R ÃÕÊ
ρ (r)=0 for r > R, r
where r is the distance from the centre. ρ (r)=0 ¡’ r > R, ¡„Ê° r ∑§ãŒ˝ ‚ ŒÍ⁄UË „Ò–
The correct graph that describes
qualitatively the acceleration, a, of a test ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ª˝Ê$»§ ∞∑§ ¬⁄UˡÊáÊ ∑§áÊ ∑§ àfl⁄UáÊ
particle as a function of r is :
a ∑§Ê r ∑§ »§‹Ÿ ◊¥ ªÈáÊÊà◊∑§ M§¬ ‚ Œ‡ÊʸÃÊ „Ò?
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
6 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
8. A steel rail of length 5 m and area of cross 8. 5 m ‹ê’Ê߸ ÃÕÊ 40 cm2 •ŸÈ¬˝SÕ ∑§Ê≈U ∑§ ˇÊòÊ»§‹
section 40 cm2 is prevented from expanding
∑§Ë ∞∑§ S≈UË‹ ∑§Ë ¬≈U⁄UË ∑§Ê ‹ê’Ê߸ ∑§ •ŸÈÁŒ‡Ê
along its length while the temperature rises
by 108C. If coefficient of linear expansion ÁflSÃÊ⁄UáÊ ⁄UÊ∑§Ê ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ¡’Á∑§ ©‚∑§Ê Ãʬ◊ÊŸ 108C
and Young’s modulus of steel are ’…∏ÊÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– ÿÁŒ S≈UË‹ ∑§Ê ⁄UπËÿ ¬˝‚Ê⁄U ªÈáÊÊ¥∑§
1.2×10 −5 K −1 and 2×10 11 Nm −2 ÃÕÊ ÿ¥ª ¬˝àÿÊSÕÃÊ ªÈáÊÊ¥∑§ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— 1.2×10−5 K−1
respectively, the force developed in the rail
is approximately :
ÃÕÊ 2×1011 Nm−2 „Ò¥ ÃÊ ¬≈U⁄UË ◊¥ ©à¬ÛÊ ’‹ ∑§Ê
ÁŸ∑§≈UÃ◊ ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
(1) 2×107 N
(2) 1×105 N
(1) 2×107 N
(3) 2×109 N
(2) 1×105 N
(4) 3×10−5 N
(3) 2×109 N
(4) 3×10−5 N
9. Two tubes of radii r1 and r2, and lengths l1
and l2, respectively, are connected in series
and a liquid flows through each of them 9. ŒÊ ŸÁ‹ÿÊ° Á¡Ÿ∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊÿ¥ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— r1 ∞fl¥ r2 ÃÕÊ
in stream line conditions. P1 and P2 are ‹ê’Ê߸ÿÊ°, l1 fl l2 „Ò¥, ∑§Ê üÊáÊË ∑˝§◊ ◊¥ ¡Ê«∏Ê ªÿÊ „Ò
pressure differences across the two tubes.
•ÊÒ⁄U ©Ÿ◊¥ ∞∑§ Œ˝fl œÊ⁄UÊ ⁄UπËÿ ¬˝flÊ„ ◊¥ ’„ÃÊ „Ò–
If P2 is 4P1 and l2 is l 1 , then the radius r2 ¬„‹Ë ÃÕÊ ŒÍ‚⁄UË Ÿ‹Ë ∑§ Á‚⁄UÊ¥ ∑§ ’Ëø ∑§ ŒÊ’ÊãÃ⁄U
4
will be equal to :
∑˝§◊‡Ê— P1 ÃÕÊ P2 „Ò¥– ÿÁŒ P2 ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ 4P1 ÃÕÊ l2
(1) r1 ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ l1 „Ê ÃÊ ÁòÊíÿÊ r2 ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
4
(2) 2r 1
(3) 4r 1
(1) r1
r1 (2) 2r 1
(4)
2 (3) 4r 1
r1
(4)
2
7 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
10. For the P-V diagram given for an ideal gas, 10. ∞∑§ •ÊŒ‡Ê¸ ªÒ‚ ∑§Ê P-V •Ê⁄Uπ ÁŒÿ ªÿ ÁøòÊ ◊¥
Œ‡ÊʸÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ò–
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
8 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
11. N moles of a diatomic gas in a cylinder are 11. ∞∑§ Ám¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ∑§ ªÒ‚ ∑§ N ◊Ê‹ T Ãʬ◊ÊŸ ¬⁄U ∞∑§
at a temperature T. Heat is supplied to
Á‚‹á«U⁄U ◊¥ ’¥Œ „Ò¥– Á‚‹á«U⁄U ◊¥ ™§c◊Ê ß‚ ¬˝∑§Ê⁄U
the cylinder such that the temperature
remains constant but n moles of the ¬˝flÊÁ„à ∑§Ë ¡ÊÃË „Ò Á¡‚‚ ©‚ Ám¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ∑§ ªÒ‚ ∑§
diatomic gas get converted into n ◊Ê‹ ∞∑§¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ∑§ ªÒ‚ ◊¥ Á’ŸÊ Ãʬ◊ÊŸ ’Œ‹
monoatomic gas. What is the change in ¬Á⁄UflÁøà „Ê ¡Êà „Ò¥– ªÒ‚ ∑§Ë ∑ȧ‹ ªÁá ™§¡Ê¸ ◊¥
the total kinetic energy of the gas ?
Á∑§ÃŸÊ ¬Á⁄UfløŸ „ʪÊ?
1
(1) nRT
2
1
(1) nRT
(2) 0 2
3 (2) 0
(3) nRT
2
3
(3) nRT
5 2
(4) nRT
2
5
(4) nRT
2
12. A block of mass 0.1 kg is connected to an
elastic spring of spring constant 640 Nm−1
and oscillates in a damping medium of 12. 0.1 kg Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ ∑§ ∞∑§ ªÈ≈U∑§ ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ¬˝àÿÊSÕ ÁS¬˝¥ª,
damping constant 10 −2 kg s −1 . The Á¡‚∑§Ê ÁS¬˝¥ª ÁŸÿÃÊ¥∑§ 640 Nm−1 „Ò, ‚ ¡Ê«∏Ê ªÿÊ
system dissipates its energy gradually. The „Ò– ÿ„ ªÈ≈U∑§Ê ∞∑§ •fl◊㌟ ◊Êäÿ◊, Á¡‚∑§Ê
time taken for its mechanical energy of
vibration to drop to half of its initial value, •fl◊㌟ ªÈáÊÊ¥∑§ 10−2 kg s−1 „Ò, ◊¥ ŒÊ‹Ÿ ªÁÃ
is closest to : ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– ÿ„ ÁŸ∑§Êÿ œË⁄U-œË⁄U •¬ŸË ™§¡Ê¸ •¬√ÿÁÃÃ
(1) 2s ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– ÁŸ∑§Êÿ ∑§ ŒÊ‹Ÿ ∑§Ë ÿÊ¥ÁòÊ∑§ ™§¡Ê¸ ∑§Ê
(2) 3.5 s ©‚∑§ •Ê⁄UÁê÷∑§ ◊ÊŸ ‚ •ÊœÊ „ÊŸ ◊¥ ‹ªŸ flÊ‹
‚◊ÿ ∑§Ê ÁŸ∑§≈UÃ◊ ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
(3) 5s
(1) 2s
(4) 7s
(2) 3.5 s
(3) 5s
(4) 7s
9 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
13. A standing wave is formed by the 13. ŒÊ Ã⁄¥Uª¥, ¡Ê Áfl¬⁄UËà ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ ø‹ ⁄U„Ë „Ò¥, ∑§ •äÿÊ⁄UʬáÊ
superposition of two waves travelling in
‚ ∞∑§ •¬˝ªÊ◊Ë Ã⁄¥Uª ’ŸÃË „Ò Á¡‚∑§Ê •ŸÈ¬˝SÕ
opposite directions. The transverse
displacement is given by ÁflSÕʬŸ ÁŸêŸ ‚◊Ë∑§⁄UáÊ mÊ⁄UÊ Á‹πÊ ¡Ê ‚∑§ÃÊ „Ò
10 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
14. Four closed surfaces and corresponding 14. øÊ⁄U ’¥Œ ¬Îc∆U ÃÕÊ ©Ÿ∑§ •Êfl‡Ê ÁflãÿÊ‚ ∑§Ê ÁŸêŸ
charge distributions are shown below. ÁøòÊ ◊¥ Œ‡ÊʸÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ò–
Let the respective electric fluxes through ÿÁŒ ©Ÿ∑ § ¬Î c ∆U ‚ ’h flÒ l È Ã ç‹Ä‚ ∑˝ § ◊‡Ê—
the surfaces be Φ1, Φ2, Φ3 and Φ4. Then :
Φ1, Φ2, Φ3 ÃÕÊ Φ4 „Ê¥ ÃÊ —
(1) Φ1 < Φ2=Φ3 > Φ4
(1) Φ1 < Φ2=Φ3 > Φ4
(2) Φ1 > Φ2 > Φ3 > Φ4
(2) Φ1 > Φ2 > Φ3 > Φ4
(3) Φ1=Φ2=Φ3=Φ4
(3) Φ1=Φ2=Φ3=Φ4
(4) Φ1 > Φ3 ; Φ2 < Φ4
(4) Φ1 > Φ3 ; Φ2 < Φ4
11 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
15. A combination of parallel plate capacitors 15. ‚◊ÊãÃ⁄U å‹≈U ‚¥œÊÁ⁄UòÊÊ¥ ∑§ ∞∑§ ‚¥ÿÊ¡Ÿ ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ÁŸÁ‡øÃ
is maintained at a certain potential
Áfl÷flÊãÃ⁄U ¬⁄U ⁄UπÊ ªÿÊ „Ò– (ÁøòÊ ŒÁπÿ)
difference.
When a 3 mm thick slab is introduced ¡’ 3 mm ◊Ê≈U ªÈ≈U∑§ ∑§Ê ‚÷Ë ‚¥œÊÁ⁄UòÊÊ¥ ∑§Ë å‹≈UÊ¥
between all the plates, in order to maintain ∑§ ’Ëø «UÊ‹Ê ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò, ÃÊ fl„Ë Áfl÷flÊãÃ⁄U ’ŸÊÿ ⁄UπŸ
the same potential difference, the distance ∑§ Á‹∞ å‹≈UÊ¥ ∑§ ’Ëø ∑§Ë ŒÍ⁄UË ∑§Ê 2.4 mm ‚ ’…∏ÊŸÊ
between the plates is increased by 2.4 mm.
Find the dielectric constant of the slab.
¬«∏ÃÊ „Ò– ªÈ≈U∑§ ∑§Ê ¬⁄UÊflÒlÈÃÊ¥∑§ „ÊªÊ —
(1) 3
(1) 3
(2) 4
(2) 4
(3) 5
(3) 5
(4) 6
(4) 6
12 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
17. The figure shows three circuits I, II and III 17. ÁŒÿ ªÿ ÁøòÊ ◊¥ ÃËŸ ¬Á⁄U¬Õ, I, II ∞fl¥ III ∑§Ê ∞∑§
which are connected to a 3V battery. If
3V ’Ò≈U⁄UË ‚ ¡Ê«∏Ê ªÿÊ „Ò– ÿÁŒ ÁflãÿÊ‚ I, II ÃÕÊ III
the powers dissipated by the configurations
I, II and III are P1, P2 and P3 respectively, ∑˝§◊‡Ê— P1, P2 ÃÕÊ P3 ‡ÊÁÄà •¬√ÿÿ ∑§⁄Uà „Ò¥ ÃÊ —
then :
13 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
19. A uniform magnetic field B of 0.3 T is along 19. 0.3 T ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ‚◊ÊŸ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ B œŸÊà◊∑§
the positive Z-direction. A rectangular
Z-•ˇÊ ∑§Ë Ã⁄U»§ ÁŒÁ‡Êà „Ò– ∞∑§ 10 cm ÃÕÊ 5 cm
loop (abcd) of sides 10 cm×5 cm carries a
current I of 12 A. Out of the following ÷È¡Ê•Ê¥ flÊ‹ •ÊÿÃÊ∑§Ê⁄U ¬Ê‡Ê (abcd) ◊¥ 12 A œÊ⁄UÊ
different orientations which one I ’„ÃË „Ò– ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ-‚Ê ÁŒª˜ÁflãÿÊ‚ ÁSÕ⁄U
corresponds to stable equilibrium ? ‚ÊêÿÊflSÕÊ ∑§Ê ¬˝ŒÁ‡Ê¸Ã ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò?
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
14 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
20. A sinusoidal voltage of peak value 283 V 20. 283 V ◊„ûÊ◊ Áfl÷fl ÃÕÊ 320 s−1 ∑§ÊáÊËÿ •ÊflÎÁûÊ
and angular frequency 320/s is applied to
flÊ‹ ∞∑§ íÿÊfl∑˝§Ëÿ Áfl÷fl ∑§Ê ∞∑§ üÊáÊË LCR ¬Á⁄U¬Õ
a series LCR circuit. Given that R=5 Ω,
L=25 mH and C=1000 µF. The total ◊¥ ‹ªÊÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ò– ÁŒÿÊ „Ò R=5 Ω, L=25 mH
impedance, and phase difference between •ÊÒ⁄U C=1000 µF– ¬Á⁄U¬Õ ∑§Ë ∑ȧ‹ ¬˝ÁÃ’ÊœÊ ÃÕÊ
the voltage across the source and the dÊà Áfl÷fl ∞fl¥ œÊ⁄UÊ ∑§ ’Ëø ∑§‹Ê¥Ã⁄U ∑˝§◊‡Ê— „ÊªÊ —
current will respectively be :
−1 5
(1) 10 Ω and tan
3
tan−1
5
(2) 7 Ω and 458
(1) 10 Ω •ÊÒ⁄U
3
2 E0 ∧ →
(1) j sin kz cos ωt ©‚∑§ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ B ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
c
2 E0 ∧
2 E0 ∧ (1) j sin kz cos ωt
(2) − j sin kz sin ωt c
c
2 E0 ∧
2 E0 ∧ (2) − j sin kz sin ωt
(3) j sin kz sin ωt c
c
2 E0 ∧
2 E0 ∧ (3) j sin kz sin ωt
(4) j cos kz cos ωt c
c
2 E0 ∧
(4) j cos kz cos ωt
c
15 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
22. In an experiment a convex lens of focal 22. ∞∑§ ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§ ŒÊÒ⁄UÊŸ, 15 cm »§Ê∑§‚ ŒÍ⁄UË ∑§ ∞∑§
length 15 cm is placed coaxially on an
©ûÊ‹ ‹¥‚ ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ¬˝∑§Ê‡Ê ’¥ø ¬⁄U ∞∑§ ©ûÊ‹ Œ¬¸áÊ
optical bench in front of a convex mirror
at a distance of 5 cm from it. It is found ∑§ ‚Ê◊Ÿ 5 cm ŒÍ⁄UË ¬⁄U ‚◊ÊˇÊËÿ ÁSÕÁà ◊¥ ⁄UπÊ ªÿÊ
that an object and its image coincide, if „Ò– ÿÁŒ flSÃÈ ∑§Ê ‹¥‚ ‚ 20 cm ∑§Ë ŒÍ⁄UË ¬⁄U ⁄UπÊ
the object is placed at a distance of 20 cm ¡Êÿ ÃÊ flSÃÈ ÃÕÊ ©‚∑§Ê ¬˝ÁÃÁ’ê’ ‚¥¬ÊÃË „Ê ¡Êà „Ò¥–
from the lens. The focal length of the
convex mirror is :
©ûÊ‹ Œ¬¸áÊ ∑§Ë »§Ê∑§‚ ŒÍ⁄UË „ÊªË —
(1) 27.5 cm
(2) 20.0 cm (1) 27.5 cm
(3) 25.0 cm (2) 20.0 cm
(4) 30.5 cm (3) 25.0 cm
(4) 30.5 cm
23. A single slit of width 0.1 mm is illuminated
by a parallel beam of light of wavelength
6000 Å and diffraction bands are observed 23. 0.1 mm øÊÒ«∏Ê߸ ∑§Ë ∞∑§ Á¤Ê⁄UË 6000 Å Ã⁄¥UªŒÒÉÿ¸ ∑§
on a screen 0.5 m from the slit. The ‚◊ÊãÃ⁄U Á∑§⁄UáÊ ¬È¥¡ ‚ ¬˝∑§ÊÁ‡Êà ∑§Ë ¡ÊÃË „Ò •ÊÒ⁄U
distance of the third dark band from the ÁflfløŸ ’Òá«U ∑§Ê Á¤Ê⁄UË ‚ 0.5 m ŒÍ⁄U ÁSÕà ¬Œ¸ ¬⁄U
central bright band is :
ŒπÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– ÃÎÃËÿ •ŒËåà ’Òá«U ∑§Ë ∑§ãŒ˝Ëÿ ŒËåÃ
(1) 3 mm
’Òá«U ‚ ŒÍ⁄UË „ÊªË —
(2) 9 mm
(3) 4.5 mm (1) 3 mm
(4) 1.5 mm (2) 9 mm
(3) 4.5 mm
24. A Laser light of wavelength 660 nm is used (4) 1.5 mm
to weld Retina detachment. If a Laser
pulse of width 60 ms and power 0.5 kW is
used the approximate number of photons 24. 660 nm Ã⁄¥UªŒÒÉÿ¸ ∑§Ë ∞∑§ ‹$¡⁄U ‹Êß≈U ∑§Ê ⁄UÁ≈UŸÊ
in the pulse are :
ÁflÿÊ¡Ÿ ∑§Ê ¡Ê«∏Ÿ ∑§ Á‹∞ ¬˝ÿʪ Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò–
[Take Planck’s constant h=6.62×10−34 Js]
ÿÁŒ 60 ms øÊÒ«∏Ê߸ ∞fl¥ 0.5 kW ‡ÊÁÄà ∑§ ‹$¡⁄U
(1) 10 20
S¬ãŒ (pulse) ∑§Ê ¬˝ÿʪ Á∑§ÿÊ ¡Êÿ ÃÊ ©‚ S¬ãŒ ◊¥
(2) 10 18
»§Ê≈UÊÚŸÊ¥ ∑§Ë ‚¥ÅÿÊ ‹ª÷ª „ÊªË —
(3) 10 22 [å‹Ê¥∑§ ÁŸÿÃÊ¥∑§ h=6.62×10−34 Js]
(4) 10 19 (1) 10 20
(2) 10 18
(3) 10 22
(4) 10 19
16 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
25. The acceleration of an electron in the first 25. „Êß«˛UÊ¡Ÿ ¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ ∑§Ë ¬˝Õ◊ ∑§ˇÊÊ (n=1) ∑§ ß‹Ä≈˛UÊÚŸ
orbit of the hydrogen atom (n=1) is :
∑§Ê àfl⁄UáÊ „ÊªÊ —
h2
(1) h2
2
π m r 2 3 (1)
π2 m 2 r 3
h2
(2) h2
8π m r2 2 3 (2)
8π 2 m 2 r 3
h2
(3) h2
4π m r2 2 3 (3)
4π 2 m 2 r 3
h2
(4) h2
4πm r 2 3 (4)
4πm 2 r 3
17 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
28. A signal is to be transmitted through a 28. Ã⁄¥UªŒÒÉÿ¸ λ ∑§Ë Ã⁄¥Uª mÊ⁄UÊ ∞∑§ ‚¥Œ‡Ê ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ∞∑§⁄UπËÿ
wave of wavelength λ, using a linear
∞ã≈UŸÊ ‚ ¬˝‚ÊÁ⁄Uà ∑§⁄UŸÊ „Ò– ∞ã≈UŸÊ ∑§Ë ‹ê’Ê߸ l ÃÕÊ
antenna. The length l of the antenna and
effective power radiated Peff will be given ¬˝ ÷ ÊflË ©à‚Á¡¸ à ‡ÊÁÄà P eff ∑§Ê ∑˝ § ◊‡Ê— ◊ÊŸ
respectively as : „ÊªÊ —
(K is a constant of proportionality) ( K ‚◊ÊŸÈ ¬ ÊÁÃ∑§ ÁSÕ⁄U Ê ¥ ∑ § (constant of
2 proportionality) „Ò)
λ , Peff = K
l
(1)
λ 2
λ , Peff = K
l
(1)
λ
, Peff = K
λ l
(2)
8 λ
, Peff = K
λ l
(2)
3 8 λ
, Peff = K
λ l
(3)
16 λ 3
, Peff = K
λ l
(3)
1 16 λ
, Peff = K
(4)
λ l 2
5 λ 1
, Peff = K
(4)
λ l 2
5 λ
18 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
29. In a meter bridge experiment resistances 29. Á∑§‚Ë ◊Ë≈U⁄U ‚ÃÈ ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§ ŒÊÒ⁄UÊŸ, ¬˝ÁÃ⁄Uʜʥ ∑§Ê ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U
are connected as shown in the figure.
¡Ê«∏Ê ªÿÊ „Ò– ‡ÊÈM§ ◊¥ ¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ P=4 Ω ÃÕÊ Ÿ‹
Initially resistance P=4 Ω and the neutral
point N is at 60 cm from A. Now an Á’ãŒÈ N, Á’ãŒÈ A ‚, 60 cm ∑§Ë ŒÍ⁄UË ¬⁄U „Ò– ∞∑§
unknown resistance R is connected in series •ôÊÊà ¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ R ∑§Ê P ∑§ ‚ÊÕ üÊáÊË ∑˝§◊ ◊¥ ¡Ê«∏Ê
to P and the new position of the neutral ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò Á¡‚‚ Ÿ‹ Á’ãŒÈ ∑§Ë Ÿß¸ ÁSÕÁà Á’¥ŒÈ A ‚
point is at 80 cm from A. The value of
80 cm ŒÍ⁄U „Ê ¡ÊÃË „Ò– •ôÊÊà ¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ R ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ
unknown resistance R is :
„ÊªÊ —
33
(1) Ω 33
5 (1) Ω
5
(2) 6Ω
(2) 6Ω
(3) 7Ω
(3) 7Ω
20
(4) Ω 20
3 (4) Ω
3
19 IX - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
30. In an experiment to determine the period 30. ∞∑§ ¬˝ÿʪ ◊¥, 1 m ‹ê’Ê߸ ∑§Ë ∞∑§ ‚⁄U‹ ŒÊ‹∑§ ∑§Ê
of a simple pendulum of length 1 m, it is
•Êflø ∑§Ê‹ ÁŸ∑§Ê‹Ÿ „ÃÈ ©‚∑§Ê r1 ÃÕÊ r2 ÁòÊíÿÊ•Ê¥
attached to different spherical bobs of radii
r1 and r2. The two spherical bobs have ∑§ •‹ª-•‹ª ªÊ‹Ê∑§Ê⁄U ‹Ê‹∑§ ‚ ¡Ê«∏Ê ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò–
uniform mass distribution. If the relative ŒÊŸÊ¥ ªÊ‹Ê∑§Ê⁄U ‹Ê‹∑§Ê¥ ∑§ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ ÁflÃ⁄UáÊ ∞∑§ ‚◊ÊŸ
difference in the periods, is found to be „Ò¥– ÿÁŒ •Êflø∑§Ê‹Ê¥ ∑§Ê ‚ʬˇÊ •¥Ã⁄U 5×10−4 s
5×10−4 s, the difference in radii, ?r1−r2?
is best given by :
¬ÊÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ê ÃÊ ©Ÿ∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ•Ê ¥ ◊ ¥ •ãÃ⁄U ,
?r1−r2? ∑§Ê ÁŸ∑§≈UÃ◊ ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
(1) 1 cm
(2) 0.1 cm
(3) 0.5 cm
(1) 1 cm
(4) 0.01 cm
(2) 0.1 cm
(3) 0.5 cm
-o0o-
(4) 0.01 cm
-o0o-
20 IX - PHYSICS
JEE Main 2017 Official Question Paper 1 - Chemistry, April 9
(English+Hindi)
1 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
4. At 300 K, the density of a certain gaseous 4. 300 K ¬⁄U; 2 ’Ê⁄U ¬⁄U ⁄Uπ Á∑§‚Ë ªÒ‚Ëÿ •áÊÈ ∑§Ê
molecule at 2 bar is double to that of
ÉÊãÊàfl, 4 ’Ê⁄U ¬⁄U ⁄Uπ «UÊߟÊß≈˛UÊ¡Ÿ (N2) ∑§ ÉÊŸàfl
dinitrogen (N2) at 4 bar. The molar mass
of gaseous molecule is : ∑§Ê ŒÍŸÊ „Ò– ªÒ‚Ëÿ •áÊÈ ∑§Ê ◊Ê‹⁄U Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ „Ò —
(1) 28 g mol−1
(1) 28 g mol−1
(2) 56 g mol−1
(2) 56 g mol−1
(3) 112 g mol−1
(3) 112 g mol−1
(4) 224 g mol−1
(4) 224 g mol−1
2 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
7. A gas undergoes change from state A to 7. ∞∑§ ªÒ‚ •flSÕÊ A ‚ •flSÕÊ B ∑§Ê ¡ÊÃË „Ò– ß‚
state B. In this process, the heat absorbed
¬˝∑˝§◊ ◊¥, ªÒ‚ mÊ⁄UÊ ‡ÊÊÁ·Ã ™§c◊Ê ÃÕÊ Á∑§ÿÊ ªÿÊ ∑§Êÿ¸
and work done by the gas is 5 J and 8 J,
respectively. Now gas is brought back to ∑˝§◊‡Ê— 5 J ÃÕÊ 8 J „Ò¥– •’ ªÒ‚ ∑§Ê ŒÍ‚⁄U ¬˝∑˝§◊
A by another process during which 3 J of mÊ⁄UÊ ¬ÈŸ— A •flSÕÊ ◊¥ ‹Êà „Ò¥ ß‚◊¥ 3 J ™§c◊Ê
heat is evolved. In this reverse process of ÁŸ∑§‹ÃË „Ò– B ‚ A ∑§ ß‚ ©À≈U ¬˝∑˝§◊ ◊¥ —
B to A :
(1) 10 J of the work will be done by the
gas.
(2) 6 J of the work will be done by the (1) ªÒ‚ mÊ⁄UÊ 10 J ∑§Êÿ¸ Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÿªÊ–
gas.
(3) 10 J of the work will be done by the (2) ªÒ‚ mÊ⁄UÊ 6 J ∑§Êÿ¸ Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÿªÊ–
surrounding on gas.
(4) 6 J of the work will be done by the (3) ªÒ‚ ¬⁄U ¬Á⁄Ufl‡Ê mÊ⁄UÊ Á∑§ÿÊ ªÿÊ ∑§Êÿ¸ 10 J
surrounding on gas.
„ʪʖ
(4) ªÒ‚ ¬⁄U ¬Á⁄Ufl‡Ê mÊ⁄UÊ Á∑§ÿÊ ªÿÊ ∑§Êÿ¸ 6 J „ʪʖ
8. Adsorption of a gas on a surface follows
Freundlich adsorption isotherm. Plot of
x
log versus log p gives a straight line
m 8. Á∑§‚Ë ¬Îc∆U ¬⁄U ∞∑§ ªÒ‚ ∑§Ê •Áœ‡ÊÊ·áÊ, »˝§ÊÚÿã«UÁ‹∑§
with slope equal to 0.5, then : •Áœ‡ÊÊ·áÊ ‚◊Ãʬ ∑§Ê •ŸÈ∑§⁄UáÊ ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– log p
x x
( is the mass of the gas adsorbed per ∑§ ÁflL§h log ∑§Ê å‹Ê≈U ∞∑§ ‚⁄U‹ ⁄UπÊ ŒÃÊ „Ò–
m m
gram of adsorbent)
Á¡‚∑§Ê S‹Ê¬ 0.5 ∑§ ’⁄UÊ’⁄U ¬ÊÿÊ ªÿÊ, Ã’ —
(1) Adsorption is independent of x
pressure.
( m , ¬˝Áà ª˝Ê◊ •Áœ‡ÊÊ·∑§ mÊ⁄UÊ •Áœ‡ÊÊÁ·Ã ªÒ‚ ∑§Ê
(2) Adsorption is proportional to the Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ „Ò)
pressure.
(1) •Áœ‡ÊÊ·áÊ, ŒÊ’ ¬⁄U •ÊÁüÊà Ÿ„Ë¥ „Ò–
(3) Adsorption is proportional to the
square root of pressure.
(2) •Áœ‡ÊÊ·áÊ, ŒÊ’ ∑§ ‚◊ʟȬÊÃË „Ò–
(4) Adsorption is proportional to the
square of pressure.
(3) •Áœ‡ÊÊ·áÊ, ŒÊ’ ∑§ flª¸◊Í‹ ∑§ ‚◊ʟȬÊÃË „Ò–
3 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
9. The rate of a reaction quadruples when 9. Ãʬ 300 ‚ 310 K ¬Á⁄UflÁøà „ÊŸ ◊¥ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ë
the temperature changes from 300 to
Œ⁄U øÊ⁄U ªÈŸÊ „Ê ¡ÊÃË „Ò– ß‚ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ë ‚Á∑˝§ÿáÊ
310 K. The activation energy of this
reaction is : ™§¡Ê¸ „Ò :
(Assume activation energy and pre- (ÿ„ ◊ÊŸ ∑§⁄U øÁ‹ÿ Á∑§ ‚Á∑˝§ÿáÊ ™§¡Ê¸ ÃÕÊ
exponential factor are independent of ¬˝Ë∞Ä‚¬ÊŸÁã‡Êÿ‹ »Ò§Ä≈U⁄U Ãʬ ¬⁄U ÁŸ÷¸⁄U Ÿ„Ë¥ „Ò;
temperature; ln 2=0.693; R=8.314 J
ln 2=0.693; R=8.314 J mol−1 K−1)
mol−1 K−1)
(1) 107.2 kJ mol−1
(2) 53.6 kJ mol−1
(1) 107.2 kJ mol−1
(3) 26.8 kJ mol−1
(2) 53.6 kJ mol−1
(4) 214.4 kJ mol−1
(3) 26.8 kJ mol−1
(4) 214.4 kJ mol−1
10. A solution is prepared by mixing 8.5 g of
CH2Cl2 and 11.95 g of CHCl3. If vapour
pressure of CH2Cl2 and CHCl3 at 298 K 10. 8.5 g CH2Cl2 ÃÕÊ 11.95 g CHCl3 ∑§Ê Á◊‹Ê∑§⁄U
are 415 and 200 mmHg respectively, the ∞∑§ Áfl‹ÿŸ ÃÒÿÊ⁄U Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– ÿÁŒ 298 K ¬⁄U
mole fraction of CHCl3 in vapour form is :
(Molar mass of Cl=35.5 g mol−1) CH2Cl2 ÃÕÊ CHCl3 ∑§ flÊc¬ ŒÊ’ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— 415
ÃÕÊ 200 mmHg „Ê ÃÊ flÊc¬ M§¬ ◊¥ ©¬ÁSÕÃ
(1) 0.162 CHCl3 ∑§Ê ◊Ê‹ •¥‡Ê „Ò —
4 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
12. The following reaction occurs in the Blast 12. flÊàÿÊ÷^Ë (é‹ÊS≈U »§⁄UŸ‡Ê) ◊¥ ÁŸêŸ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ „ÊÃË
Furnace where iron ore is reduced to iron
„Ò Á¡‚◊¥ •Êÿ⁄UŸ •ÿS∑§ •¬øÁÿà „Ê∑§⁄U •Êÿ⁄UŸ
metal :
œÊÃÈ ’ŸÃÊ „Ò;
Fe2O3(s)+3 CO(g) ⇌ 2 Fe(l)+3 CO2(g)
Fe2O3(s)+3 CO(g) ⇌ 2 Fe(l)+3 CO2(g)
Using the Le Chatelier’s principle, predict
which one of the following will not disturb ‹-‡ÊÊÃÒÁ‹∞ Á‚hÊãà ∑§Ê ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§⁄U∑§ ¬˝ÊªÈÁÄà ∑§ËÁ¡∞
the equilibrium ? Á∑§ ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ∞∑§ ‚Êêÿ ∑§Ê ¬˝÷ÊÁflà Ÿ„Ë¥
(1) Removal of CO ∑§⁄UªÊ?
(2) Removal of CO2 (1) CO ∑§Ê ÁŸ∑§Ê‹ ∑§⁄U „≈UÊ ŒŸÊ
(3) Addition of CO2
(2) CO2 ∑§Ê ÁŸ∑§Ê‹ ∑§⁄U „≈UÊ ŒŸÊ
(4) Addition of Fe2O3
(3) CO2 ∑§Ê Á◊‹Ê ŒŸÊ
13. Which one of the following is an oxide ? (4) Fe2O3 ∑§Ê Á◊‹Ê ŒŸÊ
(1) KO2
(2) BaO 2 13. ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ∞∑§, •ÊÚÄ‚Êß«U „Ò?
(3) SiO2 (1) KO2
(4) CsO2 (2) BaO 2
(3) SiO2
14. Which of the following is a set of green (4) CsO2
house gases ?
(1) CH4, O3, N2, SO2
14. ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ‚Ê ª˝ËŸ „Ê©‚ ªÒ‚Ê¥ ∑§Ê ‚◊ÈìÊÿ „Ò?
(2) O3, N2, CO2, NO2
(3) O3, NO2, SO2, Cl2
(1) CH4, O3, N2, SO2
(4) CO2, CH4, N2O, O3
(2) O3, N2, CO2, NO2
(3) O3, NO2, SO2, Cl2
(4) CO2, CH4, N2O, O3
5 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
15. The group having triangular planar 15. fl„ ª˝È¬ Á¡‚◊¥ ÁòÊ∑§ÊáÊ ‚◊ËËÿ ‚¥⁄UøŸÊflÊ‹ „Ò¥, „Ò —
structures is :
2−
(1) BF3, NF3, CO 3 2−
(1) BF3, NF3, CO 3
(2) CO 23− , NO−
3 , SO3 (2) CO 23− , NO−
3 , SO3
(3) NH3, SO3, CO 23−
(3) NH3, SO3, CO 23−
(4) NCl3, BCl3, SO3
(4) NCl3, BCl3, SO3
6 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
18. Which of the following ions does not 18. ÁŸêŸ •ÊÿŸÊ¥ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ÃŸÈ •ê‹Ê¥ ‚ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ
liberate hydrogen gas on reaction with ∑§⁄UŸ ¬⁄U „Êß«˛UÊ¡Ÿ ªÒ‚ Ÿ„Ë¥ ÁŸ∑§Ê‹ÃÊ ?
dilute acids ?
(1) Ti2+
(1) Ti2+
(2) V2+
(2) V2+
(3) Cr2+
(3) Cr2+
(4) Mn2+
(4) Mn2+
7 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
21. A compound of molecular formula 21. ∞∑§ ÿÊÒÁª∑§ Á¡‚∑§Ê •áÊÈ‚òÍ Ê C8H8O2 „Ò, ∞Á‚≈UÊ»§ŸÊŸ
C8H8O2 reacts with acetophenone to form
‚ ∞∑§ ˇÊÊ⁄U∑§ ∑§Ë ©¬ÁSÕÁà ◊¥ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§⁄U∑§ ∞∑§
a single cross-aldol product in the presence
of base. The same compound on reaction „Ë ∑˝§Ê‚-∞À«UÊ‹ ©à¬ÊŒ ’ŸÊÃÊ „Ò– fl„Ë ÿÊÒÁª∑§ ‚ÊãŒ˝
with conc. NaOH forms benzyl alcohol as NaOH ∑§ ‚ÊÕ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§⁄U∑§ ’¥Á¡‹ ∞À∑§Ê„ÊÚ‹,
one of the products. The structure of the ¡Ê ’ŸŸflÊ‹ ©à¬ÊŒÊ¥ ◊¥ ‚ ∞∑§ „Ò, ’ŸÊÃÊ „Ò– ÿÊÒÁª∑§
compound is :
∑§Ë ‚¥⁄UøŸÊ „Ò —
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
8 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
22. Which of the following compounds is most 22. ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ÿÊÒÁª∑§, ‚ÊÁ«Uÿ◊ ∑§Ê’ʸŸ≈U ∑§
reactive to an aqueous solution of sodium
¡‹Ëÿ Áfl‹ÿŸ ∑§ ¬˝ÁÃ, ‚flʸÁœ∑§ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿʇÊË‹
carbonate ?
„Ò?
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
9 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
24. The major product of the following 24. ÁŸêŸ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ê ◊ÈÅÿ ©à¬ÊŒ „Ò —
reaction is :
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
10 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
25. The incorrect statement among the 25. ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ª‹Ã ∑§ÕŸ „Ò —
following is :
(1) α-D-glucose and β-D-glucose are
(1) α-D-Ç‹Í∑§Ê¡ ÃÕÊ β-D-Ç‹Í∑§Ê¡ ∞ŸÊ◊⁄U „Ò¥–
anomers.
(2) α-D-glucose and β-D-glucose are
enantiomers. (2) α-D-Ç‹Í∑§Ê¡ ÃÕÊ β-D-Ç‹Í∑§Ê¡ ¬˝ÁÃÁ’ê’M§¬
(3) Cellulose is a straight chain „Ò–¥
polysaccharide made up of only
β-D-glucose units.
(3) ‚‹Í‹Ê¡ ∞∑§ ´§¡È oÎ¥π‹Ê ¬Ê‹Ë‚Ò∑§⁄UÊß«U „Ò
¡Ê ∑§fl‹ β-D-Ç‹Í∑§Ê¡ ∞∑§∑§Ê¥ ‚ ’ŸÊ „Ò–
(4) The penta acetate of glucose does not
react with hydroxyl amine.
(4) Ç‹Í∑§Ê¡ ∑§Ê ¬ã≈UÊ ∞‚Ë≈U≈U, „Êß«˛UÊÁÄ‚‹ ∞◊ËŸ
26. Which of the following is a biodegradable ∑§ ‚ÊÕ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ Ÿ„Ë¥ ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò
polymer ?
(2) (1)
(2)
(3)
(4) (3)
(4)
11 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
27. The increasing order of the boiling points 27. ÁŸêŸ ÿÊÒÁª∑§Ê¥ ∑§ ÄflÕŸÊ¥∑§Ê¥ ∑§Ê ’…∏ÃÊ „È•Ê ∑˝§◊ „Ò —
for the following compounds is :
C 2 H5 OH C 2 H5Cl C 2 H5CH3
C 2 H5 OH C 2 H5Cl C 2 H5CH3 (I) (II) (III)
(I) (II) (III)
C 2 H5OCH3
C 2 H5OCH3 (IV)
(IV)
(1) (III) < (IV) < (II) < (I)
(1) (III) < (IV) < (II) < (I)
(2) (IV) < (III) < (I) < (II)
(2) (IV) < (III) < (I) < (II)
(3) (II) < (III) < (IV) < (I)
(3) (II) < (III) < (IV) < (I)
(4) (III) < (II) < (I) < (IV)
(4) (III) < (II) < (I) < (IV)
12 IX - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
29. In the following reaction sequence : 29. ÁŸêŸ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑˝§◊ ◊¥ —
The compound I is :
ÿÊÒÁª∑§ I „Ò —
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
(III) (IV)
(III) (IV)
(1) (I) < (II) < (IV) < (III)
(2) (I) < (II) < (III) < (IV) (1) (I) < (II) < (IV) < (III)
(3) (II) < (I) < (IV) < (III) (2) (I) < (II) < (III) < (IV)
(4) (II) < (I) < (III) < (IV) (3) (II) < (I) < (IV) < (III)
(4) (II) < (I) < (III) < (IV)
13 IX - CHEMISTRY
JEE Main 2017 Official Question Paper 1 Mathematics, April 9
(English+Hindi)
MATHEMATICS ªÁáÊÃ
Im
iz − 2
+ 1 = 0, z C , z ≠ i
z −i 3. ‚◊Ë∑§⁄UáÊ
represents a part of a circle having radius
Im
equal to : iz − 2
+ 1 = 0, z C , z ≠ i
z −i
(1) 2
©‚ flÎûÊ ∑§ ∞∑§ ÷ʪ ∑§Ê ÁŸM§Á¬Ã ∑§⁄UÃË „Ò, Á¡‚∑§Ë
(2) 1
ÁòÊíÿÊ „Ò —
3 (1) 2
(3)
4
(2) 1
1
(4) 3
2 (3)
4
1
(4)
2
1 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
4. For two 3×3 matrices A and B, let 4. ŒÊ 3×3 •Ê√ÿÍ „ Ê ¥ A ÃÕÊ B ∑ § Á‹∞ ◊ÊŸÊ
A+B=2B9 and 3A+2B=I3, where B9 is
A+B=2B9 ÃÕÊ 3A+2B=I3 „Ò, ¡„Ê° B9 •Ê√ÿÍ„
the transpose of B and I3 is 3×3 identity
matrix. Then : B ∑§Ê ¬Á⁄Uflø „Ò ÃÕÊ I3 ∞∑§ 3×3 Ãà‚◊∑§ •Ê√ÿÍ„
(1) 5A+10B=2I3
„Ò, ÃÊ —
(2) 10A+5B=3I3 (1) 5A+10B=2I3
2 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
3 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
10. The value of k for which the function 10. k ∑§Ê fl„ ◊ÊŸ Á¡‚∑§ Á‹∞ »§‹Ÿ
4 tan 4x
4 tan 4x
tan 5x
, 0<x<
π tan 5x π
5 , 0<x<
2
f (x) = f ( x ) = 5 2
2 π 2 π
k+ , x= k+ , x=
5 2
5 2
π
is continuous at x = , is : x=
π
¬⁄U ‚ÃØ „Ò, „Ò —
2 2
17 17
(1) (1)
20 20
2 2
(2) (2)
5 5
3 3
(3) (3)
5 5
2 2
(4) − (4) −
5 5
1 − 15 1 − 15
11. If 2 x = y 5 + y and 11. ÿÁŒ 2x = y 5 + y ÃÕÊ
d2 y dy d2 y dy
( x 2 − 1) 2
+ λx + ky = 0, then λ+k ( x 2 − 1) + λx + ky = 0 „Ò, ÃÊ λ+k
dx dx dx 2 dx
is equal to :
’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
(1) −23
(1) −23
(2) −24
(2) −24
(3) 26
(3) 26
(4) −26
(4) −26
4 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
8 2 8 2
(2) − ,
(1) ,
3 3 3 3
8 2 8 2
(3) − , − (2) − ,
3 3 3 3
8 2 (3) 8 2
(4) ,− − , −
3 3 3 3
8 2
(4) ,−
3 3
5 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
2 2
∫ (x ∫ (x
dx k dx k
15. If 3
= , then k is 15. ÿÁŒ 3
= „Ò, ÃÊ k ’⁄UÊ’⁄U
k+5 k+5
1
2
− 2x + 4 ) 2
1
2
− 2x + 4 ) 2
equal to : „Ò —
(1) 1 (1) 1
(2) 2 (2) 2
(3) 3 (3) 3
(4) 4 (4) 4
16. If
16. Á∑§‚Ë œŸÊà◊∑§ flÊSÃÁfl∑§ ‚¥ÅÿÊ a ∑§ Á‹∞ ÿÁŒ
a a a
lim 1 + 2 + ........ + n 1
n →∞ a−1
= lim 1a + 2 a + ........ + n a 1
(n+1) [(na+1)+(na+2)+..... + (na+n)] 60 n →∞ a−1
=
(n+1) [(na+1)+(na+2)+..... + (na+n)] 60
for some positive real number a, then a is
equal to : „Ò, ÃÊ a ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
(1) 7
(2) 8 (1) 7
(2) 8
15
(3)
2 15
(3)
2
17
(4)
2 17
(4)
2
6 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
17. A tangent to the curve, y=f (x) at P(x, y) 17. fl∑˝§ y=f (x) ∑§ Á’¥ŒÈ P(x, y) ¬⁄U S¬‡Ê¸⁄UπÊ x-•ˇÊ
meets x-axis at A and y-axis at B. If
∑§Ê A ¬⁄U ÃÕÊ y-•ˇÊ ∑§Ê B ¬⁄U ∑§Ê≈UÃË „Ò– ÿÁŒ
AP : BP=1 : 3 and f (1)=1, then the curve
also passes through the point : AP : BP=1 : 3 ÃÕÊ f (1)=1 „Ò, ÃÊ fl∑˝§ ÁŸêŸ Á’¥ŒÈ
‚ ÷Ë „Ê ∑§⁄U ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò —
1
(1) , 24
3 1
(1) , 24
3
1
(2) , 4
2 1
(2) , 4
2
(3) 1
2,
8 (3) 1
2,
8
(4) 1
3,
28 (4) 1
3,
28
(2) 2 3 −2
(1) 2 3 −1
(3) 3 −2
(2) 2 3 −2
(4) 3 −1
(3) 3 −2
(4) 3 −1
7 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
19. A line drawn through the point P(4, 7) cuts 19. ÿÁŒ Á’¥ŒÈ P(4, 7)‚ πË¥øË ªß¸ ∞∑§ ⁄UπÊ, flÎûÊ
the circle x2+y2=9 at the points A and B.
x2+y2=9 ∑§Ê Á’¥ŒÈ•Ê¥ A ÃÕÊ B ¬⁄U ∑§Ê≈UÃË „Ò, ÃÊ
Then PA⋅PB is equal to :
PA⋅PB ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
(1) 53
(1) 53
(2) 56
(2) 56
(3) 74
(3) 74
(4) 65
(4) 65
(4) 16 3
8 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
22. If a variable plane, at a distance of 3 units 22. ∞∑§ ø⁄U ‚◊Ë, Á¡‚∑§Ë ◊Í‹ Á’¥ŒÈ ‚ ŒÍ⁄UË 3 ß∑§Ê߸ „Ò,
from the origin, intersects the coordinate
ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§ •ˇÊÊ¥ ∑§Ê A, B ÃÕÊ C ¬⁄U ∑§Ê≈UÃÊ „Ò, ÃÊ
axes at A, B and C, then the locus of the
centroid of ∆ABC is : ∆ABC ∑§ ∑¥§Œ˝∑§ ∑§Ê Á’¥ŒÈ¬Õ „Ò —
1
1 1
(1) + 2 + 2 =1
2
x y z 11 1
(1) + 2 + 2 =1
2
x y z
1
1 1
(2) + 2 + 2 =3
2
x y z 11 1
(2) + 2 + 2 =3
2
x y z
1
1 1 1
(3) + 2 + 2 =
2
x y z 9 11 1 1
(3) + 2 + 2 =
2
x y z 9
1
1 1
(4) + 2 + 2 =9
2
x y z 11 1
(4) + 2 + 2 =9
2
x y z
x −3 y +2 z +λ
23. If the line, = = lies in
1 −1 −2 x −3 y +2 z +λ
23. ÿÁŒ ⁄ U π Ê,= = , ‚◊Ë
the plane, 2x−4y+3z=2, then the 1 −1 −2
shortest distance between this line and the 2x−4y+3z=2 ◊¥ ÁSÕà „Ò, ÃÊ ß‚ ⁄UπÊ ÃÕÊ ⁄UπÊ
x −1 y z x −1
line, = = is : y
= =
z
∑§ ’Ëø ∑§Ë ãÿÍŸÃ◊ ŒÍ⁄UË „Ò —
12 9 4 12 9 4
(1) 2
(2) 1 (1) 2
(3) 0 (2) 1
(4) 3 (3) 0
(4) 3
9 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
→ ∧ ∧ → ∧ ∧
24. If the vector b = 3 j + 4 k is written as the 24. ÿÁŒ ‚ÁŒ‡Ê b =3 j +4k ∑§Ê ‚ÁŒ‡Ê
→ → ∧ ∧ → ∧ ∧ → →
sum of a vector b1 , parallel to a = i + j a =i+ j ∑§ ‚◊Ê¥Ã⁄U ‚ÁŒ‡Ê b1 ÃÕÊ ‚ÁŒ‡Ê a
→ → →
and a vector b2 , perpendicular to a , then ∑§ ‹¥’flà ‚ÁŒ‡Ê b2 ∑§ ÿʪ ∑§ M§¬ ◊¥ Á‹πÊ ¡Ê∞,
→ → → →
b1 × b 2 is equal to : ÃÊ b1 × b 2 ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(1) −3 i + 3 j − 9 k (1) −3 i + 3 j − 9 k
∧ ∧ 9∧ ∧ ∧ 9∧
(2) 6i − 6 j + k (2) 6i − 6 j + k
2 2
∧ ∧ 9∧ ∧ ∧ 9∧
(3) −6 i + 6 j − k (3) −6 i + 6 j − k
2 2
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(4) 3 i − 3 j + 9k (4) 3 i − 3 j + 9k
25. From a group of 10 men and 5 women, 25. 10 ¬ÈL§· ÃÕÊ 5 ◊Á„‹Ê•Ê¥ ∑§ ∞∑§ ‚◊Í„ ◊¥ ‚ øÊ⁄U
four member committees are to be formed
each of which must contain at least one
‚ŒSÿÊ¥ ∑§Ë ∞‚Ë ∑§◊Á≈UÿÊ¥ ’ŸÊŸË „Ò¥ Á¡Ÿ◊¥ ¬˝àÿ∑§ ◊¥
woman. Then the probability for these ∑§◊ ‚ ∑§◊ ∞∑§ ◊Á„‹Ê •fl‡ÿ „Ê– ߟ ∑§◊Á≈UÿÊ¥ ◊¥
committees to have more women than ◊Á„‹Ê•Ê¥ ∑§Ë ‚¥ÅÿÊ ¬ÈL§·Ê¥ ∑§Ë ‚¥ÅÿÊ ‚ •Áœ∑§ „ÊŸ
men, is : ∑§Ë ¬˝ÊÁÿ∑§ÃÊ „Ò —
21
(1)
220
21
(1)
3 220
(2)
11
3
(2)
1 11
(3)
11
1
(3)
2 11
(4)
23
2
(4)
23
10 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
26. Let E and F be two independent events. 26. ◊ÊŸÊ E ÃÕÊ F ŒÊ SflÃ¥òÊ ÉÊ≈UŸÊ∞° „Ò¥– E ÃÕÊ F ŒÊŸÊ¥ ∑§
The probability that both E and F happen
1
1 ÉÊ≈UŸ ∑§Ë ¬˝ÊÁÿ∑§ÃÊ „Ò ÃÕÊ Ÿ E •ÊÒ⁄U Ÿ „Ë F ∑§
is and the probability that neither E 12
12
1 P(E)
1 P(E) ÉÊ≈UŸ ∑§Ë ¬˝ÊÁÿ∑§ÃÊ „Ò, ÃÊ ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ◊ÊŸ „Ò —
nor F happens is , then a value of 2 P(F)
2 P(F)
is :
4
(1) 4
3 (1)
3
3
(2) 3
2 (2)
2
1
(3) 1
3 (3)
3
5
(4) 5
12 (4)
12
11 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
12 IX - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
-o0o- (4) ÿÁŒ ŒÊ ‚¥ÅÿÊ•Ê¥ ∑§ flª¸ ‚◊ÊŸ Ÿ„Ë¥ „Ò¥, ÃÊ
‚¥ÅÿÊ∞° ‚◊ÊŸ „Ò–
-o0o-
13 IX - MATHEMATICS
JEE-Main-2017-Answer-Key-April-9
JEE Main 2017 Official Question Paper 1 Physics, April 8
(English+Hindi)
1. Time (T), velocity (C) and angular 1. ÿÁŒ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ, ‹ê’Ê߸ •ÊÒ⁄U ‚◊ÿ ∑§ SÕÊŸ ¬⁄U ‚◊ÿ
momentum (h) are chosen as fundamental
(T), flª (C) ÃÕÊ ∑§ÊáÊËÿ ‚¥flª (h) ∑§Ê ◊Í‹÷ÍÃ
quantities instead of mass, length and time.
In terms of these, the dimensions of mass ⁄UÊÁ‡ÊÿÊ° ◊ÊŸ ‹¥ ÃÊ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ ∑§Ë Áfl◊Ê ∑§Ê ߟ ⁄UÊÁ‡ÊÿÊ¥
would be : ∑§ M§¬ ◊¥ ÁŸêŸ Ã⁄UË∑§ ‚ Á‹π¥ª —
(1) [ M ]=[ T−1 C−2 h ]
(2) [ M ]=[ T−1 C2 h ] (1) [ M ]=[ T−1 C−2 h ]
(3) [ M ]=[ T−1 C−2 h−1 ] (2) [ M ]=[ T−1 C2 h ]
(4) [ M ]=[ T C−2 h ] (3) [ M ]=[ T−1 C−2 h−1 ]
(4) [ M ]=[ T C−2 h ]
1 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
2. Which graph corresponds to an object 2. ÁSÕ⁄U ´§áÊÊà◊∑§ àfl⁄UáÊ fl œŸÊà◊∑§ flª ‚ ø‹Ÿ
moving with a constant negative
flÊ‹Ë ∞∑§ flSÃÈ ∑§ Á‹ÿ ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ª˝Ê$»§ ‚„Ë
acceleration and a positive velocity ?
„Ò?
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
2 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
3. A 1 kg block attached to a spring vibrates 3. ∞∑§ ÁS¬˝¥ª ‚ ¡È«∏Ê „È•Ê 1 kg ∑§Ê ∞∑§ ªÈ≈U∑§Ê 1 Hz
with a frequency of 1 Hz on a frictionless
∑§Ë •ÊflÎÁûÊ ‚ ∞∑§ ÉÊ·¸áÊ„ËŸ ˇÊÒÁá ◊¡ ¬⁄U ŒÊ‹Ÿ
horizontal table. Two springs identical to
the original spring are attached in parallel ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– ß‚Ë Ã⁄U„ ∑§Ë ŒÊ ‚◊ÊãÃ⁄U ÁS¬˝¥ªÊ¥ ‚ ∞∑§
to an 8 kg block placed on the same table. 8 kg ∑§Ê ªÈ≈U∑§Ê ¡Ê«∏∑§⁄U ©‚Ë ◊¡ ¬⁄U ŒÊ‹Ÿ ∑§⁄UÊÃ
So, the frequency of vibration of the 8 kg „Ò¥– 8 kg ∑§ ªÈ≈U∑§ ∑§Ë ŒÊ‹Ÿ •ÊflÎÁûÊ „ÊªË —
block is :
1
(1) Hz
4
1
(1) Hz
1 4
(2) Hz
2 2
1
(2) Hz
1 2 2
(3) Hz
2
1
(4) 2 Hz (3) Hz
2
(4) 2 Hz
4. An object is dropped from a height h from
the ground. Every time it hits the ground
it looses 50% of its kinetic energy. The total 4. ∞∑§ flSÃÈ ∑§Ê œ⁄UÃË ‚ h ™°§øÊ߸ ‚ ¿UÊ«∏Ê ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò–
distance covered as t→∞ is : ¡’ ÿ„ flSÃÈ ¬ÎâflË ‚ ≈U∑§⁄UÊÃË „Ò ÃÊ ¬˝àÿ∑§ ≈UÄ∑§⁄U ◊¥
(1) 2h ©‚∑§Ë 50% ªÁá ™§¡Ê¸ ˇÊÿ „ÊÃË „Ò– ÿÁŒ t →∞,
(2) ∞ flSÃÈ mÊ⁄UÊ Ãÿ ∑§Ë ªÿË ∑ȧ‹ ŒÍ⁄UË „ÊªË —
5 (1) 2h
(3) h
3 (2) ∞
8 5
(4) h (3) h
3 3
8
(4) h
3
3 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
5. A uniform disc of radius R and mass M is 5. ∞∑§ ÁòÊíÿÊ R ÃÕÊ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ M ∑§Ë ∞∑§‚◊ÊŸ Á«US∑§
free to rotate only about its axis. A string
∑§fl‹ •¬ŸË •ˇÊ ∑§ ¬Á⁄U× ÉÊÍáʸŸ ∑§ Á‹ÿ SflÃ¥òÊ „Ò–
is wrapped over its rim and a body of mass
m is tied to the free end of the string as ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U ß‚ Á«US∑§ ∑§Ë ¬Á⁄UÁœ ¬⁄U ∞∑§ «UÊ⁄UË ‹¬≈U∑§⁄U,
shown in the figure. The body is released «UÊ⁄UË ∑§ SflÃ¥òÊ Á‚⁄U ‚ ∞∑§ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ m ∑§Ê ’Ê°œÊ ªÿÊ
from rest. Then the acceleration of the „Ò– ÿÁŒ Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ ∑§Ê ÁSÕ⁄UÊflSÕÊ ‚ ¿UÊ«∏Ê ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÊ
body is : ©‚∑§Ê àfl⁄UáÊ „ÊªÊ —
2 mg 2 mg
(1) (1)
2 m +M 2m+M
2 Mg 2 Mg
(2) (2)
2 m+M 2m+M
2 mg 2 mg
(3) (3)
2 M+m 2M+m
2 Mg 2 Mg
(4) (4)
2 M +m 2M+m
4 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
6. Moment of inertia of an equilateral 6. ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U ‚◊’Ê„È ÁòÊ÷È¡ ∑§Ë •Ê∑ΧÁà flÊ‹ ∞∑§ ¬≈U‹
triangular lamina ABC, about the axis
ABC ∑§Ê ∞∑§ •ˇÊ, ¡Ê Á’ãŒÈ O ‚ ¡ÊÃË „Ò ÃÕÊ
passing through its centre O and
perpendicular to its plane is Io as shown ¬≈U‹ ∑§ •Á÷‹ê’flØ „Ò, ∑§ ‚ʬˇÊ ¡«∏àfl •ÊÉÊÍáʸ Io
in the figure. A cavity DEF is cut out from „Ò– ß‚ ¬≈U‹ ◊¥ ‚ ∞∑§ ÁòÊ÷È¡ DEF ∑§ •Ê∑§Ê⁄U ∑§Ê
the lamina, where D, E, F are the mid ∞∑§ ¿UŒ Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– ÿ„Ê° D, E fl F ÷È¡Ê•Ê¥ ∑§
points of the sides. Moment of inertia of
the remaining part of lamina about the
◊äÿ Á’ãŒÈ „Ò¥– ß‚ ’ø „È∞ ¬≈U‹ ∑§Ê ©‚Ë •ˇÊ ∑§
same axis is : ‚ʬˇÊ ¡«∏àfl •ÊÉÊÍáʸ „ÊªÊ —
7
7 (1) Io
(1) Io 8
8
15
15 (2) Io
(2) Io 16
16
3 Io
3 Io (3)
(3) 4
4
31 I o
31 I o (4)
(4) 32
32
5 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
7. If the Earth has no rotational motion, the 7. ÿÁŒ ¬ÎâflË ∑§Ë ÉÊÍáʸŸ ªÁà ‡ÊÍãÿ „Ò ÃÊ ∞∑§ √ÿÁÄà ∑§Ê
weight of a person on the equator is W.
÷Í◊äÿ⁄UπÊ ¬⁄U ÷Ê⁄U W „Ò– ¬ÎâflË ∑§Ë •¬ŸË •ˇÊ ∑§
Determine the speed with which the earth
would have to rotate about its axis so that ¬Á⁄U× ÉÊÍáʸŸ ∑§Ë fl„ ªÁà ôÊÊà ∑§ËÁ¡ÿ Á¡‚ ¬⁄U ©‚
the person at the equator will weigh 3
√ÿÁÄà ∑§Ê ÷Í◊äÿ⁄UπÊ ¬⁄U ÷Ê⁄U 4
W „ʪʖ ¬ÎâflË
3
W. Radius of the Earth is 6400 km and ∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ 6400 km •ÊÒ⁄U g=10 m/s2 „Ò–
4
g=10 m/s2.
(1) 1.1×10−3 rad/s
(2) 0.83×10−3 rad/s (1) 1.1×10−3 rad/s
(3) 0.63×10−3 rad/s (2) 0.83×10−3 rad/s
6 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
9. A compressive force, F is applied at the 9. S≈UË‹ ∑§Ë ∞∑§ ¬Ã‹Ë ∞fl¥ ‹ê’Ë ¿U«∏ ∑§ ŒÊŸÊ¥ Á‚⁄UÊ¥ ¬⁄U
two ends of a long thin steel rod. It is
∞∑§ ‚¥¬Ë«UŸ ’‹ F ‹ªÊÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÕÊ ‚ÊÕ „Ë ¿U«∏
heated, simultaneously, such that its
temperature increases by ∆T. The net ∑§Ê ª◊¸ ∑§⁄U∑§ ©‚∑§Ê Ãʬ◊ÊŸ ∆T ’…∏ÊÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò–
change in its length is zero. Let l be the ß‚‚ ¿U«∏ ∑§Ë ‹ê’Ê߸ ◊¥ ∑ȧ‹ ¬Á⁄UfløŸ ‡ÊÍãÿ „Ò– ◊ÊŸÊ
length of the rod, A its area of cross-section, Á∑§ ¿U«∏ ∑§Ë ‹ê’Ê߸ l, •ŸÈ¬˝SÕ ∑§Ê≈U ∑§Ê ˇÊòÊ»§‹ A,
Y its Young’s modulus, and α its coefficient
of linear expansion. Then, F is equal to :
ÿ¥ª ¬˝àÿÊSÕÃÊ ªÈáÊÊ¥∑§ Y fl ⁄UπËÿ ¬˝‚Ê⁄U ªÈáÊÊ¥∑§ α „Ò
ÃÊ F ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
(1) l2 Yα ∆T
(2) lA Yα ∆T
(1) l2 Yα ∆T
(3) A Yα ∆T
(2) lA Yα ∆T
AY
(4) (3) A Yα ∆T
α ∆T
AY
(4)
α ∆T
10. An engine operates by taking n moles of
an ideal gas through the cycle ABCDA
shown in figure. The thermal efficiency 10. ÁøòÊ ◊¥ ÁŒπÊÿ ªÿ ∞∑§ ø∑˝§Ëÿ ¬˝∑˝§◊ ABCDA ∑§
of the engine is :
•ŸÈ‚Ê⁄U n ◊Ê‹ •ÊŒ‡Ê¸ ªÒ‚ ‚ ∞∑§ ߥ¡Ÿ ø‹ÊÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ
(Take Cv=1.5 R, where R is gas constant)
„Ò– ߥ¡Ÿ ∑§Ë ÃʬËÿ ˇÊ◊ÃÊ „ÊªË —
(ÁŒÿÊ „Ò — Cv=1.5 R, ¡„Ê° R ªÒ‚ ÁŸÿÃÊ¥∑§ „Ò–)
(1) 0.24
(2) 0.15
(1) 0.24
(3) 0.32
(2) 0.15
(4) 0.08 (3) 0.32
(4) 0.08
7 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
11. An ideal gas has molecules with 5 degrees 11. ∞∑§ •ÊŒ‡Ê¸ ªÒ‚ ∑§ •áÊÈ•Ê¥ ∑§Ë SflÊÃ¥òÊÿ ∑§ÊÁ≈U
of freedom. The ratio of specific heats at
(degrees of freedom) 5 „Ò– ß‚ ªÒ‚ ∑§Ë ÁSÕ⁄U
constant pressure (C p) and at constant
volume (Cv) is : ŒÊ’ ¬⁄U ÁflÁ‡Êc≈U ™§c◊Ê (Cp) •ÊÒ⁄U ÁSÕ⁄U •Êÿß ¬⁄U
(1) 6
ÁflÁ‡ÊC ™§c◊Ê (Cv) ∑§Ê •ŸÈ¬Êà „ÊªÊ —
(1) 6
7
(2)
2 7
(2)
2
5
(3)
2 5
(3)
2
7
(4)
5 7
(4)
5
8 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
13. Two wires W 1 and W 2 have the same 13. ŒÊ ÃÊ⁄UÊ¥ W1 ÃÕÊ W2 ∑§Ë ‚◊ÊŸ ÁòÊíÿÊ r „Ò ÃÕÊ
radius r and respective densities ρ1 and ρ2
ÉÊŸàfl ∑˝§◊‡Ê— ρ1 •ÊÒ⁄U ρ2 ß‚ ¬˝∑§Ê⁄U „Ò¥ Á∑§ ρ2=4ρ1–
such that ρ 2 =4ρ 1 . They are joined
together at the point O, as shown in the ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U ߟ ÃÊ⁄UÊ¥ ∑§Ê Á’ãŒÈ O ¬⁄U ¡Ê«∏Ê ªÿÊ „Ò– ß‚
figure. The combination is used as a ‚¥ÿÊ¡Ÿ ∑§Ê ‚ÊŸÊ◊Ë≈U⁄U ∑§ ÃÊ⁄U ∑§ M§¬ ◊¥ ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§⁄UÃ
sonometer wire and kept under tension T. „Ò¥ •ÊÒ⁄U ß‚ ßÊfl T ¬⁄U ⁄Uπà „Ò¥– Á’ãŒÈ O, ŒÊŸÊ¥
The point O is midway between the two
bridges. When a stationary wave is set up
‚ÃÈ•Ê¥ ∑§ ◊äÿ ◊¥ „Ò¥– ß‚ ‚¥ÿÈÄà ÃÊ⁄U ◊¥ ∞∑§ •¬˝ªÊ◊Ë
in the composite wire, the joint is found to Ã⁄¥Uª ©à¬ÛÊ ∑§Ë ¡ÊÃË „Ò¥ ÃÊ ¡Ê«∏ ¬⁄U ÁŸS¬¥Œ (node)
be a node. The ratio of the number of ’ŸÃÊ „Ò– W1 fl W2 ÃÊ⁄UÊ¥ ◊¥ ’Ÿ ¬˝S¬¥ŒÊ¥ (antinode)
antinodes formed in W1 to W2 is : ∑§Ë ‚¥ÅÿÊ ∑§Ê •ŸÈ¬Êà „ÊªÊ —
(1) 1:1
(1) 1:1
(2) 1:2
(2) 1:2
(3) 1:3
(3) 1:3
(4) 4:1
(4) 4:1
9 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
15. The energy stored in the electric field 15. œÊÃÈ ∑§ ∞∑§ ªÊ‹ ‚ ©à¬ÛÊ ÁfllÈà ˇÊòÊ ◊¥ ‚¥Áøà ™§¡Ê¸
produced by a metal sphere is 4.5 J. If the
∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ 4.5 J „Ò– ÿÁŒ ªÊ‹ ◊¥ ÁŸÁ„à •Êfl‡Ê 4 µC
sphere contains 4 µC charge, its radius will
„Ê ÃÊ ©‚∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
1
be : [Take : = 9 × 109 N − m 2 /C 2 ] 1
4 πo [ÁŒÿÊ „Ò — = 9 × 109 N − m 2 /C 2 ]
4 πo
(1) 20 mm
(1) 20 mm
(2) 32 mm
(2) 32 mm
(3) 28 mm
(3) 28 mm
(4) 16 mm
(4) 16 mm
10 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
17. 17.
A 9 V battery with internal resistance of ∞∑§ 9 V ∑§Ë ’Ò≈U⁄UË, Á¡‚∑§Ê •ÊãÃÁ⁄U∑§ ¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ
0.5 Ω is connected across an infinite 0.5 Ω „Ò, ∑§Ê ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U •Ÿãà ¬Á⁄U¬Õ ◊¥ ‹ªÊÿÊ
network as shown in the figure. All
ªÿÊ „Ò– ‚÷Ë •◊Ë≈U⁄U A1, A2, A3 ÃÕÊ flÊÀ≈U◊Ë≈U⁄U
ammeters A1, A2, A3 and voltmeter V are
ideal. V •ÊŒ‡Ê¸ „Ò¥–
→
(1) (
E =−v0 B0 3 ∧i −2 ∧j−4 ∧k )
(2) (
E =−v0 B0 i + j+7 k ∧ ∧ ∧
) →
→
(2) E =−v0 B0 ∧i +∧j+7 ∧k ( )
(3) (
E = v0 B0 14 j+7 k ∧ ∧
) →
→
(3) (
E = v0 B0 14 ∧j+7 ∧k )
(4) (
E =− v0 B0 14 ∧j+7 ∧k ) →
(4) E =− v0 B0 14 ∧j+7 ∧k ( )
11 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
19. A magnetic dipole in a constant magnetic 19. ∞∑§ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ ◊¥ ⁄Uπ „È∞ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ Ámœ˝Èfl ∑§Ë —
field has :
(1) maximum potential energy when
the torque is maximum. (1) ÁSÕÁá ™§¡Ê¸ •Áœ∑§Ã◊ „ÊªË ÿÁŒ ’‹ •ÊÉÊÍáʸ
(2) zero potential energy when the
•Áœ∑§Ã◊ „Ò–
torque is minimum. (2) ÁSÕÁá ™§¡Ê¸ ‡ÊÍãÿ „ÊªË ÿÁŒ ’‹ •ÊÉÊÍáʸ
(3) zero potential energy when the ãÿÍŸÃ◊ „Ò–
torque is maximum.
(3) ÁSÕÁá ™§¡Ê¸ ‡ÊÍãÿ „ÊªË ÿÁŒ ’‹ •ÊÉÊÍáʸ
(4) minimum potential energy when the
torque is maximum.
•Áœ∑§Ã◊ „Ò–
(4) ÁSÕÁá ™§¡Ê¸ ãÿÍŸÃ◊ „ÊªË ÿÁŒ ’‹ •ÊÉÊÍáʸ
20. A small circular loop of wire of radius a is
•Áœ∑§Ã◊ „Ò–
located at the centre of a much larger
circular wire loop of radius b. The two
loops are in the same plane. The outer loop 20. ÃÊ⁄U ‚ ’Ÿ ÁòÊíÿÊ a ∑§ ¿UÊ≈U flÎûÊÊ∑§Ê⁄U fl‹ÿ ∑§Ê ÁòÊíÿÊ
of radius b carries an alternating current b ∑§ ∞∑§ ’΄Ø flÎûÊÊ∑§Ê⁄U fl‹ÿ ∑§ ∑§ãŒ˝ ¬⁄U ⁄UπÊ ªÿÊ
I=Io cos (ωt). The emf induced in the „Ò– ŒÊŸÊ¥ fl‹ÿ ∞∑§ „Ë ‚◊Ë ◊¥ „Ò¥– ÁòÊíÿÊ b ∑§
smaller inner loop is nearly :
’Ês fl‹ÿ ◊¥ ∞∑§ ¬˝àÿÊflÃ˸ œÊ⁄UÊ I=Io cos (ωt)
πµo Io a 2 ¬˝flÊÁ„à ∑§Ë ¡ÊÃË „Ò– ÁòÊíÿÊ a flÊ‹ •ÊãÃÁ⁄U∑§ fl‹ÿ
(1) . ω sin ( ωt) ◊¥ ¬˝Á⁄Uà ÁfllÈà flÊ„∑§ ’‹ „ÊªÊ —
2 b
πµo Io a 2
(2) . ω cos (ωt) πµo Io a 2
2 b (1) . ω sin ( ωt)
2 b
a2
(3) πµo I o ω sin (ωt) πµo Io a 2
b (2) . ω cos (ωt)
2 b
πµo Io b2
(4) ω cos (ωt) a2
a (3) πµo I o ω sin (ωt)
b
πµo Io b2
(4) ω cos (ωt)
a
12 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
21. Magnetic field in a plane electromagnetic 21. ∞∑§ ‚◊Ë flÒlÈÃøÈê’∑§Ëÿ Ã⁄¥Uª ◊¥ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ
wave is given by
→ ∧
→ ∧ B = B0 sin (k x+ω t) j T „Ò – ß‚∑ § ‚¥ ª Ã
B = B0 sin (k x+ω t) j T
ÁfllÈà ˇÊòÊ ∑§Ê ‚ÍòÊ „ÊªÊ —
Expression for corresponding electric field
will be : ÿ„Ê° c ¬˝∑§Ê‡Ê ∑§Ê flª „Ò–
Where c is speed of light.
→ ∧
(1) E = B0 c sin (k x+ω t) k V/m
→ ∧
(1) E = B0 c sin (k x+ω t) k V/m
→ B ∧
(2) E = 0 sin (k x+ωt) k V/m
→ B ∧ c
(2) E = 0 sin (k x+ωt) k V/m
c
→ ∧
(3) E =− B0 c sin (k x+ω t) k V/m
→ ∧
(3) E =− B0 c sin (k x+ω t) k V/m
→ ∧
(4) E = B0 c sin (k x−ω t) k V/m
→ ∧
(4) E = B0 c sin (k x−ω t) k V/m
22. ◊ÊŸÊ Á∑§ ∞∑§ ‚ÉÊŸ ◊Êäÿ◊ ∑§Ê ∞∑§ Áfl⁄U‹ ◊Êäÿ◊ ∑§
22. Let the refractive index of a denser medium ‚ʬˇÊ •¬fløŸÊ¥∑§ n12 „Ò ÃÕÊ ©‚∑§Ê ∑˝§ÊÁãÃ∑§ ∑§ÊáÊ
with respect to a rarer medium be n12 and
θC „Ò– ¡’ ¬˝∑§Ê‡Ê ∞∑§ •Ê¬ÃŸ ∑§ÊáÊ A ‚ ‚ÉÊŸ ‚
its critical angle be θC. At an angle of
incidence A when light is travelling from Áfl⁄U‹ ◊Êäÿ◊ ◊¥ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÊ ©‚∑§Ê ∞∑§ ÷ʪ ¬⁄UÊflÁøÃ
denser medium to rarer medium, a part of „ÊÃÊ „Ò •ÊÒ⁄U ’øÊ „È•Ê ÷ʪ •¬flÁøà „ÊÃÊ „Ò– ¬⁄UÊflÁøÃ
the light is reflected and the rest is refracted •ÊÒ ⁄ U •¬flÁø à Á∑§⁄U á ÊÊ ¥ ∑ § ’Ëø ∑§Ê á Ê 908 „Ò–
and the angle between reflected and
refracted rays is 908. Angle A is given by : ∑§ÊáÊ A ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ —
1
(1) −1 1
cos ( sin θC ) (1) −1
cos ( sin θC )
1
(2) −1 1
tan ( sin θC ) (2) −1
tan ( sin θC )
(3) cos−1 (sin θC)
(3) cos−1 (sin θC)
(4) tan−1 (sin θC)
(4) tan−1 (sin θC)
13 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
23. A single slit of width b is illuminated by a 23. λ Ã⁄¥UªŒÒäÿ¸ ∑§ ∑§‹Ê‚ê’h fl ∞∑§fláÊ˸ÿ ¬˝∑§Ê‡Ê ‚
coherent monochromatic light of
∞∑§ b øÊÒ«∏Ê߸ ∑§Ë Á¤Ê⁄UË ∑§Ê ¬˝ŒË# ∑§⁄Uà „Ò¥– ÿÁŒ 1 m
wavelength λ. If the second and fourth
minima in the diffraction pattern at a ŒÍ⁄UË ¬⁄U ⁄Uπ ¬Œ¸ ¬⁄U ’Ÿ ÁflfløŸ ¬˝ÊM§¬ ◊¥ ÁmÃËÿ ∞fl¥
distance 1 m from the slit are at 3 cm and øÃÈÕ¸ ÁŸÁêŸc∆U ∑§Ë ∑§ãŒ˝Ëÿ ©ÁìÊc∆U ‚ ŒÍ⁄UË ∑˝§◊‡Ê—
6 cm respectively from the central 3 cm •ÊÒ⁄U 6 cm „Ò ÃÊ ∑§ãŒ˝Ëÿ ©Áëøc∆U ∑§Ë øÊÒ«∏Ê߸
maximum, what is the width of the central
maximum ? (i.e. distance between first
ÄÿÊ „ʪË? (∑§ãŒ˝Ëÿ ©ÁëøD ∑§Ë øÊÒ«∏Ê߸ ©‚∑§ ŒÊŸÊ¥
minimum on either side of the central Ã⁄U»§ ∑§ ¬˝Õ◊ ÁŸÁêŸc∆U ∑§ ’Ëø ∑§Ë ŒÍ⁄UË „Ò–)
maximum)
(1) 1.5 cm
(2) 3.0 cm
(3) 4.5 cm (1) 1.5 cm
(2) v
flª „ÊªÊ —
(3) 3v ‚ •Áœ∑§
(4) 3v ∑§ ’⁄UÊ’⁄U
14 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
25. According to Bohr’s theory, the time 25. ’Ê⁄U (Bohr) ∑§ Á‚hÊãà ∑§ •ŸÈ‚Ê⁄U „Êß«˛UÊ¡Ÿ ¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ
averaged magnetic field at the centre (i.e.
∑§ ∑§ãŒ˝ (ŸÊÁ÷∑§) ¬⁄U nfl¥ ∑§ˇÊ ◊¥ ß‹Ä≈˛UÊÚŸ ∑§Ë ªÁÃ
nucleus) of a hydrogen atom due to the
motion of electrons in the n th orbit is ∑§ ∑§Ê⁄UáÊ ©à¬ãŸ ‚◊ÿ-•ÊÒ‚Ã øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ ∑§Ê
proportional to : (n=principal quantum ◊ÊŸ ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ Á∑§‚∑§ ‚◊ʟȬÊÃË „ÊªÊ — (ÿ„Ê° n
number) ◊ÈÅÿ ÄflÊã≈U◊ ‚¥ÅÿÊ „Ò–)
(1) n−4
(2) n−5 (1) n−4
(3) n−3 (2) n−5
15 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
27. The V-I characteristic of a diode is shown 27. ∞∑§ «UÊÿÊ«U ∑§Ê V-I •Á÷‹ˇÊÁáÊ∑§ fl∑˝§ ∑§Ê ÁøòÊ ◊¥
in the figure. The ratio of forward to
ÁŒπÊÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ò– •ª˝ÁŒÁ‡Ê∑§ ÃÕÊ ¬‡øÁŒÁ‡Ê∑§ ’Êÿ‚
reverse bias resistance is :
◊¥ ¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ ∑§Ê •ŸÈ¬Êà „ÊªÊ —
(1) 10
(1) 10
(2) 10 −6
(2) 10 −6
(3) 10 6
(3) 10 6
(4) 100
(4) 100
16 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
28. A signal of frequency 20 kHz and peak 28. 1.2 MHz •ÊflÎÁûÊ ÃÕÊ 25 V Á‡Êπ⁄U flÊÀ≈UÃÊ flÊ‹Ë
voltage of 5 Volt is used to modulate a
∞∑§ flÊ„∑§ Ã⁄¥Uª ∑§Ê 20 kHz •ÊflÎÁûÊ ÃÕÊ Á‡Êπ⁄U
carrier wave of frequency 1.2 MHz and
peak voltage 25 Volts. Choose the correct flÊÀ≈UÃÊU 5 V ∑§ Á‚ÇŸ‹ ‚ ◊Ê«ÈUÁ‹Ã Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò–
statement. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ ‚ ‚„Ë ∑§ÕŸ øÈÁŸÿ–
(1) Modulation index=5, side
frequency bands are at 1400 kHz (1) ◊Ê«ÈU‹Ÿ ‚Íø∑§Ê¥∑§=5, ¬Ê‡fl¸ •ÊflÎÁûÊ ’Òá«U
and 1000 kHz
1400 kHz ÃÕÊ 1000 kHz ¬⁄U „Ò–
(2) Modulation index=5, side
frequency bands are at 21.2 kHz and
18.8 kHz (2) ◊Ê«ÈU‹Ÿ ‚Íø∑§Ê¥∑§=5, ¬Ê‡fl¸ •ÊflÎÁûÊ ’Òá«U
(3) Modulation index=0.8, side 21.2 kHz ÃÕÊ 18.8 kHz ¬⁄U „Ò–
frequency bands are at 1180 kHz
and 1220 kHz
(4) Modulation index=0.2, side
(3) ◊Ê«ÈU‹Ÿ ‚Íø∑§Ê¥∑§=0.8, ¬Ê‡fl¸ •ÊflÎÁûÊ ’Òá«U
frequency bands are at 1220 kHz 1180 kHz ÃÕÊ 1220 kHz ¬⁄U „Ò–
and 1180 kHz
(4) ◊Ê«ÈU‹Ÿ ‚Íø∑§Ê¥∑§=0.2, ¬Ê‡fl¸ •ÊflÎÁûÊ ’Òá«U
29. In a physical balance working on the 1220 kHz ÃÕÊ 1180 kHz ¬⁄U „Ò–
principle of moments, when 5 mg weight
is placed on the left pan, the beam becomes
horizontal. Both the empty pans of the
balance are of equal mass. Which of the 29. ’‹ •ÊÉÊÍáʸ ∑§ Á‚hÊãà ¬⁄U ∑§Êÿ¸ ∑§⁄UŸ flÊ‹Ë ∞∑§
following statements is correct ?
÷ÊÒÁÃ∑§ ÃÈ‹Ê ∑§ ’Ê°ÿ ¬‹«∏ ◊¥ ¡’ 5 mg ÷Ê⁄U ⁄UπÊ
(1) Left arm is longer than the right arm ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÊ ∑§◊ÊŸË ˇÊÒÁá „Ê ¡ÊÃË „Ò– ÃÈ‹Ê ∑§ ŒÊŸÊ¥
(2) Both the arms are of same length ¬‹«∏Ê¥ ∑§Ê Œ˝√ÿ◊ÊŸ ‚◊ÊŸ „Ò– ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ
(3) Left arm is shorter than the right arm ‚Ê ∑§ÕŸ ‚àÿ „Ò?
(4) Every object that is weighed using
this balance appears lighter than its (1) ’Ê°ÿË ÷È¡Ê, ŒÊ°ÿË ÷È¡Ê ‚ ‹ê’Ë „Ò–
actual weight.
(2) ŒÊŸÊ¥ ÷È¡Êÿ¥ ‚◊ÊŸ ‹ê’Ê߸ ∑§Ë „Ò¥–
(3) ’Ê°ÿË ÷È¡Ê, ŒÊ°ÿË ÷È¡Ê ‚ ¿UÊ≈UË „Ò–
(4) ¬˝àÿ∑§ flSÃÈ Á¡‚∑§Ê ß‚ ÃÈ‹Ê ¬⁄U ÃÊÒ‹Ê ¡ÊÃÊ
„Ò, ©‚∑§Ê ÷Ê⁄U •¬Ÿ flÊSÃÁfl∑§ ÷Ê⁄U ‚ ∑§◊
¬˝ÃËà „ÊÃÊ „Ò–
17 VI - PHYSICS
(English+Hindi)
30. A potentiometer PQ is set up to compare 30. ∞∑§ Áfl÷fl◊Ê¬Ë PQ ∑§Ê ŒÊ ¬˝ÁÃ⁄Uʜʥ ∑§Ë ÃÈ‹ŸÊ ∑§⁄UŸ
two resistances as shown in the figure. The
∑§ Á‹ÿ, ÁøòÊÊŸÈ‚Ê⁄U, ‚◊ÊÿÊÁ¡Ã Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– ÿÁŒ
ammeter A in the circuit reads 1.0 A when
two way key K3 is open. The balance point ∑È¥§¡Ë K3 ∑§Ê πÊ‹ ÁŒÿÊ ¡Êÿ ÃÊ •◊Ë≈U⁄U A ◊¥ œÊ⁄UÊ
is at a length l1 cm from P when two way 1.0 A •ÊÃË „Ò– ¡’ ÁmªÊ◊Ë ∑È¥§¡Ë K3 ∑§Ê 2 ÃÕÊ 1
key K3 is plugged in between 2 and 1, while ∑§ ’Ëø ‹ªÊÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÊ ‚¥ÃÈ‹Ÿ Á’ãŒÈ P ‚
the balance point is at a length l2 cm from
l1 cm ŒÍ⁄UË ¬⁄U •ÊÃÊ „Ò, ¡’Á∑§ K3 ∑§Ê 3 ÃÕÊ 1 ∑§
P when key K3 is plugged in between 3
R1
’Ëø ‹ªÊŸ ¬⁄U, ‚¥ÃÈ‹Ÿ Á’ãŒÈ P ‚ l2 cm ŒÍ⁄UË ¬⁄U
and 1. The ratio of two resistances R , is R1
2 •ÊÃÊ „Ò– ŒÊŸÊ¥ ¬˝ÁÃ⁄Uʜʥ ∑§ •ŸÈ¬Êà R2 ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ
found to be :
„ÊªÊ —
l1
(1) l1
l1+l2 (1) l1+l2
l2
(2) l2
l2 −l1 (2) l2 −l1
l1
(3) l1
l1−l2 (3) l1−l2
l1
(4) l1
l2 −l1 (4) l2 −l1
18 VI - PHYSICS
JEE Main 2017 Official Question Paper 1 - Chemistry, April 8
(English+Hindi)
1 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
2 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
6. If the shortest wavelength in Lyman series 6. ÿÁŒ „Êß«˛UÊ¡Ÿ ¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ ∑§Ë ‹Êß◊Ÿ üÊáÊË ∑§Ë ‹ÉÊÈûÊ◊
of hydrogen atom is A, then the longest
Ã⁄¥UªŒÒÉÿ¸ A „Ê ÃÊ He+ ∑§Ë ¬Ê‡ÊŸ üÊáÊË ∑§Ë ŒËÉʸÃ◊
wavelength in Paschen series of He+ is :
Ã⁄¥UªŒÒÉÿ¸ „ÊªË —
5A
(1) 5A
9 (1)
9
9A
(2) 9A
5 (2)
5
36A
(3) 36A
5 (3)
5
36A
(4) 36A
7 (4)
7
3 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
9. The rate of a reaction A doubles on 9. ∞∑§ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ A ∑§Ë Œ⁄U, Ãʬ ∑§Ê 300 ‚ 310 K
increasing the temperature from 300 to
Ã∑§ ’…∏ÊŸ ¬⁄U ŒÈªŸË „Ê ¡ÊÃË „Ò– 300 K ‚ Ãʬ
310 K. By how much, the temperature of
reaction B should be increased from 300 K Á∑§ÃŸÊ ’…∏ÊÿÊ ¡Êÿ Á∑§ ∞∑§ ŒÍ‚⁄UË •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ B ∑§Ë
so that rate doubles if activation energy Œ⁄U ÷Ë ŒÈªŸË „Ê ¡Êÿ ÿÁŒ ß‚ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ B ∑§Ë
of the reaction B is twice to that of ‚Á∑˝§ÿáÊ ™§¡Ê¸ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ A ‚ ŒÈªŸË „Ê–
reaction A.
(1) 9.84 K
(2) 4.92 K (1) 9.84 K
(3) 2.45 K (2) 4.92 K
(4) 19.67 K (3) 2.45 K
(4) 19.67 K
10. The enthalpy change on freezing of 1 mol
of water at 58C to ice at −58C is :
10. 58C ¬⁄U 1 ◊Ê‹ ¡‹ ∑§ Á„◊Ÿ ‚ −58C ¬⁄U ’»¸§
(Given ∆ fus H=6 kJ mol −1 at 08C, ’ŸÊŸ ◊¥ ∞ãÕÒÀ¬Ë ∑§Ê ¬Á⁄UfløŸ „ÊªÊ —
Cp(H2O, l)=75.3 J mol−1 K−1,
Cp(H2O, s)=36.8 J mol−1 K−1) ( ÁŒÿÊ ªÿÊ „Ò ∆ fus H=6 kJ mol−1 at 08C,
(1) 5.44 kJ mol−1 Cp(H2O, l)=75.3 J mol−1 K−1,
Cp(H2O, s)=36.8 J mol−1 K−1)
(2) 5.81 kJ mol−1
(1) 5.44 kJ mol−1
(3) 6.56 kJ mol−1
(2) 5.81 kJ mol−1
(4) 6.00 kJ mol−1
(3) 6.56 kJ mol−1
(4) 6.00 kJ mol−1
11. Which of the following is paramagnetic ?
(1) NO+
(2) CO
11. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê •ŸÈøÈê’∑§Ëÿ „Ò?
(1) NO+
2−
(3) O2 (2) CO
(4) B2 2−
(3) O2
(4) B2
4 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
12. The pair of compounds having metals in 12. Á¡‚ ÿÊÒ Á ª∑§ ÿÈ Ç ◊ ◊ ¥ , œÊÃÈ ∞ ¥ •¬ŸË ©ëøÃ◊
their highest oxidation state is :
•ÊÚÄ‚Ë∑§⁄UáÊ •flSÕÊ ◊¥ „Ò¥, fl„ „Ò —
(1) MnO2 and CrO2Cl2
(1) MnO2 ÃÕÊ CrO2Cl2
(2) [NiCl4]2− and [CoCl4]2−
(3) [Fe(CN)6]3− and [Cu(CN)4]2−
(2) [NiCl4]2− ÃÕÊ [CoCl4]2−
(4) [FeCl4]− and Co2O3 (3) [Fe(CN)6]3− ÃÕÊ [Cu(CN)4]2−
5 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
16. Consider the following ionization 16. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ŒÊ ÃàflÊ¥ ‘A’ ÃÕÊ ‘B’ ∑§Ë •ÊÿŸŸ
enthalpies of two elements ‘A’ and ‘B’.
∞ãÕÒÁÀ¬ÿÊ¥ ¬⁄U ÁfløÊ⁄U ∑§ËÁ¡∞–
Element Ionization enthalpy (kJ/mol)
Ãàfl •ÊÿŸŸ ∞ãÕÒÀ¬Ë (kJ/mol)
st nd rd
1 2 3
¬˝Õ◊ ÁmÃËÿ ÃÎÃËÿ
A 899 1757 14847
A 899 1757 14847
B 737 1450 7731
B 737 1450 7731
Which of the following statements is
correct ? ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ∑§ÕŸ ‚àÿ „Ò?
(1) Both ‘A’ and ‘B’ belong to group-1
where ‘B’ comes below ‘A’. (1) ‘A’ •ÊÒ⁄U ŒÊŸÊ¥ flª¸ 1 ◊¥ ©¬ÁSÕà „Ò¥ ÃÕÊ
‘B’
(2) Both ‘A’ and ‘B’ belong to group-1 ‘B’, ‘A’ ∑§ ŸËø •ÊÃÊ „Ò–
where ‘A’ comes below ‘B’.
(2) ‘A’ •ÊÒ⁄U ‘B’ ŒÊŸÊ¥ flª¸ 1 ◊¥ ©¬ÁSÕà „Ò¥ ÃÕÊ
(3) Both ‘A’ and ‘B’ belong to group-2
where ‘B’ comes below ‘A’. ‘A’, ‘B’ ∑§ ŸËø •ÊÃÊ „Ò–
(4) Both ‘A’ and ‘B’ belong to group-2 (3) ‘A’ •ÊÒ⁄U ‘B’ ŒÊŸÊ¥ flª¸ 2 ◊¥ ©¬ÁSÕà „Ò¥ ÃÕÊ
where ‘A’ comes below ‘B’. ‘B’, ‘A’ ∑§ ŸËø •ÊÃÊ „Ò–
(4) ‘A’ •ÊÒ⁄U ‘B’ ŒÊŸÊ¥ flª¸ 2 ◊¥ ©¬ÁSÕà „Ò¥ ÃÕÊ
17. Consider the following standard electrode ‘A’, ‘B’ ∑§ ŸËø •ÊÃÊ „Ò–
potentials (E8 in volts) in aqueous solution :
6 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
18. A metal ‘M’ reacts with nitrogen gas to 18. ∞∑§ œÊÃÈ ‘M’, ŸÊß≈˛UÊ¡Ÿ ªÒ‚ ∑§ ‚ÊÕ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ
afford ‘M3N’. ‘M3N’ on heating at high
∑§⁄U∑§ M3N ©à¬ãŸ ∑§⁄UÃË „Ò– ©ëø Ãʬ ¬⁄U ª◊¸
temperature gives back ‘M’ and on
reaction with water produces a gas ‘B’. Gas ∑§⁄UŸ ¬⁄U M3N, flÊÁ¬‚ œÊÃÈ M ’ŸÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÕÊ ÿ„
‘B’ reacts with aqueous solution of CuSO4 ¡‹ ∑§ ‚ÊÕ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§⁄U∑§ ∞∑§ ªÒ‚ B ©àåÊãŸ
to form a deep blue compound. ‘M’ and ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– ªÒ‚ B, ¡‹Ëÿ CuSO4 ∑§ ‚ÊÕ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ
‘B’ respectively are :
∑§⁄U∑§ ∞∑§ ª„⁄U ŸË‹ ⁄¥Uª ∑§Ê ÿÊÒÁª∑§ ©àåÊ㟠∑§⁄UÃË „Ò–
(1) Li and NH3 ‘M’ ÃÕÊ ‘B’ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— „Ò¥ —
(2) Ba and N2
(1) Li ÃÕÊ NH3
(3) Na and NH3
(2) Ba ÃÕÊ N2
(4) Al and N2
(3) Na ÃÕÊ NH3
19. The number of S=O and S−OH bonds (4) Al ÃÕÊ N2
present in peroxodisulphuric acid and
pyrosulphuric acid respectively are :
(1) (2 and 2) and (2 and 2) 19. ¬⁄U•ÊÚÄ‚Ê«UÊß‚ÀçÿÍÁ⁄U∑§ •ê‹ ÃÕÊ ¬Êÿ⁄UÊ‚ÀçÿÍÁ⁄U∑§
(2) (2 and 4) and (2 and 4) •ê‹ ◊¥ Áfll◊ÊŸ S=O ÃÕÊ S−OH •Ê’¥œÊ¥ ∑§Ë
‚¥ÅÿÊ∞¥ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— „Ò¥ —
(3) (4 and 2) and (2 and 4)
(4) (4 and 2) and (4 and 2) (1) (2 ÃÕÊ 2) ÃÕÊ (2 ÃÕÊ 2)
(2) (2 ÃÕÊ 4) ÃÕÊ (2 ÃÕÊ 4)
20. A solution containing a group-IV cation (3) (4 ÃÕÊ 2) ÃÕÊ (2 ÃÕÊ 4)
gives a precipitate on passing H 2S. A
solution of this precipitate in dil.HCl (4) (4 ÃÕÊ 2) ÃÕÊ (4 ÃÕÊ 2)
produces a white precipitate with NaOH
solution and bluish-white precipitate with
basic potassium ferrocyanide. The cation 20. ∞∑§ Áfl‹ÿŸ Á¡‚◊¥ ªÈ˝¬-IV ∑§Ê ∞∑§ œŸÊÿŸ Áfll◊ÊŸ
is : „Ò, H2S ¬˝flÊÁ„à ∑§⁄UŸ ¬⁄U ∞∑§ •flˇÊ¬ ©à¬ãŸ ∑§⁄UÃÊ
(1) Co2+ „Ò– ß‚ •flˇÊ¬ ∑§Ê ÃŸÈ HCl ◊¥ ’ŸÊ Áfl‹ÿŸ, NaOH
(2) Ni2+ ∑§ ‚ÊÕ ∞∑§ ‡flà •flˇÊ¬ ÃÕÊ ˇÊÊ⁄UËÿ ¬Ê≈UÁ‡Êÿ◊
(3) Mn2+ »§⁄UÊ‚ÊÿŸÊß«U ∑§ ‚ÊÕ ŸË‹Ê-SÊ$»§Œ •flˇÊ¬ ©à¬ãŸ
(4) Zn2+ ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– ÿ„ œŸÊÿŸ „Ò —
(1) Co2+
(2) Ni2+
(3) Mn2+
(4) Zn2+
7 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
21. A mixture containing the following four 21. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà øÊ⁄U ÿÊÒ Á ª∑§Ê ¥ ∑ § ∞∑§ Á◊üÊáÊ ∑§Ê
compounds is extracted with 1M HCl.
1M HCl ‚ ÁŸc∑§Á·¸Ã Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– fl„ ÿÊÒÁª∑§
The compound that goes to aqueous layer
is : ¡Ê ¡‹Ëÿ ¬⁄Uà ◊¥ ø‹Ê ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò, „Ò —
(III) (IV)
(1) (I) (III) (IV)
8 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
23. Which of the following compounds will 23. ÁãÊêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚ ÿÊÒÁª∑§ ∑§Ë ’ã$¡ËŸ ∑§ ‚ÊÕ
not undergo Friedel Craft’s reaction with
»˝§Ë«U‹ ∑˝§Êç≈˜U‚ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ Ÿ„Ë¥ „ʪË?
benzene ?
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
9 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
25. The major product expected from the 25. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ê ‚¥÷ÊÁflà ◊ÈÅÿ ©à¬ÊŒ
following reaction is :
„Ò —
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
10 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
26. The major product of the following 26. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ê ◊ÈÅÿ ©à¬ÊŒ „Ò —
reaction is :
(1) CH2=CHCH2CH=CHCH3
(1) CH2=CHCH2CH=CHCH3
(2) CH2=CHCH=CHCH2CH 3
(2) CH2=CHCH=CHCH2CH3
(3) CH3CH=C=CHCH2CH3
(3) CH3CH=C=CHCH2CH3
(4) CH3CH=CH−CH=CHCH3
(4) CH3CH=CH−CH=CHCH3
(1) 1, 1-Dimethyl-2-ethylcyclohexane
(2) 2-Ethyl-1,1-dimethylcyclohexane (1) 1, 1-«UÊß◊ÁÕ‹-2-∞ÁÕ‹‚ÊßÄ‹Ê„Ä‚Ÿ
(3) 1-Ethyl-2,2-dimethylcyclohexane
(2) 2-∞ÁÕ‹-1,1-«UÊß◊ÁÕ‹‚ÊßÄ‹Ê„Ä‚Ÿ
(4) 2, 2-Dimethyl-1-ethylcyclohexane
(3) 1-∞ÁÕ‹-2,2-«UÊß◊ÁÕ‹‚ÊßÄ‹Ê„Ä‚Ÿ
(4) 2, 2-«UÊß◊ÁÕ‹-1-∞ÁÕ‹‚ÊßÄ‹Ê„Ä‚Ÿ
11 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
29. The major product of the following 29. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ê ◊ÈÅÿ ©à¬ÊŒ „Ò —
reaction is :
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
12 VI - CHEMISTRY
(English+Hindi)
30. The major product of the following 30. ÁŸêŸ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ê ◊ÈÅÿ ©à¬ÊŒ „Ò —
reaction is :
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
13 VI - CHEMISTRY
JEE Main 2017 Official Question Paper 1 Mathematics, April 8
(English+Hindi)
MATHEMATICS ªÁáÊÃ
1 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
3. Let z e C, the set of complex numbers. Then 3. ◊ÊŸÊ z e C, ¡Ê ‚Áê◊üÊ ‚¥ÅÿÊ•Ê¥ ∑§Ê ‚◊ÈìÊÿ „Ò, ÃÊ
the equation, 2?z+3i?−?z−i?=0
‚◊Ë∑§⁄UáÊ 2?z+3i?−?z−i?=0 ¬˝ŒÁ‡Ê¸Ã ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò —
represents :
8
(1) a circle with radius . 8
3 (1) ∞∑§ flÎûÊ Á¡‚∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ „Ò–
3
10
(2) a circle with diameter . 10
3 (2) ∞∑§ flÎûÊ Á¡‚∑§Ê √ÿÊ‚ „Ò–
3
(3) an ellipse with length of major axis
16 . (3) ∞∑§ ŒËÉʸflÎûÊ Á¡‚∑§ ŒËÉʸ •ˇÊ ∑§Ë ‹¥’Ê߸
3 16 „Ò
(4) an ellipse with length of minor axis 3
2 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
6. If all the words, with or without meaning, 6. ‡ÊéŒ QUEEN ∑§ ‚÷Ë •ˇÊ⁄UÊ¥ ∑§Ê ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§⁄U∑§ ’ŸŸ
are written using the letters of the word
flÊ‹ ‚÷Ë ‡ÊéŒ (Á¡Ÿ∑§Ê •Õ¸ „Ò •ÕflÊ fl •Õ¸„ËŸ
QUEEN and are arranged as in English
dictionary, then the position of the word „Ò¥) ∑§Ê •¥ª˝¡Ë ‡ÊéŒ∑§Ê· ∑§ •ŸÈ‚Ê⁄U ‹ªÊŸ ¬⁄U, ‡ÊéŒ
QUEEN is : QUEEN ∑§Ê SÕÊŸ „Ò —
(1) 44 th
(2) 45 th (1) 44 flʥ
(3) 46 th (2) 45 flʥ
(4) 47 th
(3) 46 flʥ
(4) 47 flʥ
7. If (27) 999 is divided by 7, then the
remainder is :
(1) 1 7. ÿÁŒ (27)999 ∑§Ê 7 ‚ ÷ʪ ÁŒÿÊ ¡Ê∞, ÃÊ ‡Ê·»§‹ „Ò —
(2) 2
(3) 3 (1) 1
(4) 6 (2) 2
(3) 3
8. If the arithmetic mean of two numbers a (4) 6
and b, a > b > 0, is five times their geometric
a+b
mean, then
a−b
is equal to : 8. ÿÁŒ ŒÊ ‚¥ÅÿÊ•Ê¥ a ÃÕÊ b, a > b > 0 ∑§Ê ‚◊Ê¥Ã⁄U
◊Êäÿ (A.M.) ©Ÿ∑§ ªÈáÊÊûÊ⁄U ◊Êäÿ (G.M.) ∑§Ê
6 a+b
(1) 5 ªÈŸÊ „Ò, ÃÊ ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
2 a−b
3 2 6
(2) (1)
4 2
7 3 3 2
(3) (2)
12 4
5 6 7 3
(4) (3)
12 12
5 6
(4)
12
3 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
9. If the sum of the first n terms of the series 9. ÿÁŒ üÊáÊË 3 + 75 + 243 + 507 + .....
3 + 75 + 243 + 507 + ..... is 435 3 ,
∑§ ¬˝Õ◊ n ¬ŒÊ¥ ∑§Ê ÿʪ 435 3 „Ò, ÃÊ n ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
then n equals :
(1) 18
(1) 18
(2) 15
(2) 15
(3) 13
(3) 13
(4) 29
(4) 29
lim 3x − 3
10. is equal to : lim 3x − 3
x →3 2x − 4 − 2 10. x →3
’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
2x − 4 − 2
(1) 3
(1) 3
1
(2) 1
2 (2)
2
3
(3) 3
2 (3)
2
1
(4) 1
2 2 (4)
2 2
4 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
15 15 15 15
12. If y = x+ x 2 −1 + x − x 2 −1 , 12. ÿÁŒ y = x+ x 2 −1 + x − x 2 −1
d2 y dy d2 y dy
then ( x 2 − 1) 2
+x is equal to : „Ò, ÃÊ 2
( x − 1) 2
+x ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
dx dx dx dx
13. If a point P has co-ordinates (0, −2) and 13. ÿÁŒ Á∑§‚Ë Á’ãŒÈ P ∑§ ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§ (0, −2) „Ò¥ ÃÕÊ ∑§Ê߸
Q is any point on the circle,
Á’ãŒÈ Q flÎûÊ x2+y2−5x−y+5=0 ¬⁄U ÁSÕà „Ò,
x2+y2−5x−y+5=0, then the maximum
value of (PQ)2 is : ÃÊ (PQ)2 ∑§Ê •Áœ∑§Ã◊ ◊ÊŸ „Ò —
25 + 6
(1)
2 25 + 6
(1)
2
(2) 14 + 5 3
(2) 14 + 5 3
47 + 10 6
(3)
2 47 + 10 6
(3)
2
(4) 8 +5 3
(4) 8 +5 3
5 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
π π
0 < x < is equal to : 0 < x < ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
2 2
(where C is a constant of integration)
(¡„Ê° C ∞∑§ ‚◊Ê∑§‹Ÿ •ø⁄U „Ò)
4 log sin + C
x
(1) 4 log sin + C
x
2 (1)
2
2 log sin + C
x
(2) 2 log sin + C
x
2 (2)
2
2 log cos + C
x
(3) 2 log cos + C
x
2 (3)
2
4 log cos + C
x
(4) 4 log cos + C
x
2 (4)
2
π
8 cos 2x
∫
4
15. The integral dx π
8 cos 2x
π 3
(tan x + cot x ) 15. ‚◊Ê∑§‹ ∫ π4 dx ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
(tan x + cot x )3
12
12
equals :
15
(1) 15
128 (1)
128
15
(2) 15
64 (2)
64
13
(3) 13
32 (3)
32
13
(4) 13
256 (4)
256
6 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
16. The area (in sq. units) of the smaller portion 16. fl∑˝§Ê¥ x2+y2=4 ÃÕÊ y2=3x ∑§ ’Ëø ÁÉÊ⁄U ¿UÊ≈U
enclosed between the curves, x2+y2=4
÷ʪ ∑§Ê ˇÊòÊ»§‹ (flª¸ ß∑§ÊßÿÊ¥ ◊¥) „Ò —
and y2=3x, is :
1 π
(1) + 1 π
2 3 3 (1) +
2 3 3
1 2π
(2) + 1 2π
3 3 (2) +
3 3
1 2π
(3) + 1 2π
2 3 3 (3) +
2 3 3
1 4π
(4) + 1 4π
3 3 (4) +
3 3
7 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
8 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
20. If the common tangents to the parabola, 20. ÿÁŒ ¬⁄Ufl‹ÿ x2=4y ÃÕÊ flÎûÊ x2+y2=4 ∑§Ë
x2=4y and the circle, x2+y2=4 intersect
©÷ÿÁŸc∆U S¬‡Ê¸ ⁄UπÊ∞° ∞∑§ Á’¥ŒÈ P ¬⁄U ¬˝ÁÃë¿UŒ ∑§⁄UÃË
at the point P, then the distance of P from
the origin, is : „Ò¥, ÃÊ P ∑§Ë ◊Í‹ Á’¥ŒÈ ‚ ŒÍ⁄UË „Ò —
(1) 2 +1
(1) 2 +1
(2) 2(3 + 2 2 )
(2) 2(3 + 2 2 )
(3) 2 ( 2 + 1)
(3) 2 ( 2 + 1)
(4) 3+2 2
(4) 3+2 2
9 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
22. The coordinates of the foot of the 22. ‚◊Ë, Á¡‚◊¥ ŒÊŸÊ¥ ⁄UπÊ∞¥
perpendicular from the point (1, −2, 1)
x +1 y −1 z −3
on the plane containing the lines, = = ÃÕÊ
6 7 8
x +1 y −1 z −3
= = and
6 7 8 x −1 y −2 z −3
= = ÁSÕà „Ò¥, ¬⁄U Á’ãŒÈ
3 5 7
x −1 y −2 z −3
= = , is : (1, −2, 1) ‚ «UÊ‹ ª∞ ‹ê’ ∑§ ¬ÊŒ ∑§ ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§
3 5 7
„Ò¥ —
(1) (2, −4, 2)
(1) (2, −4, 2)
(2) (−1, 2, −1)
(2) (−1, 2, −1)
(3) (0, 0, 0)
(3) (0, 0, 0)
(4) (1, 1, 1)
(4) (1, 1, 1)
r . ( i + 4 j − 2 k ) = 2, is :
→ ∧ ∧ ∧ →
( ∧
r . i +4 j −2 k =2
∧ ∧
) ∑§Ë ¬˝ÁÃë¿UŒË ⁄UπÊ „Ò —
x − 74 y z − 75
(1) = =
−2 7 13 x − 74 y z − 75
(1) = =
−2 7 13
x− 4 z+ 5
7 y 7
(2) = =
2 −7 13 x − 74 y z + 75
(2) = =
2 −7 13
6
x − 13 5
y − 13 z
(3) = = 6 5
2 −7 −13 x − 13 y − 13 z
(3) = =
2 −7 −13
6
x − 13 5
y − 13 z
(4) = = 6 5
2 7 −13 x − 13 y − 13 z
(4) = =
2 7 −13
10 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
11 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
26. Three persons P, Q and R independently 26. ÃËŸ √ÿÁÄà P, Q ÃÕÊ R SflÃ¥òÊ M§¬ ‚ ∞∑§ ÁŸ‡ÊÊŸ
try to hit a target. If the probabilities of
∑§Ê ÷ŒŸ ∑§Ê ¬˝ÿÊ‚ ∑§⁄Uà „Ò¥– ÿÁŒ ©Ÿ∑§ ÁŸ‡ÊÊŸ ∑§Ê
3 1 5
their hitting the target are , and 3 1 5
4 2 8 ÷Œ ¬ÊŸ ∑§Ë ¬˝ÊÁÿ∑§ÃÊ∞¥ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— , ÃÕÊ „Ò¥, ÃÊ
4 2 8
respectively, then the probability that the
target is hit by P or Q but not by R is : P •ÕflÊ Q ∑§ ÁŸ‡ÊÊŸÊ ÷Œ ¬ÊŸ ¬⁄UãÃÈ R ∑§ ÁŸ‡ÊÊŸÊ Ÿ
÷Œ ¬ÊŸ ∑§Ë ¬˝ÊÁÿ∑§ÃÊ „Ò —
21
(1)
64 21
(1)
64
9
(2)
64 9
(2)
64
15
(3)
64 15
(3)
64
39
(4)
64 39
(4)
64
12 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
tan + x is equal to :
π
∑ tan + x
then π
3 „Ò, ÃÊ ∑ ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
xȏS xȏS 3
(1) 4 +2 3 (1) 4 +2 3
(2) −2 + 3 (2) −2 + 3
(3) −2 − 3 (3) −2 − 3
(4) −4 − 2 3 (4) −4 − 2 3
1 + x2 + 1 − x2 1 + x2 + 1 − x2
−1
29. The value of tan , 29. tan−1
1 + x 2 − 1 − x 2 1 + x 2 − 1 − x 2
1 1
x < , x ≠ 0 , is equal to : x < , x ≠ 0, ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „Ò —
2 2
π 1
(1) + cos−1 x 2 (1)
π
+
1
cos−1 x 2
4 2 4 2
π π
(2) + cos−1 x 2 (2) + cos−1 x 2
4 4
π 1
(3) − cos−1 x 2 (3)
π
−
1
cos−1 x 2
4 2 4 2
π π
(4) − cos−1 x 2 (4) − cos−1 x 2
4 4
13 VI - MATHEMATICS
(English+Hindi)
30. The proposition (~p) ∨ (p ∧ ~q) is equivalent 30. ∑§ÕŸ (~p) ∨ (p ∧ ~q) ‚◊ÃÈÀÿ „Ò —
to :
(1) p ∨ ~q
(1) p ∨ ~q
(2) p → ~q
(2) p → ~q
(3) p ∧ ~q
(3) p ∧ ~q
(4) q→p
(4) q→p
-o0o-
-o0o-
14 VI - MATHEMATICS
JEE-Main-Answer-Key-April-8
JEE Main 2016 Question Paper 1 Online (April 9, 2016)
Set - 04 1
1. In the following ‘I’ refers to current and 1. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ ‘I’ ÁfllÈà œÊ⁄UÊ ∑§Ê ∞fl¥ •ãÿ Áøq 1. r_ç_rgrMsdp„ ‘I’ A¡ rhÛysâhpl v$ip®h¡ R>¡ s\p AÞe
other symbols have their usual meaning.
•¬Ÿ ‚Ê◊Êãÿ •Õ¸ ∑§Ê ߥÁªÃ ∑§⁄Uà „Ò¥– ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ◊¥ k„¿epAp¡ s¡_p¡ âQrgs A\®. _uQ¡ Ap`¡g rhL$ë`p¡dp„\u
Choose the option that corresponds to the
dimensions of electrical conductivity : ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ-‚Ê Áfl∑§À¬ flÒlÈà øÊ‹∑§ÃÊ ∑§Ë ‚„Ë Áfl◊Ê ∑§Ê rhÛyshplL$sp_y„ kpQy„ `qfdpZ v$ip®hsp¡ rhL$ë` `k„v$
(1) ML−3 T−3 I2 ’ÃÊÃÊ „Ò? L$fp¡.
(2) M−1 L3 T3 I (1) ML−3 T−3 I2 (1) ML−3 T−3 I2
(3) M−1 L−3 T3 I2 (2) M−1 L3 T3 I (2) M−1 L3 T3 I
(4) M−1 L−3 T3 I (3) M−1 L−3 T3 I2 (3) M−1 L−3 T3 I2
(4) M−1 L−3 T3 I (4) M−1 L−3 T3 I
(2)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(1) 5.0
(1) 5.0 (1) 5.0 (2) 6.7
(2) 6.7 (2) 6.7 (3) 9.4
(3) 9.4 (3) 9.4 (4) 13.3
(4) 13.3 (4) 13.3
6. k|e® (S) t1 _u afs¡ Nrs L$fsp A¡L$ D`N°l_p¡ D`hgeu
∞∑§ ª˝„ ‚Íÿ¸ S ∑§ øÊ⁄UÊ¥ •Ê⁄U ∞∑§ ŒËÉʸflÎûÊËÿ ∑§ˇÊ
6. Figure shows elliptical path abcd of a planet
around the sun S such that the area of
6. dpN® abcd A¡ ApL©$rsdp„ v$ip®h¡g R>¡. Äep„ rÓcyS> csa
abcd ◊¥ ß‚ Ã⁄U„ ‚ øÄ∑§⁄U ‹ªÊÃÊ „Ò Á∑§ csa ÁòÊ÷È¡ •
• _y„ n¡Óam A¡ D`hge_p n¡Óam_y„ R>¡, db A¡ s¡_u
•
triangle csa is the area of the ellipse. (See ∑§Ê ˇÊòÊ»§‹ ŒËÉʸflÎûÊ ∑§ ˇÊòÊ»§‹ ∑§Ê ∞∑§-øÊÒÕÊ߸ „Ò •
figure) With db as the semimajor axis, and (ÿ„Ê° ¬⁄U ac ‹ÉÊÈ-•ˇÊ ∞fl¥ bd ŒËÉʸ-•ˇÊ „Ò)– ÿÁŒ v$uO®-An s\p ca s¡_u gOy-An R>¡. Å¡ D`N°l s¡_p
ca as the semiminor axis. If t1 is the time ª˝„ abc ÃÕÊ cda ∑§ˇÊËÿ ¬ÕÊ¥ ∑§ Á‹∞ ∑˝§◊‡Ê— L$nue `\ abc A_¡ cda dpV¡$ g¡hpsp¡ kde A_y¾$d¡ t1
taken for planet to go over path abc and t2 t1 ÃÕÊ t2 ∑§Ê ‚◊ÿ ‹ÃÊ „Ò, Ã’ — A_¡ t2 lp¡e sp¡ :
for path taken over cda then :
Consider a water jar of radius R that has ∞∑§ R ÁòÊíÿÊ ∑§ ¬ÊŸË ∑§ ¡Ê⁄, Á¡‚ ¬ÊŸË ‚ H ™°§øÊ߸ R rÓÄep ^fphsp A¡L$ `pZu_p Åfdp„ H KQpC ky^u_y„
water filled up to height H and is kept on a Ã∑§ ÷⁄UÊ ªÿÊ „Ò, ∑§Ê h ™°§øÊ߸ ∑§ S≈Ò¥U«U ¬⁄U ⁄UπÊ ªÿÊ „Ò `pZu cf¡gy A_¡ s¡_¡ h KQpC_p õV¡$ÞX$ `f fpM¡g R>¡
stand of height h (see figure). Through a
hole of radius r (r << R) at its bottom, the
(ÁøòÊ Œπ¥)– Ë ◊¥ ∞∑§ ¿UÊ≈U Á¿UŒ˝, Á¡‚∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ r s¡d ^pfp¡. (ApL©$rs Sy>Ap¡) Åf_p smue¡ r -rÓÄep_p
water leaks out and the stream of water „Ò (r << R), ‚ ŸËø Áª⁄Uà „È∞ ¬ÊŸË ∑§Ë œÊ⁄U ∞∑§ A¡L$ L$pZpdp„\u (r << R) `pZu r_L$m¡ R>¡ S>¡ N°pDÞX$
coming down towards the ground has a “∑§Ë¬” ∑§Ê •Ê∑§Ê⁄U œÊ⁄UáÊ ∑§⁄UÃË „Ò– ÿÁŒ ÷ÍÁ◊ ∑§ Ë sfa _pmQp_p ApL$pfdp„ Å¡hp dm¡ R>¡. Ap `pZu_u
shape like a funnel as shown in the figure. ¬⁄U ¬ÊŸË ∑§Ë œÊ⁄U ∑§ •ŸÈ¬˝SÕ ∑§Ê≈U ∑§Ë ÁòÊíÿÊ x „Ò, ^pfp Äepf¡ S>du__¡ AX¡$ R>¡ Ðepf¡ s¡_p ApX$R>¡v$_u rÓÄep
If the radius of the cross-section of water
stream when it hits the ground is x. Then : Ã’ — x R>¡ sp¡ :
• • •
• •• ••• • •• •••
• •• •••
• •• ••
(1)
• •• ••
(1)
• •• ••
(1)
• •
• • •
• • • • • •• •••
• •• ••• • •• ••• (2)
• •• ••
(2)
• •• ••
(2)
• •• ••
• •
• • •
• • • • • •• •••
• •• ••• • •• ••• (3)
• •• ••
(3)
• •• ••
(3)
• •• ••
• •
• • •
• • •• ••• • •• •••
• •• ••• (4) (4)
• •• ••
(4)
• •• ••
• •• ••
9. The ratio of work done by an ideal 9. Á∑§‚Ë ‚◊÷ÊÁ⁄U∑§ ¬˝Á∑˝§ÿÊ ◊¥ ∞∑§ •ÊŒ‡Ê¸ ∞∑§¬⁄U◊ÊáÊÈ∑§ 9. L$p¡C kdcpqfL$ âq¾$epdp„ A¡L$ Apv$i® A¡L$ `fdpÎhue
monoatomic gas to the heat supplied to it ªÒ‚ ∑§ mÊ⁄UÊ Á∑§ÿ ª∞ ∑§Êÿ¸ ÃÕÊ ©‚ ŒË ªß¸ ™§c◊Ê ∑§Ê hpey Üpfp \sp L$pe® s\p s¡_¡ Ap`hpdp„ Aphsu Dódp_p¡
in an isobaric process is :
•ŸÈ¬Êà „ÊªÊ — NyZp¡Ñf R>¡ :
•
• •
•
(1)
•
(1)
•
(1)
•
• •
•
(2)
•
(2)
•
(2)
•
• •
•
(3)
•
(3)
•
(3)
•
• •
•
(4)
•
(4)
•
(4)
In the circuit shown, the resistance r is a ÁŒÿ „È∞ ¬Á⁄U¬Õ ◊¥ r ∞∑§ ø⁄U-¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ „Ò– ÿÁŒ Ap`¡g `qf`\dp„ r A¡L$ Qg Ahfp¡^ R>¡. Å¡ r=f R
r=f R, Ã’ r ◊¥ ™§c◊Ê ©à¬ÊŒŸ •Áœ∑§Ã◊ „ÊŸ ∑§ dpV¡$ r dp„ dlÑd Dódp DÐ`Þ_ \pe sp¡ f _u qL„$ds
variable resistance. If for r=f R, the heat
generation in r is maximum then the value
of f is : Á‹ÿ f ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „ÊªÊ — \i¡ :
• • •
• •
(1) (1)
•
(1)
• • •
• •
(2) (2)
•
(2)
• • •
• •
(3) (3)
•
(3)
15. A magnetic dipole is acted upon by two 15. ∞∑§ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ Ámœ˝Èfl ¬⁄U ŒÊ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ, ¡Ê •Ê¬‚ 15. A¡L$buÅ_u kpd¡ 75 _p MyZp¡ Y$msp b¡ Qy„bL$ue n¡Óp¡
magnetic fields which are inclined to each ◊¥ 75 ∑§ÊáÊ ’ŸÊà „Ò¥, ∞∑§ ‚ÊÕ Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§⁄Uà „Ò¥– ÿÁŒ `f A¡L$ Qy„bL$ue qÜ-^y°h (Dipole) L$pe®fs R>¡. L$p¡C
ÿ„ Ámœ˝Èfl ‚¥ÃÈ‹Ÿ ∑§Ë •flSÕÊ ◊¥ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ¬˝⁄UáÊ
other at an angle of 75. One of the fields
has a magnitude of 15 mT. The dipole
A¡L$ n¡Ó_y„ dyëe 15 mT R>¡ A_¡ Ap n¡Ó kp\¡ 30 _p
attains stable equilibrium at an angle of 30 15 mT ∑§ ∞∑§ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ ‚ 30 ∑§Ê ∑§ÊáÊ ’ŸÊÃÊ MyZp\u X$pe`p¡g õ\peu k„sygus Ahõ\p âpá L$f¡ R>¡.
with this field. The magnitude of the other „Ò, ÃÊ ŒÍ‚⁄U øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ˇÊòÊ ∑§ øÈê’∑§Ëÿ ¬̋⁄UáÊ ∑§Ê ‹ª÷ª buÅ n¡Ó_y„ dyëe (mT dp„) Apif¡ li¡ :
field (in mT ) is close to : ◊ÊŸ ( mT ◊¥ ) „ÊªÊ — (1) 11
(1) 11 (2) 36
(1) 11
(2) 36 (3) 1
(2) 36
(3) 1 (4) 1060
(3) 1
(4) 1060
(4) 1060
(1) (1)
(1)
(2)
(2) (2)
(3)
(3) (3)
(4)
(4) (4)
OR ª≈U
(2) OR - Gate
(2)
(3) NAND - Gate
(3) NAND ª≈U
(4) NOR - Gate
(4) NOR ª≈U
•
(1) α •
•
(2)
(2)
• •
•
(2) (3) 2α
(3) 2α
•
(3) 2α •
•
(4)
(4)
• •
•
(4)
48. Which one of the following complexes will 48. ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà ‚¥∑ȧ‹Ê¥ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ‚¥∑ȧ‹ Ag(NO3) 48. _uQ¡ Ap`¡gp k„L$uZp£dp„\u L$e„y A¡L$ Ag(NO3) _p S>gue
consume more equivalents of aqueous ∑§ ¡‹Ëÿ Áfl‹ÿŸ ∑§ •Áœ∑§ ‚◊ÃÈÀÿ π¬ÊÿªÊ ? ÖphZ_u Ar^L$ syëesp_p¡ D`ep¡N L$fi¡ ?
solution of Ag(NO3) ? (1) Na3[CrCl6]
(1) Na3[CrCl6]
(1) Na3[CrCl6] (2) [Cr(H2O)5Cl]Cl2
(2) [Cr(H2O)5Cl]Cl2
(2) [Cr(H2O)5Cl]Cl2 (3) [Cr(H2O)6]Cl3
(3) [Cr(H2O)6]Cl3
(3) [Cr(H2O)6]Cl3 (4) Na2[CrCl5(H2O)]
(4) Na2[CrCl5(H2O)]
(4) Na2[CrCl5(H2O)]
58. ∞S¬ÊÁ≈¸U∑§ •ê‹ ∑§ ÁŸêŸÁ‹Áπà •ŸÈ∑˝§◊ ¬⁄U ÁfløÊ⁄U 58. A¡õ`pqV®$L$ A¡rkX$ dpV¡$ _uQ¡_p¡ ¾$d Ýep_dp„ gp¡.
58. Consider the following sequence for
aspartic acid : ∑§ËÁ¡∞ —
62. The point represented by 2+i in the 62. •Ê⁄Uªá«U ‚◊Ë ◊¥ 2+i mÊ⁄UÊ ÁŸÁŒ¸c≈U Á’¥ŒÈ, 1 ß∑§Ê߸ 62. ApN®ÞX$ kdsgdp„ 2+i \u v$ip®h¡g tbvy$ A¡L$ A¡L$d
Argand plane moves 1 unit eastwards, then ¬Ífl¸ ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ ø‹ÃÊ „Ò •ÊÒ⁄U Á»§⁄U 2 ß∑§Ê߸ ©ûÊ⁄U ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ `|h® sfa Mk¡ R>¡, Ðepfbpv$ 2 A¡L$d DÑf sfa Mk¡ R>¡
2 units northwards and finally from there
ø‹ÃÊ „Ò ÃÕÊ •ãà ◊¥ • • ß∑§Ê߸ ŒÁˇÊáÊ-¬Á‡ø◊ A_¡ Ðep„\u R>¡hV¡$ • • A¡L$d _¥F>Ðe sfa Mk¡ R>¡.
• • units in the south-westwards ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò– ÃÊ •Ê⁄Uªá«U ‚◊Ë ◊¥ ß‚∑§Ê ŸÿÊ ApN®ÞX$ kdsgdp„ Ap tbvy$_y„ _hy„ õ\p_ L$C k„¿ep\u
direction. Then its new position in the
Argand plane is at the point represented SÕÊŸ Á¡‚ Á’¥ŒÈ mÊ⁄UÊ ÁŸÁŒ¸c≈U „ÊÃÊ „Ò, fl„ „Ò — v$ip®hhpdp„ Aph¡ ?
by : (1) 2+2i (1) 2+2i
(1) 2+2i (2) 1+i (2) 1+i
(2) 1+i (3) −1−i (3) −1−i
(3) −1−i (4) −2−2i (4) −2−2i
(4) −2−2i
• • • •
• • •• •• • • • • • • • •
• •
If • •• •• • , • •• •• • • •• •• • • •• ••
• •• • •• •• • • • •• •• • •
64. and
• • • • •• ÿÁŒ • , • •• •• ÃÕÊ Å¡ • , • •• •• A_¡
•• • • •• • ••
64. 64.
• • •
•
•
• • • • •• • • • • ••
•• • • •• • •
• • • • • • • •
Q=PAPT, then PT Q2015 P is :
Q=PAPT „Ò, ÃÊ PT Q2015 P „Ò — Q=PAPT lp¡e sp¡ PT Q2015 P bfpbf :
•• •••••
(1) •• • •• •• ••••• •• •••••
• ••
(1) •• • ••
(1)
• • ••
•
•• • • • • •
(2) • • • • • • •• •• • • • • • •• • • • • •
• • •
(2) • • • • • • ••
(2)
• • • • • ••
•
•• • • • • •
(3) • • • • • • •• •• • • • • • •• • • • • •
• • •
(3) • • • • • • ••
(3)
• • • • • ••
•
•• •••••
(4) •• • •• •• ••••• •• •••••
• ••
(4) •• • ••
(4)
• • ••
•
68. ◊ÊŸÊ x, y, z ∞‚Ë œŸÊà◊∑§ flÊSÃÁfl∑§ ‚¥ÅÿÊ∞° „Ò¥ Á∑§, 68. ^pfp¡ L¡$ ^_ hpõsrhL$ k„¿epAp¡ x, y, z A¡hu R>¡ L¡$ S>¡\u
x+y+z=12 A_¡ x3y4z5=(0.1) (600)3. sp¡
68. Let x, y, z be positive real numbers
such that x+y+z=12 and x+y+z=12 ÃÕÊ x3y4z5=(0.1) (600)3 „Ò, ÃÊ
x3+y3+z3=
x3y4z5=(0.1) (600)3. Then x3+y3+z3 is x3+y3+z3 ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
equal to : (1) 270
(1) 270
(1) 270 (2) 258
(2) 258
(2) 258 (3) 342
(3) 342
(3) 342 (4) 216
(4) 216
(4) 216
•• ••
• • • •
••• • •+ − • = • • ••• • •+ − • = • • •
• •
•• ÿÁŒ „Ò, ÃÊ ‘a’ ’⁄UÊ’⁄U 70. Å¡ sp¡ ‘a’ =
• •
70.
70.
•
If ••• • •+ − • = • • then ‘a’ is • →∞ • • →∞ •
• →∞ • • „Ò — (1) 2
equal to :
(1) 2 •
(1) 2
•
(2)
•
•
•
(2)
•
•
(2)
•
(3)
•
•
•
(3)
•
•
(3)
•
(4)
•
•
•
(4)
•
(4)
72. ÿÁŒ fl∑˝§ x=4t2+3, y=8t3−1, t R ∑§ Á’¥ŒÈ P, 72. Å¡ h¾$ x=4t2+3, y=8t3−1, t R, _p¡ P tbvy$
72. If the tangent at a point P, with parameter
t, on the curve x=4t2+3, y=8t3−1, t R, t ¬˝Êø‹ ∑§ ‚ÊÕ, ¬⁄U S¬‡Ê¸ ⁄UπÊ, fl∑˝§ ∑§Ê ŒÈ’Ê⁄UÊ Á’¥ŒÈ ApNm_p¡ õ`i®L$, âpQg t kp\¡, h¾$_¡ afuhpf Q tbvy$A¡
meets the curve again at a point Q, then the Q ¬⁄U Á◊‹ÃË „Ò, ÃÊ Q ∑§ ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§ „Ò¥ — dm¡ R>¡ sp¡ Q tbvy$_p„ epd R>¡:
coordinates of Q are : (1) (t2+3, −t3−1) (1) (t2+3, −t3−1)
(1) (t2+3, −t3−1) (2) (4t2+3, −8t3−1) (2) (4t2+3, −8t3−1)
(2) (4t2+3, −8t3−1) (3) (t2+3, t3−1) (3) (t2+3, t3−1)
(3) (t2+3, t3−1) (4) (16t2+3, −64t3−1) (4) (16t2+3, −64t3−1)
(4) (16t2+3, −64t3−1)
74. If
74. ÿÁŒ 74. Å¡
••
•
• ( •• • • )• • • ( •• • • )• • • • •• ••
•• • • • •••• • •
•
• ( •• • • )• • • ( •• • • )• • • •
• ( •• • • )• • • ( •• • • )• • • •
•• • • • •••• • • •• • • • •••• • •
where k is a constant of integration, then
A+B+C equals : „Ò, ¡„Ê° k ‚◊Ê∑§‹Ÿ •ø⁄U „Ò, ÃÊ A+B+C ’⁄UÊ’⁄U Äep„ k A¡ k„L$g__p¡ AQmp„L$ R>¡, sp¡ A+B+C=
•• „Ò — ••
•
(1)
•
(1)
••
•
(1)
•• ••
•
(2)
•
(2)
••
•
(2)
• •
••
(3)
••
(3)
•
••
(3)
•• ••
••
(4)
••
(4)
••
••
(4)
• • • •
78. If a variable line drawn through the • • • • f¡ M pAp¡ •• • •• •• A_¡ •• • •• •• _p„
78. ÿÁŒ ⁄ U π Ê•Ê ¥ •• • •• •• ÃÕÊ •• • •• •• 78.
• • • •
• • • • • •
•• • •• •• and R>¡v$dp„\u `kpf \su A¡L$ Qrgs f¡Mp epdpnp¡_¡ tbvy$Ap¡
intersection of the lines
• • ∑§ ¬˝ÁÃë¿UŒŸ ‚ „Ê∑§⁄U ¡ÊŸ flÊ‹Ë ∞∑§ ø⁄U ⁄UπÊ ß‚
A A_¡ B, (A ≠ B) dp„ dm¡ R>¡. f¡MpM„X$ AB _p
• • ¬˝∑§Ê⁄U πË¥øË ªß¸ „Ò Á∑§ ÿ„ ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§ •ˇÊÊ¥ ∑§Ê
•• • •• •• , meets the coordinate axes at dÝetbvy$_p¡ tbvy$`\ L$ep kduL$fZ_y„ kdp^p_ L$fi¡ ?
• • A ÃÕÊ B, (A ≠ B) ¬⁄U Á◊‹ÃË „Ò, ÃÊ AB ∑§ ◊äÿÁ’¥ŒÈ
A and B, (A ≠ B), then the locus of the ∑§Ê Á’¥ŒÈ¬Õ „Ò — (1) 6xy=7(x+y)
midpoint of AB is : (2) 4(x+y)2−28(x+y)+49=0
(1) 6xy=7(x+y)
(1) 6xy=7(x+y) (3) 7xy=6(x+y)
(2) 4(x+y)2−28(x+y)+49=0
(2) 4(x+y)2−28(x+y)+49=0 (4) 14(x+y)2−97(x+y)+168=0
(3) 7xy=6(x+y)
(3) 7xy=6(x+y) (4) 14(x+y)2−97(x+y)+168=0
(4) 14(x+y)2−97(x+y)+168=0
80. A circle passes through (−2, 4) and touches 80. ∞∑§ flÎûÊ Á’¥ŒÈ (−2, 4) ‚ „Ê ∑§⁄U ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò ÃÕÊ y-•ˇÊ 80. A¡L$ hsy®m (−2, 4) dp„\u `kpf \pe R>¡ A_¡
the y-axis at (0, 2). Which one of the ∑§Ê (0, 2) ¬⁄U S¬‡Ê¸ ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò– ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ ‚Ê ∞∑§ y-An_¡ tbvy$ (0, 2) ApNm õ`i£ R>¡. _uQ¡_pdp„\u
‚◊Ë∑§⁄UáÊ ß‚ flÎûÊ ∑§ √ÿÊ‚ ∑§Ê ÁŸM§Á¬Ã ∑§⁄UÃÊ „Ò?
following equations can represent a
diameter of this circle ?
L$ey„ kduL$fZ Ap hsy®m_p„ ìepk_¡ kdphsu f¡Mp
(1) 4x+5y−6=0 (1) 4x+5y−6=0 v$ip®hi¡ ?
(2) 2x−3y+10=0 (2) 2x−3y+10=0 (1) 4x+5y−6=0
(3) 3x+4y−3=0 (3) 3x+4y−3=0 (2) 2x−3y+10=0
(4) 5x+2y+4=0 (4) 5x+2y+4=0 (3) 3x+4y−3=0
(4) 5x+2y+4=0
81. Let a and b respectively be the semi- 81. ◊ÊŸÊ a ÃÕÊ b ∑˝§◊‡Ê—, ∞∑§ •Áì⁄Ufl‹ÿ Á¡‚∑§Ë
transverse and semi-conjugate axes of a ©à∑¥§Œ˝ÃÊ ‚◊Ë∑§⁄UáÊ 9e2−18e+5=0 ∑§Ê ‚¥ÃÈc≈U ∑§⁄UÃË 81. ^pfp¡ L¡$ a A_¡ b A_y¾$d¡ A¡ Arshge_p„ A^® dy¿eAn
hyperbola whose eccentricity satisfies the „Ò, ∑§ •œ¸•ŸÈ¬˝SÕ •ˇÊ ÃÕÊ •œ¸‚¥ÿÈÇ◊Ë •ˇÊ „Ò¥– A_¡ A^® A_ybÝ^ An_p„ dp` R>¡ S>¡_u DÐL¡$ÞÖsp
equation 9e2−18e+5=0. If S(5, 0) is a focus
and 5x=9 is the corresponding directrix of ÿÁŒ S(5, 0) ß‚ •Áì⁄Ufl‹ÿ ∑§Ë ∞∑§ ŸÊÁ÷ ÃÕÊ kduL$fZ 9e2−18e+5=0 _y„ kdp^p_ L$f¡ R>¡. Å¡
this hyperbola, then a2−b2 is equal to : 5x=9 ‚¥ªÃ ÁŸÿãÃÊ (directrix) „Ò, ÃÊ a2−b2 ’⁄UÊ’⁄U S(5, 0) A¡ _prc A_¡ A_yê$` r_eprdL$p 5x=9 lp¡e
(1) 7 „Ò — sp¡ Ap Arshge dpV¡$ a2−b2 bfpbf :
(2) −7 (1) 7 (1) 7
(3) 5 (2) −7 (2) −7
(4) −5 (3) 5 (3) 5
(4) −5 (4) −5
SET - 04 ENGLISH SET - 04 HINDI SET - 04 GUJARATI
Set - 04 43
•• •• •• ••
82. If the tangent at a point on the ellipse
• • ÿÁŒ ŒËÉʸflÎûÊ •• • •• •• ∑§ ∞∑§ Á’¥ŒÈ ¬⁄U πË¥øË Å¡ D`hge •• • •• •• _p¡ õ`i®L$, epdpnp¡_¡
• • 82.
•• •
82.
•• •
•• • •• •• meets the coordinate axes at
•• • ªß¸ S¬‡Ê¸ ⁄UπÊ, ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§ •ˇÊÊ¥ ∑§Ê A ÃÕÊ B ¬⁄U Á◊‹ÃË A A_¡ B tbvy$dp„ dmsp¡ lp¡s s\p Å¡ O ENdtbvy$
A and B, and O is the origin, then the
„Ò ÃÕÊ O ◊Í‹ Á’¥ŒÈ „Ò, ÃÊ ÁòÊ÷È¡ OAB ∑§Ê ãÿÍŸÃ◊ lp¡e sp¡ rÓL$p¡Z OAB _y„ gOyÑd n¡Óam (Qp¡.A¡L$ddp„)
minimum area (in sq. units) of the triangle
OAB is : ˇÊòÊ»§‹ (flª¸ ß∑§ÊßÿÊ¥ ◊¥) „Ò — L¡$V$gy„ \pe ?
• • •
• •
(1) (1)
•
(1)
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
∧ ∧ ∧ • i • j • k ••• i • • j • p k
• • • • • • • • ÃÕÊ A_y ¾ $d¡ • i • j • k ••• i • • j • p k
• • • • • • • • A_¡
and • i •• •q j •• •• k • then the point (p, q) lies
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
on a line : • i •• •q j •• •• k „Ò¥, ÃÊ Á’¥ŒÈ (p, q) Á¡‚ ⁄UπÊ ¬⁄U • i •• •q j •• •• k lp¡e sp¡, tbvy$ (p, q) S>¡ f¡Mp D`f
ÁSÕÃ „Ò, fl„ —
(1) parallel to x-axis.
Aph¡g R>¡ s¡
(2) parallel to y-axis.
(3) making an acute angle with the (1) x-•ˇÊ ∑§ ‚◊Ê¥Ã⁄U „Ò– (1) x-An_¡ kdp„sf R>¡.
positive direction of x-axis. (2) y-•ˇÊ ∑§ ‚◊Ê¥Ã⁄U „Ò– (2) y-An_¡ kdp„sf R>¡.
(4) making an obtuse angle with the (3) x-•ˇÊ ∑§Ë œŸÊà◊∑§ ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ‚ ãÿÍŸ ∑§ÊáÊ ’ŸÊÃË (3) ^_ x-An kp\¡ gOyL$p¡Z b_ph¡ R>¡.
positive direction of x-axis.
„Ò– (4) ^_ x-An kp\¡ NyfyL$p¡Z b_ph¡ R>¡.
(4) x-•ˇÊ ∑§Ë œŸÊà◊∑§ ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ‚ •Áœ∑§ ∑§ÊáÊ
’ŸÊÃË „Ò–
• • • •
=1 is : • ••• • • • • • •• • • • •• • • •• • • • • • • ••• • •
• • • •
=1, „Ò —
(1) 2
(1) 2 =1 lp¡e s¡hp L¡$V$gp x dmi¡ ?
(2) 4
(2) 4 (1) 2
(3) 6
(3) 6 (2) 4
(4) 8
(4) 8 (3) 6
(4) 8
SET - 04 ENGLISH SET - 04 HINDI SET - 04 GUJARATI
Set - 04 46
89. If m and M are the minimum and the ÿÁŒ m ÃÕÊ M, √ÿ¥¡∑§ •
• •• • ••• • • • •• •• •• • • • •
89.
maximum values of 89. Å¡ m A_¡ M A¡ •
•
• • •• • ••• • • • •• •• •• • • • • x R ∑ § ∑˝ § ◊‡Ê— _p„ Þe|_sd A_¡ dlÑd d|ëep¡ lp¡e sp¡ M−m
• •• • ••• • • • •• •• •• • • • • x R, then • xR
• _u qL„$ds L¡$V$gu \i¡ ?
ãÿÍŸÃ◊ ÃÕÊ •Áœ∑§Ã◊ ◊ÊŸ „Ò¥, ÃÊ M−m ’⁄UÊ’⁄U
M−m is equal to :
„Ò — ••
•• (1)
•
••
•
(1)
•
(1)
•
• (2)
•
•
•
(2)
•
(2)
•
• (3)
•
•
•
(3)
•
(3)
•
• (4)
•
•
•
(4)
•
(4)
90. Consider the following two statements : 90. ÁŸêŸ ŒÊ ∑§ÕŸÊ¥ ¬⁄U ÁfløÊ⁄U ∑§ËÁ¡∞ — 90. _uQ¡_p b¡ rh^p_p¡ Ap`¡g R>¡ :
P : If 7 is an odd number, then 7 is P : ÿÁŒ 7 ∞∑§ Áfl·◊ ‚¥ÅÿÊ „Ò, ÃÊ 7, 2 ‚ ÷Êíÿ P : Å¡ 7 A¡ AeyÁd k„¿ep lp¡e sp¡ 7 _¡ 2 hX¡$
divisible by 2. „Ò– r_:i¡j cpNu iL$pe R>¡.
Q : If 7 is a prime number, then 7 is an
Q : ÿÁŒ 7 ∞∑§ •÷Êíÿ ‚¥ÅÿÊ „Ò, ÃÊ 7 ∞∑§ Áfl·◊ Q : Å¡ 7 A¡ ArhcpÄe k„¿ep lp¡e sp¡ 7 AeyÁd
odd number.
‚¥ÅÿÊ „Ò– R>¡.
If V1 is the truth value of the contrapositive
of P and V 2 is the truth value of ÿÁŒ V1, P ∑§ ¬˝ÁÃœŸÊà◊∑§ ∑§Ê ‚àÿ◊ÊŸ „Ò ÃÕÊ Å¡ V1 A¡ P dp„ kdp_p\} â¡fZ (contrapositive)
contrapositive of Q, then the ordered pair V2, Q ∑§ ¬˝ÁÃœŸÊà◊∑§ ∑§Ê ‚àÿ◊ÊŸ „Ò, ÃÊ ∑˝§Á◊à ÿÈÇ◊ _y„ kÐep\®sp d|ëe A_¡ V2 A¡ Q _p kdp_p\} â¡fZ_p„
(V1, V2) equals :
(V1, V2) ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò — kÐep\®sp d|ëe lp¡e sp¡ ¾$dey¼s Å¡X$ (V1, V2) bfpbf:
(1) (T, T)
(1) (T, T) (1) (T, T)
(2) (T, F)
(2) (T, F) (2) (T, F)
(3) (F, T)
(3) (F, T) (3) (F, T)
(4) (F, F)
(4) (F, F) (4) (F, F)
-oOo-
-oOo- -oOo-
5. In the figure shown ABC is a uniform wire. 5. ÁŒÿ ªÿ ÁøòÊ ◊¥ ÃÊ⁄U ABC ∞∑§ ‚◊ÊŸ „Ò– ÿÁŒ 5. ApL©$rÑdp„ v$ip®ìep dyS>b ABC A¡ kdp_ spf R>¡. Å¡
If centre of mass of wire lies vertically below ‚¥„ÁÃ-∑§ãŒ˝ Á’¥ŒÈ A ∑ ™§äflʸœ⁄U ŸËø ÁSÕà „Ò, Ã’ spf_y„ Öìedp_ L¡$ÞÖ tbvy$ A _u bfp¡bf _uQ¡ Aphsy„
•• •• ••
point A, then
• •
is close to : ‹ª÷ª „Ò — lp¡e sp¡ _y„ d|ëe _________ _u _ÆL$_y„ \i¡.
• • • •
• •• •• • •• •
•• • „Ò– [õ\rsdp„ R>¡.
••
(2)
•• • •• •
• •• •• • •• • • •• •• • •• •
•• ••
(2) (2)
•• • •• •
•• •• • •• •
•• •• •• •• ••
(3)
•• • •• • •• • •• •
•• •• • •• • •• •• • •• •
•• •• •• •• •• •• •• •• •• ••
(3) (3)
•• •
• • •• •
•• •• •• ••
(4)
•• • •• •
• • •• • • • •• •
•• •• •• •• •• •• •• ••
(4) (4)
••
•• •
••
(1)
•• ••
•• • •• •
••
(1)
••
(1)
••
(2) •• •
•• •• ••
(2) •• • •• •
••
(2)
•• ••
(3) •• •
•• •• ••
(3) •• • •• •
•• ••
(3)
••
•• •
••
(4)
•• ••
•• • •• •
••
(4)
••
(4)
(4) 300 J
π • • • • •• π • • • • ••
(4)
τ•
(4)
τ•
(4)
τ•
•
∧
( ∧
•• • • ••• ••• •• • •−• • , ) •
•
→
• •= ( ∧ ∧
•• • • ••• ••• •• • •−• • ) A_¡
→
• •=
•
•
(
•• • • ••• ••• •• • •−• •
∧ ∧
) and the →
B •• •
•
( ∧
•Byz ••x, •t •• y •• • z
∧
)
•
•
• Qy„bL$ue n¡Ó
magnetic field is
•
→
B •• •
• ∧
( ∧
•Byz ••x, •t •• y •• • z ) (2) +x ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ øÊÁ‹Ã flÒlÈÃ-øÈê’∑§Ëÿ Ã⁄¥Uª ∑§ →
B •• •
•
∧
( ∧
•Byz ••x, •t •• y •• • z ) \i¡.
• •
(2) For an electromagnetic wave
Á‹ÿ
→
• •• •
•
∧
(∧
•• • • • • •• •••• •• • •• • • , ) (2) +x -qv$ipdp„ Nrs L$fsp rhÛysQy„bL$ue sf„N
propagating in +x direction the dpV¡$ rhÛys n¡Ó
•
electric field is
→
• •• •
•
∧
( ∧
•• • • •• • •• •••• •• • •• • • ) → •
(
∧ ∧
) A_¡
• •• • •• • • • • •• •••• •• • •• • •
•
→
• •• •
•
∧
( ∧
•• • • • • •• •••• •• • •• • • ) and (3) +y ÁŒ‡ÊÊ ◊¥ ø‹ ⁄U„Ë flÒlÈÃ-øÈê’∑§Ëÿ Ã⁄¥Uª ∑§
•
Qy„bL$ue n¡Ó
→ • ∧
the magnetic field is
Á‹ÿ • •• • •• • • •• • •• • •• • , •
→ •
( ∧ ∧
) •
→
• •• •
•
∧
( ∧
•• • • •• • •• •••• •• • •• • • ) \i¡.
• •• • •• • • •• • •• •••• •• • •• • •
• → • ∧
B •• • •Byz ••x, •t •• z - qv$ipdp„ Nrs L$fsp rhÛysQy„bL$ue sf„N
•
(3) +y
(3) For an electromagnetic wave
→ • ∧
propagating in +y direction the dpV¡$ rhÛys n¡Ó • •• • •• • • •• • •• • •• •
→ • ∧ •
electric field is • •• • •• • • •• • •• • •• •
• → • ∧
A_¡ Qy„bL$ue n¡Ó B •• • •Byz •• x, •t •• z
and the magnetic field is •
→ • ∧ \i¡.
B •• • •Byz •• x, •t •• z
•
(1) (1)
(1)
(2)
(2) (2)
(3)
(3) (3)
30. The ratio (R) of output resistance r0, and 30. Á∑§‚Ë ≈˛UÊ¥Á¡S≈U⁄U ∑§Ë ÁŸfl‡Ê-ÁŸª¸◊ •Á÷‹ÊˇÊÁáÊ∑§ 30. V²$p[ÞTõV$f_u C_`yV$ A_¡ ApDV$`yV$ gpnrZL$sp_p
the input resistance ri in measurements of
◊ʬŸ ∑ § Á‹ÿ ¬˝ ÿ È Ä Ã ÁŸª¸ ◊ -¬˝ Á Ã⁄U Ê œ (r 0) fl dp`_dp„ ApDV$`yV$ Ahfp¡^ r0 A_¡ C_`yV$ Ahfp¡^ ri
input and output characteristics of a
transistor is typically in the range : ÁŸfl‡Ê-¬˝ÁÃ⁄UÊœ (ri) ∑§ •ŸÈ¬Êà (R) ∑§Ê •ÊÿÊ◊ _p¡ NyZp¡Ñf (R) __________ S>¡V$gu f¡ÞS>dp„ lp¡e R>¡.
(1) R~102−103 (range) „ʪÊ? (1) R~102−103
(2) R~1−10 (1) R~102−103 (2) R~1−10
(3) R~0.1−0.01 (2) R~1−10 (3) R~0.1−0.01
(4) R~0.1−1.0 (3) R~0.1−0.01 (4) R~0.1−1.0
(4) R~0.1−1.0
31. The volume of 0.1N dibasic acid sufficient 31. 0.1N X$peb¡rTL$ A¡rkX$_y„ L$v$ iy„ li¡ L¡$ S>¡ 1 g b¡CT_p
to neutralize 1 g of a base that furnishes 0.04 31. 0.1N ÁmˇÊÊ⁄UËÿ •ê‹ ∑§Ê •Êÿß ÄÿÊ „ÊªÊ ¡Ê 1 ª˝Ê◊ sV$õ\uL$fZ L$fhp dpV¡$ `ep®á lp¡e L¡$ S>¡_p S>gue ÖphZdp„
mole of OH− in aqueous solution is :
ˇÊÊ⁄U∑§ Á¡‚∑§ ¡‹Ëÿ Áfl‹ÿŸ ◊¥ 0.04 ◊Ê‹ OH− „Ò 0.04 dp¡g OH− Aph¡gp R>¡ ?
(1) 200 mL
∑§Ê ©ŒÊ‚ËŸ ∑§⁄UŸ ∑§ Á‹ÿ ¬ÿʸ# „Ò? (1) 200 mL
(2) 400 mL (2) 400 mL
(1) 200 mL
(3) 600 mL (3) 600 mL
(2) 400 mL
(4) 800 mL (4) 800 mL
(3) 600 mL
(4) 800 mL
37. A solid XY kept in an evacuated sealed 37. ∞∑§ ’¥Œ (‚ËÀ«U) ÁŸflʸÁÃà ¬ÊòÊ ◊¥ ⁄UπÊ ªÿÊ ∆UÊ‚ XY 37. A¡L$ b„^ (sealed) r_hp®rss (evacuated) `pÓdp„
container undergoes decomposition to ÁflÉÊÁ≈Uà „Ê∑§⁄U Ãʬ T ¬⁄U ŒÊ ªÒ‚¥ X ÃÕÊ Y ∑§Ê Á◊üÊáÊ fpMhpdp„ Aph¡g O_ (solid) XY rhOV$us \C_¡ T
form a mixture of gases X and Y at
temperature T. The equilibrium pressure ’ŸÊÃÊ „Ò– ß‚ ¬ÊòÊ ◊¥ ‚Êêÿ ŒÊ’ 10 bar „Ò– ß‚ sp`dp_¡ hpeyAp¡_y„ rdîZ X A_¡ Y b_¡ R>¡. Ap `pÓdp„
is 10 bar in this vessel. Kp for this reaction •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§ Á‹ÿ Kp „ÊªÊ — k„syg_ v$bpZ 10 bar (bpf) R>¡. Ap âq¾$ep dpV¡$ Kp
is : (1) 5 iy„ R>¡ ?
(1) 5 (2) 10 (1) 5
(2) 10 (3) 25 (2) 10
(3) 25 (4) 100 (3) 25
(4) 100
(4) 100
39. The rate law for the reaction below is given 39. ŸËø ŒË ªß¸ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§ Á‹∞ Œ⁄U ÁŸÿ◊ k [A][B] 39. _uQ¡ Ap`¡g âq¾$ep dpV¡$_p¡ h¡N-r_ed k [A][B] ìe„S>L$
by the expression k [A][B] √ÿ¥¡∑§ ‚ √ÿÄà Á∑§ÿÊ ¡ÊÃÊ „Ò \u ìe¼s (expression) L$f¡g R>¡.
A+B Product A+B ©à¬ÊŒ A+B _u`S>
If the concentration of B is increased from A _u kp„Ösp 0.1 mole (dp¡g) fpMuA¡ A_¡ Å¡ B _u
A ∑§Ë ‚ÊãŒ˝ÃÊ ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ 0.1 ◊Ê‹ ¬⁄U ⁄Uπà „È∞ ÿÁŒ B
0.1 to 0.3 mole, keeping the value of A at
∑§Ë ‚ÊãŒ˝ÃÊ 0.1 ‚ ’…∏Ê∑§⁄U 0.3 ◊Ê‹ ∑§⁄U ŒË ¡ÊÃË „Ò ÃÊ kp„Ösp 0.1 \u h^pfu_¡ 0.3 dp¡g L$fhpdp„ Aph¡ sp¡
0.1 mole, the rate constant will be :
(1) k Œ⁄U ÁSÕ⁄UÊ¥∑§ „ÊªÊ — h¡NAQmp„L$ iy„ li¡ ?
(1) k
(2) k/3 (1) k
(2) k/3
(3) 3k (2) k/3
(3) 3k
(4) 9k (3) 3k
(4) 9k
(4) 9k
40. Gold numbers of some colloids 40. L¡$V$gpL$ L$rggp¡_p õhZp¯L$ (Np¡ëX$ _„bf) Ap âdpZ¡ R>¡.
40. ∑È § ¿U ∑§Ê ‹ Êß«U Ê ¥ ∑ § SfláÊÊZ ∑ § „Ò ¥ , Á¡‹ Á ≈U Ÿ —
are : Gelatin : 0.005 - 0.01, Gum Æg¡V$u_ (Gelatin) : 0.005 - 0.01, Nd Af¡rbL$
Arabic : 0.15 - 0.25; Oleate : 0.04 - 1.0; 0.005 - 0.01, ª◊ ∞⁄ U Á’∑§ — 0.15 - 0.25;
(Gum Arabic) : 0.15 - 0.25; Ap¡ r gA¡ V $$
Starch : 15 - 25. Which among these is a •ÊÁ‹∞≈U — 0.04 - 1.0; S≈UÊø¸ — 15 - 25, ߟ◊¥ ∑§ÊÒŸ-
(Oleate) : 0.04 - 1.0; õV$pQ® (Starch) : 15 - 25.
better protective colloid ?
‚Ê ’„Ã⁄U ⁄UˇÊË ∑§Ê‹Êÿ«U „ʪÊ?
(1) Gelatin Apdp„\u L$ep¡ kp¥\u h^pfp¡ kpfp¡ frns L$rgg R>¡ ?
(1) Á¡‹Á≈UŸ
(2) Gum Arabic (1) Æg¡V$u_ (Gelatin)
(3) Oleate (2) ª◊ ∞⁄UÁ’∑§ (2) Nd Af¡rbL$ (Gum Arabic)
(4) Starch (3) •ÊÁ‹∞≈U (3) Ap¡rgA¡V$ (Oleate)
(4) S≈UÊø¸ (4) õV$pQ® (Starch)
SET - 03 ENGLISH SET - 03 HINDI SET - 03 GUJARATI
Set - 03 27
41. The following statements concern elements 41. ÁŸêŸ ∑§ÕŸ •Êflø ÃÊÁ‹∑§Ê ◊¥ ©¬ÁSÕà ÃàflÊ¥ ‚ ‚ê’¥ÁœÃ 41. _uQ¡_p rh^p_p¡ Aphs®L$p¡ô$dp„_p sÒhp¡_¡ k„b„r^s R>¡.
in the periodic table. Which of the
„Ò¥– ÁŸêŸ ◊¥ ‚ ∑§ÊÒŸ-‚Ê ‚àÿ „Ò? _uQ¡_pdp„\u L$ey„ kpQy„ R>¡ ?
following is true ?
(1) All the elements in Group 17 are (1) ª˝È¬ 17 ◊¥ ‚÷Ë Ãàfl ªÒ‚ „Ò¥– (1) kd|l 17 dp„ b^p S> sÒhp¡ hpeyAp¡ R>¡.
gases. (2) ª˝È¬ 13 ◊¥ ‚÷Ë Ãàfl œÊÃÈ „Ò¥– (2) kd|l 13 dp„ b^p S> sÒhp¡ ^psyAp¡ R>¡.
(2) The Group 13 elements are all metals.
(3) ª˝È¬ 15 ∑§ ÃàflÊ¥ ∑§Ë ÃÈ‹ŸÊ ◊¥ ‚¥ªÃ •Êflø ∑§ (3) Aphs®_¡ A_ygnu_¡ kd|l 15 _p sÒhp¡_u
(3) Elements of Group 16 have lower
ª˝È¬ 16 ∑§ ÃàflÊ¥ ◊¥ •ÊÿŸŸ ∞ãÕÒÀ¬Ë ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ syg_pdp„ kd|l 16 _p sÒhp¡_u â\d Ape_uL$fZ
ionization enthalpy values compared
to those of Group 15 in the ∑§◊ ⁄U„ÃÊ „Ò– A¡Þ\pë`u Ap¡R>u R>¡.
(4) kd|l 15 _p sÒhp¡ dpV¡$, kd|ldp„ _uQ¡ S>CA¡
corresponding periods. (4) ª˝È¬ 15 ∑§ ÃàflÊ¥ ∑§ Á‹∞, ª˝È¬ ◊¥ ŸËø ¡ÊŸ ¬⁄U
(4) For Group 15 elements, the stability +5 •ÊÚÄ‚Ë∑§⁄UáÊ •flSÕÊ ∑§Ê SÕÊÁÿàfl ’…∏ÃÊ
s¡d +5 Ap¡[¼kX¡$i_ Ahõ\p_u [õ\fsp h^¡
of +5 oxidation state increases down
„Ò– R>¡.
the group.
••
•• ••
(1)
(1) (1)
••
•• ••
••
•• ••
(2)
(2) (2)
•• ••
••
(3)
(3) (3)
•• ••
••
••
•• ••
(4)
(4)
••
(4)
•• ••
X X
is :
„Ò — X iy„ R>¡ ?
••
••
• •• • ••
• •• •
• •• •
(1)
(1)
(1)
••
••
••
• •• • ••
• •• • ••
• •• • ••
(2)
(2)
(2)
••
••
••
••• • ••• •
••• •
(3)
(3)
(3)
54. Which one of the following reagents is not 54. Áfl‹Ê¬Ÿ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§ Á‹∞ ߟ •Á÷∑§Ê⁄U∑§Ê¥ ◊¥ ‚ 54. _uQ¡ Ap`¡gpdp„\u L$ep¡ âq¾$eL$ A¡ rhgp¡`_ âq¾$ep dpV¡$
suitable for the elimination reaction ?
∑§ÊÒŸ-‚Ê ©¬ÿÈÄà Ÿ„Ë¥ „Ò? kyk„Ns _\u ?
•• ••
••
(1) NaOH/H2O (1) NaOH/H2O
(1) NaOH/H2O
(2) NaOEt/EtOH (2) NaOEt/EtOH
(2) NaOEt/EtOH
(3) NaOH/H2O-EtOH (3) NaOH/H2O-EtOH
(3) NaOH/H2O-EtOH
(4) NaI (4) NaI
(4) NaI
55. The correct statement about the synthesis 55. PETN _u b_phV$dp„ h`fpsp¡ Cfu\° u V$p¡ g
of erythritol (C(CH 2OH) 4 ) used in the 55. PETN ∑§ ’ŸÊŸ ◊¥ ¬˝ÿÈÄà ß⁄UËÁÕ˝≈UÊÚ‹ (C(CH2OH)4) (C(CH2OH)4) _p k„ïg¡jZ dpV¡$ L$ey„ rh^p_ kpQy„
preparation of PETN is : ∑§ ‚¥‡‹·áÊ ∑§ ‚ê’㜠◊¥ ‚„Ë ∑§ÕŸ „Ò — R>¡ ?
(1) The synthesis requires four aldol (1) ‚¥‡‹·áÊ ◊¥ ◊ÕŸÊÚ‹ ÃÕÊ ∞ÕŸÊÚ‹ ∑§ ’Ëø øÊ⁄U (1) k„ïg¡jZ dpV¡$ rd\¡_p¡g A_¡ C\¡_p¡g_u hÃQ¡
∞À«UÊ‹ ‚¥ÉÊŸŸ ∑§Ë •Êfl‡ÿ∑§ÃÊ „ÊÃË „Ò–
condensations between methanol
and ethanol. Qpf ApëX$p¡g k„O___u AphíeL$sp lp¡e R>¡.
(2) The synthesis requires two aldol (2) ‚¥‡‹·áÊ ◊¥ ŒÊ ∞À«UÊ‹ ‚¥ÉÊŸŸ ÃÕÊ ŒÊ ∑Ò§ÁŸ¡Ê⁄UÊ (2) k„ïg¡jZdp„ b¡ ApëX$p¡g k„O__ A_¡ b¡ L¡$r_Tpfp¡
condensations and two Cannizzaro •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ë ¡M§⁄Uà „ÊÃË „Ò– âq¾$ep_u AphíeL$sp R>¡.
reactions.
(3) ‚¥‡‹·áÊ ◊¥ ÃËŸ ∞À«UÊ‹ ‚¥ÉÊŸŸ ÃÕÊ ∞∑§ (3) k„ïg¡jZdp„ ÓZ ApëX$p¡g k„O__ A_¡ A¡L$
(3) The synthesis requires three aldol
condensations and one Cannizzaro ∑Ò§ÁŸ¡Ê⁄UÊ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ∑§Ë •Êfl‡ÿ∑§ÃÊ „ÊÃË „Ò– L¡$r_Tpfp¡ âq¾$ep_u AphíeL$sp R>¡.
reaction. (4) ß‚ •Á÷Á∑˝§ÿÊ ◊¥ ∞ÕŸÊÚ‹ ∑§ •À»§Ê „Êß«˛UÊ¡Ÿ (4) Ap âq¾$epdp„ C\¡_p¡g_p¡ Apëap lpCX²$p¡S>_ A_¡
(4) Alpha hydrogens of ethanol and ÃÕÊ ◊ÕŸÊÚ‹ ÷ʪ ‹Ã „Ò¥– rd\¡_p¡g cpN g¡ R>¡.
methanol are involved in this
reaction.
• • •
•
(2)
•
(2)
•
(2)
(3) 2 (3) 2 (3) 2
(4) • • (4) • • (4) • •
• • •
• • •
(3) (3) (3)
•• ••
74. The integral is equal 74. ‚◊Ê∑§‹ ’⁄UÊ’⁄U „Ò —
( • •• • • ) • • •• •• • ( • •• • • ) • • •• •• • ••
74. =__________.
( • •• • • ) • • •• •• •
to : (¡„Ê° C ∞∑§ ‚◊Ê∑§‹Ÿ •ø⁄U „Ò–)
(where C is a constant of integration.)
(Äep„ C k„L$g__p¡ AQmp„L$ R>¡.)
• •• • •
• •• • • (1) • •• •• ••
• •• •• •• • •• • • • •• • •
• •• •• ••
(1)
• •• • • (1)
• •• • •
• •• • •
• •• • • (2) • •• •• ••
• •• •• •• • •• • • • •• • •
• •• •• ••
(2)
• •• • • (2)
• •• • •
• •• • •
• •• • • (3) • • •• ••
• •• •• • •• • • • •• • •
• • •• ••
(3)
• •• • • (3)
• •• • •
• •• • •
• •• • • (4) •• •• ••
•• •• •• • •• • • • •• • •
•• •• ••
(4)
• •• • • (4)
• •• • •
83. ABC is a triangle in a plane with vertices 83. ∞∑§ ‚◊Ë ◊¥ ∞∑§ ÁòÊ÷È¡ ABC „Ò Á¡‚∑§ ‡ÊË·¸ 83. A¡L$ kdsgdp„ A¡L$ rÓL$p¡Z ABC R>¡. S>¡_p rifp¡tbvy$Ap¡
A(2, 3, 5), B(−1, 3, 2) and C(λ, 5, µ). If the A(2, 3, 5), B(−1, 3, 2) ÃÕÊ C(λ, 5, µ) „Ò¥– ÿÁŒ A(2, 3, 5), B(−1, 3, 2) A_¡ C(λ, 5, µ) R>¡. Å¡ A
A ‚ „Ê∑§⁄U ¡ÊÃË ◊ÊÁäÿ∑§Ê ÁŸŒ¸‡ÊÊ¥∑§ •ˇÊÊ¥ ¬⁄U ‚◊ÊŸ
median through A is equally inclined to the
coordinate axes, then the value of
dp„\u _uL$msu dÝeNp epdpnp kp\¡ kdp_ fus¡ Y$m¡g
(λ3+µ3+5) is : M§¬ ‚ ! ÊÈ∑§Ë „Ò, ÃÊ (λ3+µ3+5) ∑§Ê ◊ÊŸ „Ò — R>¡, sp¡ (λ3+µ3+5) _u qL„$ds __________ R>¡.
(1) 1130 (1) 1130 (1) 1130
(2) 1348 (2) 1348 (2) 1348
(3) 676 (3) 676 (3) 676
(4) 1077 (4) 1077 (4) 1077
87. An experiment succeeds twice as often as 87. ∞∑§ ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§ ‚»§‹ „ÊŸ ∑§Ê ‚¥ÿʪ ©‚∑§ Áfl»§‹ 87. A¡L$ âep¡N S>¡V$gp hMs Akam \pe R>¡ s¡_p\u b¡
it fails. The probability of at least 5 „ÊŸ ∑§ ‚¥ÿʪ ∑§Ê ŒÈªÈŸÊ „Ò– ß‚ ¬˝ÿʪ ∑§ 6 ¬⁄UˡÊáÊÊ¥ NZp¡ kam \pe R>¡. Ap âep¡N_p R> âeÐ_p¡dp„\u
successes in the six trials of this experiment ◊¥ ‚ ∑§◊ ‚ ∑§◊ ¬Ê°ø ∑§ ‚»§‹ „ÊŸ ∑§Ë ¬˝ÊÁÿ∑§ÃÊ Ap¡ R >pdp„ Ap¡ R >u 5 kamsp dmhp_u k„ c ph_p
is :
„Ò — __________ R>¡.
•••
••• •••
•••
(1)
•••
(1)
•••
(1)
•••
••• •••
•••
(2)
•••
(2)
•••
(2)
•••
••• •••
•••
(3)
•••
(3)
•••
(3)
•••
••• •••
•••
(4)
•••
(4)
•••
(4)
89. The angle of elevation of the top of a 89. Á’¥ŒÈ A ‚, ¡Ê ∞∑§ ™§äflʸœ⁄U ◊ËŸÊ⁄U ∑§ ¬Ífl¸ ∑§Ë •Ê⁄U
vertical tower from a point A, due east of it „Ò, ◊ËŸÊ⁄U ∑§ ‡ÊË·¸ ∑§Ê ©ãŸÿŸ ∑§ÊáÊ 45 „Ò– Á’¥ŒÈ B, 89. A¡L$ rifp¡g„b V$phf_u `|h® sfa_p tbvy$ A \u V$phf_u
is 45. The angle of elevation of the top of
¡Ê Á’¥ŒÈ A ∑§ ŒÁˇÊáÊ ◊¥ „Ò, ‚ ©‚Ë ◊ËŸÊ⁄U ∑§ ‡ÊË·¸ ∑§Ê V$p¡Q_p¡ DÐk¡^L$p¡Z 45 R>¡. tbvy$ A _u v$rnZ¡ Aph¡g
the same tower from a point B, due south
©ãŸÿŸ ∑§ÊáÊ 30 „Ò– ÿÁŒ A ÃÕÊ B ∑§ ’Ëø ∑§Ë ŒÍ⁄UË tbvy$ B \u V$phf_u V$p¡Q_p¡ DÐk¡^L$p¡Z 30 R>¡. Å¡ A
of A is 30. If the distance between A and
B is • • • •• , then the height of the tower • • • ◊Ë. „Ò, ÃÊ ◊ËŸÊ⁄U ∑§Ë ™§°øÊ߸ (◊Ë. ◊¥) „Ò — A_¡ B hÃQ¡_y„ A„sf • • • •• lp¡e, sp¡ V$phf_u
KQpC (duV$fdp„) __________ R>¡.
•• •
(in metres), is :
(1)
(1) •• • (2) 54 (1) •• •
(2) 54
•• •
(2) 54
(3)
(3) •• • (4) 108 (3) •• •
(4) 108 (4) 108
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Page 2 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
2. If a body moving in a circular path 2. ØçÎ ßëææ·¤æÚU ÂÍ ×ð´ »çÌ ·¤ÚUÌð ãé° ç·¤âè ç´ÇU (ßSÌé)
maintains constant speed of 10 ms21, then
·¤è ¿æÜ 10 ms21 ãñ ¥æñÚU Øã ¥¿ÚU ÕÙè ÚUãÌè ãñ Ìæð,
which of the following correctly describes
relation between acceleration and çÙÙæ´ç·¤Ì ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙâæ ¥æÜð¹, ßÚUæ ÌÍæ çæØæ ·ð¤
radius ? Õè¿ âÕÏ ·¤æ ÆUè·¤ (âãè) ç¿ææ ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ?
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
Page 3 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
3. A block of mass m510 kg rests on a 3. ç·¤âè Üæò·¤ (»éÅU·ð¤) ·¤æ ÎýÃØ×æÙ m510 kg ãñÐ
horizontal table. The coefficient of friction
Øã °·¤ ÿæñçÌÁ ×ðÁ ÂÚU ÚU¹æ ãñÐ §Ù ÎæðÙæð´ ·ð¤ Õè¿
between the block and the table is 0.05.
When hit by a bullet of mass 50 g moving æáüæ »éææ´·¤50.05 ãñÐ §â Üæò·¤ ÂÚU 50 g ÎýÃØ×æÙ
with speed v, that gets embedded in it, the ·¤è °·¤ »æðÜè v ¿æÜ âð ÅU·¤ÚUæÌè ¥æñÚU §â×ð´ Ï´â
block moves and comes to stop after ÁæÌè ãñÐ §ââð Øã Üæò·¤, ×ðÁ ÂÚU 2 m çßSÍæçÂÌ
moving a distance of 2 m on the table.
ãæð·¤ÚU L¤·¤ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
If a freely falling object were to acquire
ØçÎ, H ª¡¤¿æ§ü âð ×éÌ M¤Â âð ç»ÚUæÙð ·ð¤ Âà¿æÌ÷ ·¤æð§ü
speed after being dropped from height
v
10 ßSÌé v
¿æÜ ÂýæÌ ·¤ÚU ÜðÌè ãñ Ìæð, ª¤Áæü-ÿæØ ·¤æð
H, then neglecting energy losses and 10
taking g510 ms22, the value of H is close Ù»Ø ×æÙÌð ãé°, H ·¤æ âçÙ·¤ÅU ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
to : (g510 ms22)
(1) 0.2 km (1) 0.2 km
(2) 0.3 km (2) 0.3 km
(3) 0.4 km (3) 0.4 km
(4) 0.5 km (4) 0.5 km
4. A block of mass m50.1 kg is connected to 4. ç·¤âè Üæò·¤ ·¤æ ÎýÃØ×æÙ m50.1 kg ãñÐ Øã °·¤
a spring of unknown spring constant k. It
is compressed to a distance x from its °ðâè ·¤×æÙè (çSÂý»´ ) âð ÁéÇæ¸ ãñ çÁâ·¤æ ·¤×æÙè çSÍÚUæ·´ ¤
equilibrium position and released from rest. k ãñÐ §â·¤æð §â·¤è âæØæßSÍæ âð x ÎêÚUè Ì·¤ ÎÕæ·¤ÚU
çßÚUæ×æßSÍæ âð ÀUæðǸ çÎØæ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ âæØæßSÍæ âð
After approaching half the distance
x
5. A uniform solid cylindrical roller of mass 5. m ÎýÃØ×æÙ ·ð¤ ç·¤âè °·¤â×æÙ ÆUæðâ çâçÜÇUÚU ·ð¤
m is being pulled on a horizontal surface
with force F parallel to the surface and
·ð¤Îý ÂÚU °·¤ ÕÜ F ܻ淤ÚU, ©âð ç·¤âè â×ÌÜ
applied at its centre. If the acceleration of âÌã ÂÚU, ©â·ð¤ â×æÌÚU ¹è´¿æ Áæ ÚUãæ ãñÐ ØçÎ Øã
the cylinder is a and it is rolling without çâçÜÇUÚU Õ»ñÚU (çÕÙæ) çȤâÜð a ßÚUæ âð Üéɸ·¤
slipping then the value of F is : ÚUãæ ãñ Ìæð, F ·¤æ ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) ma
(1) ma
(2) 2 ma
(2) 2 ma
(3)
3
(3)
ma 3
2 ma
2
(4)
5
(4)
ma 5
3 ma
3
Page 4 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
6. Consider a thin uniform square sheet made 6. °·¤ ÂÌÜè, °·¤â×æÙ, ß»æü·¤æÚU, ¿æÎÚU (àæèÅU) ç·¤âè
of a rigid material. If its side is a, mass m
Îëɸ ÂÎæÍü ·¤è ÕÙè ãñÐ ØçÎ §â·¤è °·¤ ÖéÁæ a,
and moment of inertia I about one of its
diagonals, then : ÎýÃØ×æÙ m ÌÍæ ç·¤âè °·¤ çß·¤æü ·ð¤ ÂçÚUÌÑ, §â·¤æ
ÁÇ¸ß ¥ææêæü I ãñ Ìæð Ñ
(1)
ma 2
I>
(1)
12 ma 2
I>
12
(2)
ma 2 ma 2
<I<
(2)
24 12 ma 2 ma 2
<I<
24 12
(3)
ma 2
I5
(3)
12 ma 2
I5
12
(4)
ma 2
I5
(4)
24 ma 2
I5
24
7. A very long (length L) cylindrical galaxy
is made of uniformly distributed mass and 7. °·¤ ÕãéÌ ÜÕè »ñÜðâè (×´Îæç·¤Ùè) (ÜÕæ§ü L)
has radius R (R<<L). A star outside the
galaxy is orbiting the galaxy in a plane
°·¤â×æÙ çßÌçÚUÌ ÎýÃØ ·¤è ÕÙè ãñ, §â·¤è çæØæ
perpendicular to the galaxy and passing R (R<<L) ãñÐ §â »ñÜðâè ·ð¤ ÕæãÚ °·¤ ÌæÚUæ,
through its centre. If the time period of star »ñÜðâè ·¤è ÂçÚU·ý¤×æ ·¤ÚU ÚUãæ ãñÐ §â·¤è ÂçÚU·ý¤×æ ·¤æ
is T and its distance from the galaxys axis â×ÌÜ »ñÜðâè ·ð¤ â×ÌÜ ·ð¤ ÜÕßÌ÷ ãñ ÌÍæ §â·ð¤
is r, then :
·ð¤Îý âð ãæð·¤ÚU »é$ÁÚUÌæ ãñÐ ØçÎ, ÌæÚðU ·¤è »ñÜðâè ·¤è
(1) T2 ; r3
¥ÿæ âð ÎêÚUè r ãñ ¥æñÚU ÌæÚðU ·¤æ ¥æßÌü ·¤æÜ T ãñ Ìæð ÑU
(2) T ; r2
(1) T2 ; r3
(3) T;r
(2) T ; r2
(4) T; r (3) T;r
(4)
If it takes 5 minutes to fill a 15 litre bucket
T; r
8.
(1)
4R T
4R
(2)
T
(2)
2R T
2R
(3)
4T
(3)
R 4T
R
(4)
2T
(4)
R 2T
R
Page 6 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
10. An ideal gas goes through a reversible 10. °·¤ ¥æÎàæü »ñ⠷𤠩·ý¤×æèØ ¿·ý¤ a®b®c®d ,
cycle a®b®c®d has the V - T diagram ·ð¤ çÜØð V - T ¥æÚðU¹ Øãæ¡ ÎàææüØæ »Øæ ãñÐ Âý·ý¤×
shown below. Process d®a and b®c are d®a ÌÍæ b®c L¤Î÷Ïæðc× ãñ´Ð
adiabatic.
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
Page 7 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
11. In an ideal gas at temperature T, the 11. ç·¤âè ¥æÎàæü »ñâ ×ð´, ç·¤âè ¥æé mæÚUæ »ñâ ·ð¤ ÕÎ
average force that a molecule applies on
Âææ ·¤è ÎèßæÚUæð´ ÂÚU Ü»æØæ »Øæ ¥æñâÌ ÕÜ, »ñâ ·ð¤
the walls of a closed container depends on
T as T . A good estimate for q is :
q Ìæ T ÂÚU, Tq ·ð¤ ¥ÙéâæÚU çÙÖüÚU ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñÐ Ìæð, q ·¤æ
(1) 2 âçÙ·¤ÅU ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
(2) 1 (1) 2
(2) 1
(3)
1
(3)
2 1
2
(4)
1
(4)
4 1
4
12. A simple harmonic oscillator of angular
frequency 2 rad s21 is acted upon by an 12. ç·¤âè âÚUÜ ¥æßÌü ÎæðçÜæ ·¤è ·¤æðæèØ ¥æßëçæ
external force F5sint N. If the oscillator
2 rad s21 ãñÐ §â ÂÚU °·¤ Õæs ÕÜ, F5sint
is at rest in its equilibrium position at t50,
its position at later times is proportional ØêÅUÙ (N) Ü»Ìæ ãñÐ ØçÎ â×Ø t50 ÂÚU, Øã ÎæðçÜæ,
to : ¥ÂÙè âæØæßSÍæ ×ð´ çßÚUæ× çSÍçÌ ×ð´ ãñ Ìæð, §â·ð¤
Âà¿æÌ÷ ·ð¤ ç·¤âè â×Ø ×ð´, §â·¤è çSÍçÌ çÙÙæ´ç·¤Ì
(1) ×ð´ ç·¤â·ð¤ â×æÙéÂæÌè ãæð»è?
1
sint 1 sin 2t
2
(2) (1)
1
sint 1
1
cos 2t sint 1 sin 2t
2 2
(3) (2)
1
cost 2
1
sin 2t sint 1 cos 2t
2 2
(4) (3)
1
sint 2
1
sin 2t cost 2 sin 2t
2 2
(4)
1
A bat moving at 10 ms21
towards a wall
sint 2 sin 2t
13.
sends a sound signal of 8000 Hz towards
2
(1)
s
ae 0
(1)
s
s
ae 0
(2) 2ae0
s
(2) 2ae0
(3)
s
4ae0
(3)
s
4ae0
(4)
s
8ae0
(4)
s
8ae0
Page 9 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
15. Shown in the figure are two point charges 15. Øãæ¡ ¥æÚðU¹ ×ð´, ç·¤âè »æðÜæ·¤æÚU ·¤æðàæ (àæñÜ) ·ð¤ ·¤æðÅUÚU
1Q and 2Q inside the cavity of a
·ð¤ ÖèÌÚU Îæð çÕÎé-¥æßðàæ 1Q ÌÍæ 2Q ÎàææüØð »Øð
spherical shell. The charges are kept near
the surface of the cavity on opposite sides ãñ´Ð Øð ¥æßðàæ ·¤æðÅUÚU ·¤è âÌã ·ð¤ çÙ·¤Å U§â Âý·¤æÚU
of the centre of the shell. If s1 is the surface ÚU¹ð »Øð ãñ´ ç·¤, °·¤ ¥æßðàæ ·¤æðàæ ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý ·¤è °·¤
charge on the inner surface and Q1 net ¥æðÚU ãñ ¥æñÚU ÎêâÚUæ ·ð¤Îý ·ð¤ çßÂÚUèÌ ÎêâÚUè ¥æðÚUÐ ØçÎ,
charge on it and s2 the surface charge on
the outer surface and Q2 net charge on it
ÖèÌÚUè ÌÍæ ÕæãÚUè âÌãæð´ (ÂëcÆUæð´) ÂÚU, ÂëcÆU ¥æßðàæ
then : ·ý¤×àæÑ s1 ÌÍæ s2 ¥æñÚU ÙðÅU ¥æßðàæ ·ý¤×àæÑ Q1 ÌÍæ
Q2 ãæð Ìæð Ñ
(1) s1 ¹ 0, Q1 ¹ 0
s2 ¹ 0, Q2 ¹ 0 (1) s1 ¹ 0, Q1 ¹ 0
(2) s1 ¹ 0, Q1 5 0 s2 ¹ 0, Q2 ¹ 0
s2 ¹ 0, Q2 5 0 (2) s1 ¹ 0, Q1 5 0
(3) s1 ¹ 0, Q1 5 0 s2 ¹ 0, Q2 5 0
s2 5 0, Q2 5 0 (3) s1 ¹ 0, Q1 5 0
(4) s1 5 0, Q1 5 0 s2 5 0, Q2 5 0
s2 5 0, Q2 5 0 (4) s1 5 0, Q1 5 0
s2 5 0, Q2 5 0
16. If the capacitance of a nanocapacitor is
measured in terms of a unit u made by 16. ØçÎ ç·¤âè ÙñÙæð â´ÏæçÚUæ ·¤è ÏæçÚUÌæ, °·¤ °ðâð ×ææ·¤
combining the electronic charge e, Bohr
radius a0, Plancks constant h and speed u ×ð´ ×æÂè ÁæØ, Áæð §ÜðÅþUæòÙ ¥æßðàæ e , ÕæðÚU-çæØæ
of light c then : a0, Üæ´·¤ çSÍÚUæ´·¤ h ÌÍæ Âý·¤æàæ ·¤è ¿æÜ c ·ð¤
â´ØæðÁÙ âð ÕÙæ ãñ Ìæð Ñ
(1)
e2 c
u5
(1)
e2 c
u5
ha0
ha0
(2)
e2 h
u5
(2)
ca0 e2 h
u5
ca0
(3)
e 2 a0
u5
(3)
hc e 2 a0
u5
hc
(4)
hc
u5 2
(4)
e a0 hc
u5 2
e a0
Page 10 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
17. Suppose the drift velocity vd in a material 17. ØçÎ, ç·¤âè ÂÎæÍü ×ð´ ¥Âßæã ßð», vd ·¤æ ×æÙ, Ü»æØð
varied with the applied electric field E as
»Øð çßléÌ ÿæðæ E ÂÚU §â Âý·¤æÚU çÙÖüÚU ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ, ç·¤
vd ; E . Then V - I graph for a wire
vd ; E Ð Ìæð çÙÙæ´ç·¤Ì ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ-âæ »ýæȤ
made of such a material is best given by :
(¥æÜð¹), §â ÂÎæÍü âð ÕÙð ÌæÚU ·ð¤ çÜØð, âçÙ·¤ÅU
V - I »ýæȤ ãæð»æ?
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Page 11 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
18. A 10V battery with internal resistance 18. °·¤ ßæðËÅU×èÅUÚU âð â×æÌÚU ·ý¤× ×ð´, Îæð ÕñÅUçÚUØæ¡, ÁæðǸè
1V and a 15V battery with internal
»§ü ãñ´Ð ÂãÜè, 10V ÌÍæ 1V ¥æÌçÚU·¤ ÂýçÌÚUæðÏ ·¤è
resistance 0.6V are connected in parallel
to a voltmeter (see figure). The reading in ¥æñÚU ÎêâÚUè, 15V ÌÍæ 0.6V ¥æÌçÚU·¤ ÂýçÌÚUæðÏ ·¤è
the voltmeter will be close to : (¥æÚðU¹ Îðç¹Øð) Ìæð, ßæðËÅU×èÅUÚU ·ð¤ ÂÆUÙ (ÚUèçÇ´U»)
·¤æ âçÙ·¤ÅU ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) 11.9 V
(2) 12.5 V (1) 11.9 V
(3) 13.1 V (2) 12.5 V
(4) 24.5 V (3) 13.1 V
(4) 24.5 V
(1)
B qd
2 mV
(1)
B qd
(2)
B q
2 mV
d 2mV
(2)
B q
(3)
q d 2mV
Bd
2mV
(3)
q
Bd
(4)
Bd 2mV
qV
2m
(4)
Bd
qV
2m
Page 12 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
20. A 25 cm long solenoid has radius 2 cm 20. ç·¤âè ÂçÚUÙæçÜ·¤æ ·¤è ÜÕæ§ü 25 cm ÌÍæ çæØæ
and 500 total number of turns. It carries a
2 cm ãñ ¥æñÚU §â×ð´ ÌæÚU ·ð¤ ·é¤Ü 500 Èð¤ÚðU ÜÂðÅðU »Øð
current of 15 A. If it is equivalent to a
magnet of the same size and magnetization ãñ´Ð §ââð 15 A ·¤è ÏæÚUæ ÂýßæçãÌ ãæð ÚUãè ãñÐ Øã
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Page 14 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
23. An electromagnetic wave travelling in the 23. x-çÎàææ ×ð´ ¿ÜÌè ãé§ü ç·¤âè çßléÌ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÌÚ´U» ·¤è
x-direction has frequency of 231014 Hz
¥æßëçæ 231014 Hz ãñ ÌÍæ §â·¤æ çßléÌ ÿæðæ
and electric field amplitude of 27 Vm21.
From the options given below, which one 27 Vm21 ãñÐ Ìæð, çÎØð »Øð çÙÙæ´ç·¤Ì çß·¤ËÂæð´ ×ð´
describes the magnetic field for this âð ·¤æñÙ âæ çß·¤ËÂ, §â ÌÚ´U» ·ð¤ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÿæðæ ·¤æð
wave ? Âý·¤ÅU ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ?
(1) (1)
→ ∧
B ( x , t)5(331028 T) j → ∧
B ( x , t)5(331028 T) j
(1) ?py?d ; h
(2) ?py?d>h (1) ?py?d ; h
(3) ?py?d<h (2) ?py?d>h
(4) ?py?d>>h (3) ?py?d<h
(4) ?py?d>>h
26. A telescope has an objective lens of focal
length 150 cm and an eyepiece of focal
length 5 cm. If a 50 m tall tower at a 26. ç·¤âè ÎêÚUÎàæü·¤ ·ð¤ ¥çÖÎëàØ·¤ ÌÍæ Ùðçæ·¤æ ·¤è Ȥæð·¤â
distance of 1 km is observed through this ÎêçÚUØæ¡ ·ý¤×àæÑ 150 cm ÌÍæ 5 cm ãñ´Ð ØçÎ 1 km
telescope in normal setting, the angle ÎêÚU çSÍÌ ç·¤âè 50 m ª¡¤¿ð ÅUæßÚU (×èÙæÚU) ·¤æð, âæ×æØ
formed by the image of the tower is u, then
u is close to : çßØæâ ×ð´, ÎêÚUÎàæü·¤ âð Îð¹Ùð ÂÚU, ÅUæßÚU ·ð¤ ÂýçÌçÕÕ
(1) 18 mæÚUæ ÕÙæØæ »Øæ ·¤æðæ, u ãæð Ìæð, u ·¤æ ×æÙ ãæð»æ
(2) 158
ֻܻ Ñ
(3) 308 (1) 18
(1) (1)
hqB hqB
n n
2 pm 2 pm
(2) (2)
hqB hqB
n n
4 pm 4 pm
(3) (3)
hqB hqB
n n
8 pm 8 pm
(4) (4)
hqB hqB
n n
pm pm
29. In an unbiased n-p junction electrons 29. ç·¤âè ¥-ÕæØçâÌ n-p â´çÏ ×ð´ §ÜðÅþUæòÙ n - ÿæðæ âð
diffuse from n - region to p - region
p - ÿæðæ ·¤æð çßâçÚUÌ ãæðÌð ãñ´ Øæð´ç·¤ Ñ
because :
(1) holes in p - region attract them (1) p- ÿæðæ ×ð´ çÀUÎý (ãæðÜ) ©ã𴠥淤çáüÌ ·¤ÚUÌð
(2) electrons travel across the junction ãñд
due to potential difference (2) §ÜðÅþUæòÙ çßÖßæÌÚU ·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ â´çÏ ·ð¤ ÂæÚU
(3) electron concentration in n - region ¿Üð ÁæÌð ãñ´Ð
is more as compared to that in
p - region (3) n- ÿæðæ ×ð´ §ÜðÅþUæòÙæð´ ·¤è âæ´ÎýÌæ p- ÿæðæ âð
(4) only electrons move from n to p ¥çÏ·¤ ãæðÌè ãñÐ
region and not the vice - versa
(4) §ÜðÅþUæòÙ ·ð¤ßÜ n âð p ÿæðæ ·¤æð ÁæÌð ã´ñ §â·ð¤
çßÂÚèUÌ (p âð n ·¤æð ) Ùãè´Ð
Page 17 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 09
30. Diameter of a steel ball is measured using 30. SÅUèÜ ·¤è °·¤ »æðÜè ·¤æ ÃØæâ °·¤ °ðâð ßçÙüØÚU
a Vernier callipers which has divisions of
·ñ¤ÜèÂâü âð ÙæÂæ ÁæÌæ ãñ çÁâ·ð¤ ×éØ Âñ×æÙð ·¤æ °·¤
0.1 cm on its main scale (MS) and 10
divisions of its vernier scale (VS) match 9 Öæ» (MSD) 0.1 cm ãñ, ÌÍæ §â×ð´ ßçÙüØÚ Âñ×æÙðU
divisions on the main scale. Three such (VS) ·ð¤ 10 Öæ», ×éØ Âñ×æÙð ·ð¤ 9 Öæ»æð´ ·ð¤ ÕÚUæÕÚU
measurements for a ball are given as : ãñ´Ð »æðÜè ·ð¤ ÃØæâ ·ð¤ çÜØð ÌèÙ ÂæÆ÷UØæ´·¤ (ÚUèçÇU´»)
S.No. MS (cm) VS divisions
Øãæ¡ çÎØð »Øð ãñ´ Ñ
corrected diameter is :
2. 0.5 4
(1) 0.56 cm
3. 0.5 6
(2) 0.59 cm ØçÎ ßçÙüØÚU ·ñ¤ÜèÂâü ·¤è àæêØ æéçÅU 20.03 cm, ãñ
(3) 0.53 cm Ìæð, ÃØæâ ·¤æ ×æØ â´àææðçÏÌ ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
(4) 0.52 cm
(1) 0.56 cm
(2) 0.59 cm
-o0o-
(3) 0.53 cm
(4) 0.52 cm
-o0o-
Page 1 Chemistry : English & Hindi 09
1. A sample of a hydrate of barium chloride 1. 61 g ÕðçÚUØ× ÜæðÚUæ§ÇU ·ð¤ ãæ§ÇþðUÅU ·ð¤ °·¤ Ù×êÙð ·¤æð
weighing 61 g was heated until all the
»ÚU× ·¤ÚU·ð¤ âé¹æØæ »ØæÐ âê¹ð Ù×êÙð ·¤æ ßÁÙ 52 g
water of hydration is removed. The dried
sample weighed 52 g. The formula of the ÍæÐ ãæ§ÇþðUÅU Üßæ ·¤æ âêæ ãñ Ñ (ÂÚU×ææé ÎýÃØ×æÙ,
hydrated salt is : (atomic mass, Ba5137 amu, Cl535.5 amu)
Ba5137 amu, Cl535.5 amu) (1) BaCl2.H2O
(1) BaCl2.H2O (2) BaCl2.2H2O
(2) BaCl2.2H2O (3) BaCl2.3H2O
(3) BaCl2.3H2O (4) BaCl2.4H2O
(4) BaCl2.4H2O
2. çÙÙ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ âè »ñâæ𴠷𤠥æé»çÌ·¤ çâhæ´Ì ·¤è
2. Which of the following is not an ¥ßÏæÚUææ Ùãè´ ãñ?
assumption of the kinetic theory of gases ?
(1) A gas consists of many identical
(1) °·¤ »ñâ ÕãéÌ âæÚðU â×M¤Â ·¤ææð´ âð ÕÙÌè ãñ
particles which are in continual Áæð Ü»æÌæÚU »çÌ·¤ ¥ßSÍæ ×ð´ ÚUãÌð ãñ´Ð
motion. (2) »ñ⠷𤠷¤ææð´ ·¤æ ¥æØÌÙ Ù»Ø ãñÐ
(2) Gas particles have negligible volume.
(3) ©æ ÎæÕ ÂÚU »ñâ ·¤ææð´ ·¤æ â´ÂèÇUÙ ·¤çÆUÙ ãñÐ
(3) At high pressure, gas particles are
difficult to compress. (4) »ñ⠷𤠷¤ææð´ ·ð¤ ×Ø â´æ^ ÂêæüÌÑ ÂýØæSÍ
(4) Collisions of gas particles are ãæðÌð ãñ´Ð
perfectly elastic.
11. In the long form of the periodic table, the 11. ¥æßÌü âæÚUæè ·ð¤ Îèæü SßM¤Â ×ð´, ¥»ÚU â´ØæðÁè ·¤æðàæ
valence shell electronic configuration of
5s2 5p4 corresponds to the element present §ÜðÅþUæòÙ çßØæâ 5s2 5p4 ãñ ÌÕ ßã Ìß ©ÂçSÍÌ
in : ãñ Ñ
(1) Group 16 and period 6 (1) ß»ü 16 ¥æñÚU ¥æßÌü 6 ×ð´
(2) Group 17 and period 5
(2) ß»ü 17 ¥æñÚU ¥æßÌü 5 ×ð´
(3) Group 16 and period 5
(3) ß»ü 16 ¥æñÚU ¥æßÌü 5 ×ð´
(4) Group 17 and period 6
(4) ß»ü 17 ¥æñÚU ¥æßÌü 6 ×ð´
12. In the isolation of metals, calcination
process usually results in : 12. ÏæÌé¥æð´ ·ð¤ çÙc·¤áüæ ×ð´, çÙSÌæÂÙ âð ¥·¤âÚU ÕÙÌð
(1) metal carbonate ãñ´ Ñ
(2) metal oxide
(1) ÏæÌé ·¤æÕæðüÙðÅU
(3) metal sulphide
(2) ÏæÌé ¥æòâæ§ÇU
(4) metal hydroxide
(3) ÏæÌé âËȤæ§ÇU
13. Permanent hardness in water cannot be (4) ÏæÌé ãæ§ÇþUæòâæ§ÇU
cured by :
(1) Boiling
13. ÁÜ ·¤è SÍæØè ·¤ÆUæðÚUÌæ ·¤æð §â Âýç·ý¤Øæ âð ÆUè·¤ Ùãè´
(2) Ion exchange method
ç·¤Øæ Áæ â·¤Ìæ ãñ Ñ
(3) Calgons method
(4) Treatment with washing soda
(1) ©ÕæÜÙæ
(2) ¥æØÙ çßçÙ×Ø çßçÏ
(3) ·ð¤Ü»æòÙ çßçÏ
(4) ÏæßÙ âæðÇUæ ·ð¤ ©Â¿æÚU âð
Page 5 Chemistry : English & Hindi 09
14. The correct order of thermal stability of 14. ãæ§ÇþUæòâæ§ÇUæð´ ·¤æ ÌæÂèØ SÍæçØß ·¤æ âãè ·ý¤× ãñ Ñ
hydroxides is :
(1) Ba(OH)2 < Sr(OH) 2 < Ca(OH) 2 <
(1) Ba(OH)2 < Sr(OH) 2 < Ca(OH) 2 < Mg(OH)2
Mg(OH)2
(2) Ba(OH)2 < Ca(OH) 2 < Sr(OH) 2 <
(2) Ba(OH)2 < Ca(OH) 2 < Sr(OH) 2 < Mg(OH)2
Mg(OH)2
(3) Mg(OH)2 < Ca(OH) 2 < Sr(OH) 2 <
(3) Mg(OH)2 < Ca(OH) 2 < Sr(OH)2 < Ba(OH)2
Ba(OH)2
(4) Mg(OH)2 < Sr(OH)2 < Ca(OH) 2 <
(4) Mg(OH)2 < Sr(OH) 2 < Ca(OH) 2 < Ba(OH)2
Ba(OH)2
16. The geometry of XeOF4 by VSEPR theory 16. ßè.°â.§ü.Âè.¥æÚU. (VSEPR) çâhæ´Ì ·ð¤ ¥ÙéâæÚU,
is : XeOF4 ·¤è Øæç×çÌ ãñ Ñ
(1) trigonal bipyramidal (1) çæ·¤æðæèØ çmçÂÚUæç×ÇUè
(2) square pyramidal
(2) ß»ü çÂÚUæç×ÇUè
(3) octahedral
(4) pentagonal planar (3) ¥cÅUȤܷ¤èØ
(4) ´¿·¤æðæèØ â×ÌÜèØ
17. An aqueous solution of a salt X turns blood
red on treatment with SCN2 and blue on
17. Üßæ X ·¤æ ÁÜèØ çßÜØÙ SCN2 ·ð¤ âæÍ ¹êÙè
treatment with K4[Fe(CN)6]. X also gives
a positive chromyl chloride test. The salt ÜæÜ Ú´U» ¥æñÚU K4[Fe(CN)6] ·ð¤ âæÍ ÙèÜæ Ú´U» ÎðÌæ
X is : ãñÐ X °·¤ â·¤æÚUæ×·¤ ·ý¤æðç×Ü ÜæðÚUæ§ÇU ÂÚUèÿææ Öè
(1) CuCl2 ÎðÌæ ãñÐ Üßæ X ãñ Ñ
(2) FeCl3 (1) CuCl2
(3) Cu(NO3)2 (2) FeCl3
(4) Fe(NO3)3 (3) Cu(NO3)2
(4) Fe(NO3)3
18. Which molecule/ion among the following
cannot act as a ligand in complex
compounds ?
18. çÙÙ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ âæ ¥æé/¥æØÙ â´·é¤Ü Øæñç»·¤æð´ ×ð´
(1) CO
çÜ»ñÇU Ùãè´ ãæð â·¤Ìæ ãñ?
(2) CN2 (1) CO
23.
23.
A is :
A ãñ Ñ
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(3) C6H52CH22CH22CH22CH22Cl
(4)
(4)
Page 8 Chemistry : English & Hindi 09
25. In the presence of a small amount of 25. ȤæòSȤæðÚUâ ·¤è ·¤× ×æææ ·¤è ©ÂçSÍçÌ ×ð´ °ÜèÈð¤çÅU·¤
phosphorous, aliphatic carboxylic acids
·¤æÕæðüçâçÜ·¤ ¥Ü ÜæðÚUèÙ ¥æñÚU Õýæð×èÙ ·ð¤ âæÍ
react with chlorine or bromine to yield a
compound in which a - hydrogen has been ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ·¤ÚUÌð ãé° ¥ÂÙð a - ãæ§ÇþUæðÁÙ ·¤æð ãñÜæðÁÙ
replaced by halogen. This reaction is ×ð´ ÂçÚUßçÌüÌ ·¤ÚUÌð ãñ´Ð §â ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ·¤æ Ùæ× ãñ Ñ
known as :
(1) ßæðËȤ-ç·¤àÙÚU ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ
(1) Wolff - Kischner reaction
(2) Etard reaction
(2) §üÅUæÇüU ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ
(3) Hell - Volhard - Zelinsky reaction (3) ãðÜ-ȤæðÜæÇüU-ÁðçÜ´S·¤è ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ
(4) Rosenmund reaction (4) ÚUæðÁðÙ×é´ÇU ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ
26. Arrange the following amines in the order 26. çÙÙ ¥×èÙæð´ ·¤æð ÿææÚU·¤Ìæ ·ð¤ ÕɸÌð ·ý¤× ×ð´ ܻ槰Ð
of increasing basicity.
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Page 9 Chemistry : English & Hindi 09
27. Match the polymers in column-A with 27. ·¤æòÜ×-A ×ð´ çΰ »° ÕãéÜ·¤æð´ ·¤æð ·¤æòÜ×-B ×ð´ ©Ù·ð¤
their main uses in column-B and choose
Âý×é¹ ©ÂØæð» ·ð¤ âæÍ âé×ðçÜÌ ·¤Úð´U ÌÍæ âãè çß·¤ËÂ
the correct answer :
¿éÙð´ Ñ
Column - A Column - B
(A) Polystyrene (i) Paints and Ë×Á¼ - A Ë×Á¼ - B
lacquers (A) §ËÁÍSªUË¿U; (i) §âÁ§Õ ËÖ¿U §âÁËäË
(B) Glyptal (ii) Rain coats
º¾Ë¾Õ ¼Õ
ÌóÁåªUÁ º¿UÇË̱½Ë º¾Ë¾Õ ¼Õ
(C) Polyvinyl (iii) Manufacture of
(B) (ii)
(1) (A) - (ii), (B) - (i), (C) - (iii), (D) - (iv) þÁËÕ¿UˬU
(2) (A) - (iii), (B) - (i), (C) - (ii), (D) - (iv) (D) ºÖÕ Á˪U (iv) å½ÏªU¿U ̬US
(3) (A) - (ii), (B) - (iv), (C) - (iii), (D) - (i) º¾Ë¾Õ ¼Õ
(4) (A) - (iii), (B) - (iv), (C) - (ii), (D) - (i)
(1) (A) - (ii), (B) - (i), (C) - (iii), (D) - (iv)
(2) (A) - (iii), (B) - (i), (C) - (ii), (D) - (iv)
28. Complete hydrolysis of starch gives : (3) (A) - (ii), (B) - (iv), (C) - (iii), (D) - (i)
(1) glucose and fructose in equimolar (4) (A) - (iii), (B) - (iv), (C) - (ii), (D) - (i)
amounts
(2) galactose and fructose in equimolar 28. SÅUæ¿ü ·ð¤ Âêæü ÁÜ ¥ÂæÅUÙ âð ç×ÜÌæ ãñ Ñ
amounts (1) Üê·¤æðâ ¥æñÚU Èýé¤ÅUæðâ ·¤è â××æðÜ ×æææ
(3) glucose only (2) »ñÜðÅUæðâ ¥æñÚU Èýé¤ÅUæðâ ·¤è â××æðÜ ×æææ
(4) glucose and galactose in equimolar (3) ·ð¤ßÜ Üê·¤æðâ
amounts
(4) Üê·¤æðâ ¥æñÚU »ñÜðÅUæðâ ·¤è â××æðÜ ×æææ
is used as :
29.
29. ·¤æ ÂýØæð» ç·¤â M¤Â ×ð´ ãæðÌæ ãñ?
30. The cation that will not be precipitated by 30. ßã ÏÙæØÙ Áæð ÌÙé HCl ·ð¤ ©ÂçSÍçÌ ×ð´ H2S âð
H2S in the presence of dil HCl is :
¥ßÿæðçÂÌ Ùãè´ ãæðÌæ ãñ, ßã ãñ Ñ
(1) Cu 21 (1) Cu 21
(2) Pb21 (2) Pb21
(3) As31 (3) As31
(4) Co21
(4) Co21
-oOo- -oOo-
Page 1 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 09
1. In a certain town, 25% of the families own 1. ç·¤âè àæãÚU ×ð´, 25% ÂçÚUßæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Âæâ ȤæðÙ ãñ ÌÍæ
a phone and 15% own a car ; 65% families
15% ·ð¤ Âæâ ·¤æÚU ãñ ; 65% ÂçÚUßæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Âæâ Ù Ìæð
own neither a phone nor a car and 2,000
families own both a car and a phone. ȤæðÙ ãñ ¥æñÚU Ù ãè ·¤æÚU ãñ, ÌÍæ 2,000 ÂçÚUßæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Âæâ
Consider the following three statements : ȤæðÙ ÌÍæ ·¤æÚU ÎæðÙæð´ ãñ´Ð çÙÙ ÌèÙ ·¤ÍÙæð´ ÂÚU çß¿æÚU
(a) 5% families own both a car and a ·¤èçÁ° Ñ
phone.
(a) 5% ÂçÚUßæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Âæâ ·¤æÚU ÌÍæ ȤæðÙ ÎæðÙæð´ ãñ´Ð
(b) 35% families own either a car or a
phone. (b) 35% ÂçÚUßæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Âæâ Øæ Ìæð ·¤æÚU ãñ Øæ ȤæðÙ
(c) 40,000 families live in the town. ãñÐ
Then, (c) àæãÚU ×ð´ 40,000 ÂçÚUßæÚU ÚUãÌð ãñ´Ð
(1) Only (a) and (b) are correct. Ìæð,
(2) Only (a) and (c) are correct.
(1) ·ð¤ßÜ (a) ÌÍæ (b) âãè ãñ´Ð
(3) Only (b) and (c) are correct.
(4) All (a), (b) and (c) are correct.
(2) ·ð¤ßÜ (a) ÌÍæ (c) âãè ãñ´Ð
(3) ·ð¤ßÜ (b) ÌÍæ (c) âãè ãñ´Ð
2. The largest value of r for which the region (4) (a), (b) ÌÍæ (c) âÖè âãè ãñ´Ð
represented by the set {v e C/?v242i?[r}
is contained in the region represented by
the set {z e C/?z21?[?z1i?}, is equal to : 2. r ·¤æ ßã ¥çÏ·¤Ì× ×æÙ çÁâ·ð¤ çÜ° â×éæØ
{v e C/?v242i?[r} mæÚUæ çÙÏæüçÚUÌ ÿæðæ, â×éæØ
(1)
{z e C/?z21?[?z1i?} mæÚU æ çÙÏæü ç ÚU Ì ÿæð æ ×ð ´
17
(2)
22 2
(2)
216 2
(3) 28
2 16 2
(3) 28
(4) 21
(4) 21
6. The number of ways of selecting 15 teams 6. 15 ÂéL¤áæð´ ÌÍæ 15 ×çãÜæ¥æð´ ×ð´ âð °ðâè 15 ÅUè×ð´,
from 15 men and 15 women, such that çÁÙ×ð´ ÂýØð·¤ ×ð´ °·¤ ÂéL¤á ÌÍæ °·¤ ×çãÜæ ãæð, ¿éÙÙð
each team consists of a man and a woman, ·ð¤ ÌÚUè·¤æð´ ·¤è â´Øæ ãñ Ñ
is :
(1) 1120
(1) 1120
(2) 1240
(2) 1240
(3) 1880
(3) 1880
(4) 1960
(4) 1960
is equal to :
2
e x 2 cosx
10.
e x 2 cosx
ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
2
lim
10.
x →0 2
sin x lim
(1) 3
x →0 sin 2 x
(1) 3
(2)
3
(2)
2 3
2
(3)
5
(3)
4 5
(4) 2
4
(4) 2
(4) 2 (3) 2
(4) 2
Page 4 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 09
12. If Rolles theorem holds for the function 12. ØçΠȤÜÙ f (x)52x31bx21cx, x e [21, 1]
f (x)52x 3 1bx 2 1cx, x e [21, 1], at the
·ð¤ çÜ° çÕ´Îé 1
ÂÚU ÚUæðÜð ·¤æ Âý×ðØ Üæ»ê ãæðÌæ ãñ,
point x 5 , then 2b1c equals :
1 x5
2
2
Ìæð 2b1c ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
(1) 1
(1) 1
(2) 21
(2) 21
(3) 2
(3) 2
(4) 23
(4) 23
(2) 3 3 (1) 4 3
(3) 3 2 (2) 3 3
(4) 4 2 (3) 3 2
(4) 4 2
x 11 4
1
(1) 1C x 11 4
1
x 22 (1) 1C
4
x 22
4
x 22 4
1
(2) 1C x 22 4
1
x 11 (2) 1C
4
x 11
4
4 x 11 4
1
(3) 2 1C 4 x 11 4
1
3 x 22 (3) 2 1C
3 x 22
4 x 22 4
1
(4) 2 1C 4 x 22 4
1
3 x 11 (4) 2 1C
3 x 11
Page 5 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 09
For x > 0, let f ( x ) 5 ∫ dt . Then x>0 ·ð¤ çÜ° ×æÙæ ãñ, Ìæð
x x
log t log t
15. 15. f (x) 5 ∫ dt
11t 11t
1 1
f ( x ) 1 f is equal to :
1 1
f (x) 1 f ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
x x
(1) (1)
1 1
(log x )2 (log x )2
4 4
(2) (2)
1 1
(log x )2 (log x )2
2 2
(3) log x (3) log x
(4) (4)
1 1
log x 2 log x 2
4 4
16. The area (in square units) of the region 16. ß·ý¤æð´ y12x250 ÌÍæ y13x251 mæÚUæ ÂçÚUÕh ÿæðæ
bounded by the curves y12x 2 50 and
·¤æ ÿæðæÈ¤Ü (ß»ü §·¤æ§Øæð´ ×ð´) ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
y13x251, is equal to :
(1)
3
(1)
3
5
5
(2)
3
(2)
3
4
4
(3)
1
(3)
1
3
3
(4)
4
(4)
4
3
3
17. If y(x) is the solution of the differential 17. ØçÎ y(x), ¥ß·¤Ü â×è·¤ÚUæ
equation ( x12) 5 x 2 14x29 , x ¹ 22 5 x 2 14x29 , x ¹ 22 ¥æñÚU
dy
dy ( x12)
dx
y(0)50, ·¤æ ãÜ ãñ, Ìæð y(24) ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
dx
and y(0)50, then y(24) is equal to :
(1) 0 (1) 0
(2) 1 (2) 1
(3) 21 (3) 21
(4) 2 (4) 2
Page 6 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 09
18. The points 0, 8 , (1, 3) and (82, 30) : 18. çÕ´Îé 0, , (1, 3)
8 ÌÍæ (82, 30) Ñ
3 3
(1) form an obtuse angled triangle. (1) °·¤ ¥çÏ·¤·¤æðæ çæÖéÁ ÕÙæÌð ãñ´Ð
(2) form an acute angled triangle.
(2) °·¤ ØêÙ·¤æðæ çæÖéÁ ÕÙæÌð ãñ´Ð
(3) form a right angled triangle.
(3) °·¤ â×·¤æðæ çæÖéÁ ÕÙæÌð ãñ´Ð
(4) lie on a straight line.
(4) °·¤ âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ ÂÚU çSÍÌ ãñ´Ð
19. Let L be the line passing through the point
P(1, 2) such that its intercepted segment 19. ×æÙæ L, çÕ´Îé P(1, 2) âð ãæð·¤ÚU ÁæÙð ßæÜè ßã ÚðU¹æ ãñ
between the co-ordinate axes is bisected
at P. If L1 is the line perpendicular to L
çÁâ·¤æ çÙÎðüàææ´·¤ ¥ÿææð´ ·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤ÅUæ ÚðU¹æ¹ÇU P ÂÚU
and passing through the point (22, 1), â×çmÖæçÁÌ ãæðÌæ ãñÐ ×æÙæ L1 ßã ÚðU¹æ ãñ Áæð L ÂÚU
then the point of intersection of L and L1 Ü´ÕßÌ ãñ ÌÍæ çÕ´Îé (22, 1) âð ãæð·¤ÚU ÁæÌè ãñ, Ìæð
is : L ÌÍæ L1 ·¤æ ÂýçÌÀðUÎÙ çÕ´Îé ãñ Ñ
(1)
4 12
(1)
, 4 12
5 5 ,
5 5
(2)
11 29
(2)
, 11 29
20 10 ,
20 10
(3)
3 17
(3)
, 3 17
10 5 ,
10 5
(4)
3 23
(4)
, 3 23
5 10 ,
5 10
(2)
39
(2)
, 3 39
2 , 3
2
(3)
1 3
(3)
13 , 1 3
2 2 13 ,
2 2
(4)
13
(4)
, 6 13
2 , 6
2
(1)
16
2
(1)
16
2 19
19
(2)
19
2
(2)
19
2 16
16
(3)
32
(3)
32
19
19
(4)
19
(4)
19
32
32
(2) 51 (2) 51
(3) 43 (3) 43
(4) 37 (4) 37
26. Let X be a set containing 10 elements and 26. ×æÙæ °·¤ â×éæØ ãñ çÁâ×ð´ 10 ¥ßØß ãñ´ ÌÍæ
X
P(X) be its power set. If A and B are picked P(X) §â·¤æ ææÌ â×éæØ ãñÐ ØçÎ P(X) âð A ÌÍæ
up at random from P(X), with B ØæÎëÀUØæ, ÂýçÌSÍæÂÙæ âçãÌ, çÜ° »° ãñ´, Ìæð
replacement, then the probability that A
and B have equal number of elements, is : A ÌÍæ B ×ð´ ÕÚUæÕÚU ¥ßØßæð´ ·ð¤ ãæðÙð ·¤è ÂýæçØ·¤Ìæ ãñ Ñ
(1)
20
(1)
20 C10
C10
2 10 2 10
( 2 10 2 1 ) ( 210 2 1 )
(2) (2)
2 20 2 20
( 2 10 2 1 ) ( 210 2 1 )
(3) (3)
2 10 2 10
(4)
20
(4)
20 C10
C10
2 20 2 20
Page 9 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 09
27. A factory is operating in two shifts, day 27. °·¤ Èñ¤ÅþUè Îæð ÂæçÚUØæð´, çÎÙ ÌÍæ ÚUæÌ, ×ð´ ¿ÜÌè ãñ
and night, with 70 and 30 workers
çÁÙ×ð´ ·ý¤×àæÑ 70 ÌÍæ 30 ·¤æ×»æÚU ·¤æØü ·¤ÚUÌð ãñ´Ð
respectively. If per day mean wage of the
day shift workers is ` 54 and per day mean ØçÎ çÎÙ ·¤è ÂæÚUè ·ð¤ ·¤æ×»æÚUæð´ ·¤æ ×æØ ÂýçÌçÎÙ
wage of all the workers is ` 60, then per ßðÌÙ ` 54 ãñ ÌÍæ âÖè ·¤æ×»æÚUæð´ ·¤æ ×æØ ÂýçÌçÎÙ
day mean wage of the night shift workers ßðÌÙ ` 60 ãñ, Ìæð ÚUæÌ ×ð´ ·¤æØü ·¤ÚUÙð ßæÜð ·¤æ×»æÚUæð´ ·¤æ
(in `) is :
×æØ ÂýçÌçÎÙ ßðÌÙ (` ×ð´) ãñ Ñ
(1) 66
(1) 66
(2) 69
(2) 69
(3) 74
(3) 74
(4) 75
(4) 75
-o0o-
JEE Main 2015 Answer key Paper 1 Online (April 10, 2015) Code-10
JEE Main 2015 Question Paper 1 Online (April 11, 2015)
hc hc
(1) (1)
me 2 me 2
h h
(2) (2)
me 2 me 2
h h
(3) 2 (3) 2
ce ce
mc2 mc2
(4) 2 (4) 2
he he
→ →
2. A vector A is rotated by a small angle Du 2. ç·¤âè âçÎàæ A ·¤æð Du ÚðUçÇUØÙ (Du<<1) æé×æ ÎðÙð
→ →
radians (Du<<1) to get a new vector B . ÂÚU °·¤ ÙØæ âçÎàæ B ÂýæÌ ãæðÌæ ãñÐ §â ¥ßSÍæ ×ð´
→ → → →
In that case B 2 A is : ãæð»æ Ñ
B2A
(1) 0
(1) àæêØ
→ Du2
A 12 → Du 2
(2) 2 A 12
(2) 2
→
A Du →
(3) A Du
(3)
→ →
B Du 2 A → →
(4) B Du 2 A
(4)
Page 2 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
3. A large number (n) of identical beads, each 3. °·¤ ÂÌÜè ç¿·¤Ùè ÿæñçÌÁ ÀUǸ ÂÚU ·¤§ü (n) âßüâ×
of mass m and radius r are strung on a
×çæ·¤æØð´ (ÕèÇU) çÂÚUæð§ü »§ü ãñ´ Áæð ÀUǸ ÂÚU ¥çÙØç×Ì
thin smooth rigid horizontal rod of length
L (L>>r) and are at rest at random ÌÍæ çßÚUæ× ¥ßSÍæ ×ð´ ãñ´Ð ÂýØð·¤ ÕèÇU ·¤æ ÎýÃØ×æÙ
positions. The rod is mounted between m ÌÍæ çæØæ r ãñ ¥æñÚU ÀUǸ ·¤è Ü´Õæ§ü L ãñ (L>>r)Ð
two rigid supports (see figure). If one of Øã ÀUǸ Îæð ÅðU·¤æð´ (¥æÏæÚUæð´) ÂÚU, ¥æÚðU¹ ×ð´ ÎàææüØð »Øð
the beads is now given a speed v, the
average force experienced by each support
¥ÙéâæÚU çÅU·¤è ãñÐ ØçÎ °·¤ ÕèÇU ·¤æð v ßð» ÂýÎæÙ
after a long time is (assume all collisions ç·¤Øæ ÁæØ Ìæð, °·¤ ÜÕð â×Ø ·ð¤ Âà¿æÌ÷ ÂýØð·¤
are elastic) : ÅðU·¤ (¥æÏæÚU) ÂÚU Ü»Ùð ßæÜð ¥æñâÌ ÕÜ ·¤æ ×æÙ
ãæð»æ (ØçÎ âÖè ÅU·¤Úð´U ÂýØæSÍ ãñ´) Ñ
mv2
(1)
L 2 nr mv2
(1)
2 L 2 nr
mv
(2)
L 2 2nr mv 2
(2)
L 2 2nr
mv 2
(3)
2(L 2 nr) mv 2
(3)
(4) zero 2(L 2 nr)
(4) àæêØ
4. A particle is moving in a circle of radius r
under the action of a force F5ar2 which
is directed towards centre of the circle. 4. ç·¤âè ÕÜ F5ar2 ·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ, °·¤ ·¤æ r çæØæ ·ð¤
Total mechanical energy (kinetic ßëæ ×ð´ »çÌ ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñÐ ÕÜ ·¤è çÎàææ ßëæ ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý ·¤è
energy1potential energy) of the particle
¥æðÚU ãñÐ ØçÎ, r50 ·ð¤ çÜØð çSÍçÌÁ ª¤Áæü ·¤æð àæêØ
is (take potential energy50 for r50) :
×æÙæ ÁæØ Ìæð, §â ·¤æ ·¤è ·é¤Ü Øæ´çæ·¤ ª¤Áæü (»çÌÁ
(1) ar3
ª¤Áæü1çSÍçÌÁ ª¤Áæü) ãæð»è Ñ
1
(2) ar3 (1) ar3
2
1
4 (2) ar3
(3) ar 3 2
3
4
5 (3) ar 3
(4) ar3 3
6
5
(4) ar3
6
Page 3 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
5. A uniform thin rod AB of length L has 5. L ÜÕæ§ü ÌÍæ °·¤â×æÙ ÂÌÜè ÀUǸ AB, ·¤æ ÚñUç¹·¤
bx bx
linear mass density m(x)5 a 1 , where ÎýÃØ×æÙ æÙß m(x)5 a 1 ãñ, Áãæ¡ x ·¤æð ÀUǸ
L L
x is measured from A. If the CM of the
·ð¤ çâÚðU A âð ×æÂæ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ ØçÎ §â ÀUǸ ·¤æ ÎýÃØ×æÙ-
7
rod lies at a distance of L from A, 7
12 ·ð¤Îý ÀUǸ ·ð¤ çâÚðU A âð L
12
ÎêÚUè ÂÚU ãñ Ìæð,
then a and b are related as :
a ÌÍæ b ·ð¤ Õè¿ â´Õ´Ï ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) a5b
(1) a5b
(2) a52b
(2) a52b
(3) 2a5b
(3) 2a5b
(4) 3a52b
(4) 3a52b
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
S Du 1 S Du 1
(2) h (2) h
h r g h r g
S Du S Du
(3) (3)
hh hh
S Du 1 S Du 1
(4) (4)
hh r g hh r g
10. An experiment takes 10 minutes to raise 10. ç·¤âè ÂýØæð» ×ð´ ç·¤âè ª¤c×·¤ (ãèÅUÚU) mæÚUæ °·¤â×æÙ
the temperature of water in a container ÎÚU ÂÚU ª¤c×æ ÎðÙð ÂÚU, °·¤ Âææ ×ð´ ÚU¹ð ÁÜ ·¤æ ÌæÂ
from 08C to 1008C and another 55 minutes
to convert it totally into steam by a heater 08C âð 1008C Ì·¤ ÕɸæÙð ·ð¤ çÜØð 10 ç×ÙÅU ·¤æ
supplying heat at a uniform rate. â×Ø Ü»Ìæ ãñÐ §âè Îýß ·¤æð ÂêæüÌÑ ßæc ×ð´ M¤ÂæÌçÚUÌ
Neglecting the specific heat of the container ·¤ÚUÙð ×ð´ 55 ç×ÙÅU ¥æñÚU Ü»Ìð ãñ´Ð Âææ ·¤è çßçàæcÅU
and taking specific heat of water to be
ª¤c×æ ·¤æð Ù»Ø ÌÍæ ÁÜ ·¤è çßçàæcÅUU ª¤c×æ ·¤æð
1 cal/g 8C , the heat of vapourization
according to this experiment will come out 1 cal/g 8C ÜðÌð ãé°, §â ÂýØæ𻠷𤠥ÙéâæÚU ßæcÂÙ
to be : ·¤è ª¤c×æ ·¤æ ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) 530 cal/g (1) 530 cal/g
(2) 540 cal/g (2) 540 cal/g
(3) 550 cal/g (3) 550 cal/g
(4) 560 cal/g (4) 560 cal/g
Page 6 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
11. Using equipartition of energy, the specific 11. ª¤Áæü ·ð¤ â×çßÖæÁÙ ·ð¤ ©ÂØæð» âð, ·¤ÿæ-Ìæ ÂÚU,
heat (in J kg21 K21) of aluminium at room
°ðÜéç×çÙØ× ·¤è çßçàæcÅU ª¤c×æ (J kg21 K21) ·¤æ
temperature can be estimated to be (atomic
weight of aluminium527) ¥Ùé×æçÙÌ ×æÙ ãæð»æ, (°ðÜéç×çÙØ× ·¤æ ÂÚU×ææé
(1) 25 ÖæÚU527)
(2) 410 (1) 25
(3) 925 (2) 410
(4) 1850 (3) 925
(4) 1850
12. A pendulum with time period of 1s is
losing energy due to damping. At certain 12. 1s ¥æßÌü·¤æÜ ·ð¤ ç·¤âè ÜæðÜ·¤ ·¤è ª¤Áæü ¥ß×´ÎÙ
time its energy is 45 J. If after completing
15 oscillations, its energy has become 15 J,
·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ ÿæØ ãæð ÚUãè ãñÐ ç·¤âè ÿææ §â·¤è ª¤Áæü
its damping constant (in s21) is : 45 J ãñÐ ØçÎ 15 ÎæðÜÙ ÂêÚðU ·¤ÚUÙð ·ð¤ Âà¿æÌ÷ §â·¤è
ª¤Áæü 15 J ãæð ÁæÌè ãñ Ìæð, §â·ð¤ çÜØð ¥ß×´ÎÙ çSÍÚUæ´·¤
1
(1)
30
ln 3 ãñ (s21 ×ð´) Ñ
1 1
ln 3 (1) ln 3
(2) 30
15
(3) 2 1
(2) ln 3
15
1
(4) (3) 2
2
1
(4)
2
Page 7 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
13. A source of sound emits sound waves at 13. ßçÙ ·ð¤ °·¤ dæðÌ âð f0 ¥æßëçæ ·¤è ÌÚ´U»ð´ ©âçÁüÌ
frequency f 0. It is moving towards an
(©Âóæ) ãæðÌè ãñ´Ð Øã dæðÌ ç·¤âè ææðÌæ ·¤è ¥æðÚU °·¤
observer with fixed speed vs(vs<v, where
v is the speed of sound in air). If the çÙØÌ ¿æÜ vs âð ¿Ü ÚUãæ ãñ (vs< v, Áãæ¡ v ßæØé ×ð´
observer were to move towards the source ßçÙ ·¤è ¿æÜ ãñ)Ð ØçÎ ææðÌæ v0 ¿æÜ âð dæðÌ ·¤è
with speed v0, one of the following two ¥æðÚU ¿ÜÙð Ü»ð, Ìæð v0 ×ð´ ÂçÚUßÌüÙ âð, ææðÌæ mæÚUæ âéÙè
graphs (A and B) will give the correct
variation of the frequency f heard by the
»§ü ¥æßëçæ ·ð¤ âãè çß¿ÚUæ (ÂçÚUßÌüÙ) ·¤æð çÙÙæ´ç·¤Ì
observer as v0 is changed. »ýæȤ A Øæ B ×ð´ âð °·¤ »ýæȤ ÎàææüØð»æÐ
The variation of f with v0 is given correctly Ìæð, v0 ·ð¤ âæÍ f ·ð¤ çß¿ÚUæ (ÂçÚUßÌüÙ) ·¤æð âãè
by : ÎàææüÌæ ãñ Ñ
f0
(1) graph A with slope 5 f0
(v 2 vs ) (1) »ýæȤ A ÂýßæÌæ 5 ·ð¤ âæÍ
(v 2 vs )
f0
(2) graph A with slope 5 f0
(v 1 vs ) (2) »ýæȤ A ÂýßæÌæ 5 ·ð¤ âæÍ
(v 1 vs )
f0
(3) graph B with slope 5 f0
(v 2 vs ) (3) »ýæȤ B ÂýßæÌæ 5 ·ð¤ âæÍ
(v 2 vs )
f0
(4) graph B with slope 5 f0
(v 1 vs ) (4) »ýæȤ B ÂýßæÌæ 5 ·ð¤ âæÍ
(v 1 vs )
Page 8 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
14. A wire, of length L(520 cm), is bent into 14. L(520 cm) ÜÕæ§ü ·ð¤ °·¤ ÌæÚU ·¤æð °·¤ ¥Ïü ßëææ·¤æÚU
a semi-circular arc. If the two equal halves,
¿æ ·ð¤ M¤Â ×ð´ ×æðǸ çÎØæ »Øæ ãñÐ ØçÎ §â ¿æ ·ð¤ Îæð
of the arc, were each to be uniformly
charged with charges 6Q, [|Q|5103 e0 â×æÙ Öæ»æð´ ·¤æð 6Q ¥æßðàæ âð °·¤â×æÙ ¥æßðçàæÌ
Coulomb where e0 is the permittivity (in ·¤ÚU çÎØæ ÁæØ [|Q|5103 e0 ·ê¤Üæò× Áãæ¡ e0 (SI
SI units) of free space] the net electric field ×ææ·¤ ×ð ´ ) ×é Ì ¥æ·¤æàæ ·¤è çßlé Ì àæèÜÌæ
at the centre O of the semi-circular arc
would be :
(ÂÚUæßñléÌæ´·¤) ãñ ], Ìæð, ¥Ïüßëææ·¤æÚU ¿æ ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý O
ÂÚU ÙðÅU çßléÌ ÿæðæ ãæð»æ Ñ
∧
(1) (503103 N/C) j ∧
(1) (503103 N/C) j
∧
(2) (253103 N/C) i ∧
(2) (253103 N/C) i
∧
(3) (253103 N/C) j ∧
(3) (253103 N/C) j
∧
(4) (503103 N/C) i ∧
(4) (503103 N/C) i
(1) 3V
(1) 3V
(2) 4V
(2) 4V
(3) 5V
(3) 5V
(4) 6V
(4) 6V
Page 10 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
18. The value of the resistor, RS, needed in the 18. Øãæ¡ ÎàææüØð »Øð ÇUè.âè. (dc) ßæðËÅUÌæ çÙØ´æ·¤ ÂçÚUÂÍ
dc voltage regulator circuit shown here,
×ð´, ¥æßàØ·¤ ÂýçÌÚUæðÏ RS ·¤æ ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
equals :
(1) (Vi2VL)/n IL
(1) (Vi2VL)/n IL
(2) (Vi1VL)/n IL
(2) (Vi1VL)/n IL
(3) (Vi2VL)/(n11) IL
(3) (Vi2VL)/(n11) IL
(4) (Vi1VL)/(n11) IL
(4) (Vi1VL)/(n11) IL
Page 11 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
19. Two long straight parallel wires, carrying 19. Îæð ÜÕð, âèÏð, â×æÌÚU ÌæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤è ÎêÚUè d ãñÐ
(adjustable) currents I1 and I2, are kept at
§Ùâð I1 ÌÍæ I2 ÏæÚUæØð´ ÂýßæçãÌ ãæð ÚUãè ãñ´ (çÁÙ·ð¤ ×æÙ
a distance d apart. If the force F between
the two wires is taken as positive when â×æØæðçÁÌ ç·¤Øð Áæ â·¤Ìð ãñ´) ØçÎ §Ù ÌæÚUæð´ ·ð¤ Õè¿
the wires repel each other and negative ÂýçÌ·¤áüæ ãæðÙð ÂÚU §Ù·ð¤ Õè¿ ÕÜ F ·¤æð ÒÏÙæ×·¤Ó
when the wires attract each other, the ÌÍæ §Ù ·ð¤ Õè¿ ¥æ·¤áüæ ãæðÙð ÂÚU ÕÜ F ·¤æ𠫤ææ×·¤
graph showing the dependence of F, on
the product I1I2, would be :
×æÙæ ÁæØ Ìæð, I1 ÌÍæ I2 ·ð¤ »éæÙÈ¤Ü (I1I2) ÂÚU F
·ð¤ çÙÖüÚU ãæðÙð ·¤æð ·¤æñÙ âæ »ýæȤ ÆUè·¤ (âãè) ÎàææüÌæ
ãñ?
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Page 12 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
20. A wire carrying current I is tied between 20. IÏæÚUæßæãè °·¤ ÌæÚU, P ÌÍæ Q çÕÎé¥æð´ ÂÚU Õ´Ïæ ãñ
points P and Q and is in the shape of a
¥æñÚU ¥ÂÙð ¥æâ-Âæâ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÿæðæ B ·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ (Áæð
circular arch of radius R due to a uniform
magnetic field B (perpendicular to the xxx mæÚUæ ÎàææüØæ »Øæ ãñ ¥æñÚU §â ÂëcÆ ·ð¤ ÜÕßÌ÷ ãñ)
plane of the paper, shown by xxx) in the R çæØæ ·ð¤ ßëææ·¤æÚU ¿æ ·ð¤ M¤Â ×ð´ ¥æ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
vicinity of the wire. If the wire subtends ØçÎ Øã ÌæÚU, ©â ßëæ ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý ÂÚU çÁâ·¤æ Øã ¿æÂ
an angle 2u0 at the centre of the circle (of
which it forms an arch) then the tension
Öæ» ãñ, 2u0 ·¤æðæ ÕÙæÌæ ãñ Ìæð, ÌæÚU ×ð´ ÌÙæß ãæð»æ Ñ
in the wire is :
(1) IBR
(1) IBR IBR
(2) sinu0
IBR
(2) sinu0
IBR
(3) 2sinu0
IBR
(3) 2sinu0
IBRu0
(4) sinu0
IBRu0
(4) sinu0
21. ç·¤âè ÀUæðÅðU âð δÇU ¿éÕ·¤ ·¤æð Âëßè ·ð¤ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÿæðæ
21. A short bar magnet is placed in the ·ð¤ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ØæØæðæÚU ×ð´ §â Âý·¤æÚU ÚU¹æ »Øæ ãñ ç·¤
magnetic meridian of the earth with north ©â·¤æ ©æÚU Ïýéß, ©æÚU ·¤è ¥æðÚU ãñÐ §â·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ
pole pointing north. Neutral points are
found at a distance of 30 cm from the ¿éÕ·¤ ·ð¤ ×ØçÕÎé âð Âêßü-Âçà¿× çÎàææ ×𴠹贿è
magnet on the East - West line, drawn »§ü âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ ÂÚU, ©ÎæâèÙ çÕÎé ÂýæÌ ãæðÌð ãñ´, çÁÙ·¤è
through the middle point of the magnet. ¿éÕ·¤ âð ÎêÚUè 30 cm ãñÐ Ìæð, ¿éÕ·¤ ·¤æ ¿éÕ·¤èØ
The magnetic moment of the magnet in
¥ææêæü (Am2 ×ð´) ãæð»æ ֻܻ Ñ
Am2 is close to :
m0 2 (çÎØæ ãñ,
m0 2
5 10 7 SI ×ææ·¤ ×ð́ ÌÍæ BH5Âëßè
(Given 5 10 7 in SI units and 4p
4p
B H 5Horizontal component of earths ·ð¤ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÿæðæ ·¤æ ÿæñçÌÁ æÅU·¤ 53.631025
magnetic field53.631025 Tesla.) Tesla.)
(1) 9.7 (1) 9.7
(2) 4.9 (2) 4.9
(3) 19.4 (3) 19.4
(4) 14.6 (4) 14.6
Page 13 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
22. For the LCR circuit, shown here, the 22. Øãæ¡ ÎàææüØð »Øð LCR ÂçÚUÂÍ ×ð´, çßléÌÏæÚUæ, ¥æÚUæðçÂÌ
current is observed to lead the applied
ßæðËÅUÌæ âð ¥»ý»æ×è (¥æ»ð) ÚUãÌè ãñÐ ÂçÚUÂÍ ×ð´ ÁéǸð
voltage. An additional capacitor C9, when
joined with the capacitor C present in the â´ÏæçÚUæ C ·ð¤ âæÍ °·¤ ¥çÌçÚUÌ â´ÏæçÚUæ C9 ÁæðǸÙð
circuit, makes the power factor of the âð, §â ÂçÚUÂÍ ·¤æ àæçÌ-»éæ·¤ §·¤æ§ü (°·¤·¤) ãæð
circuit unity. The capacitor C9, must have ÁæÌæ ãñÐ Ìæð, â´ÏæçÚUæ C9 ·¤æð ¥ßàØ ãè ÁæðÇ¸æ »Øæ
been connected in :
ãæð»æ Ñ
(2) (2 2 i 2 3 j ) and ( 3 i 2 2 j )
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(2) (2 2 i 2 3 j ) ÌÍæ ( 3 i 2 2 j )
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(3) ( 2 i 1 3 j ) and ( i 1 2 j )
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(3) ( 2 i 1 3 j ) ÌÍæ ( i 1 2 j )
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(4) ( 3 i 1 4 j ) and ( 4 i 2 3 j )
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
(4) ( 3 i 1 4 j ) ÌÍæ ( 4 i 2 3 j )
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
Page 14 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
24. A thin convex lens of focal length f is put 24. °·¤ ©æÜ Üð´â ·¤æð, ¥æÚðU¹ ×ð´ ÎàææüØð »Øð ¥ÙéâæÚU
on a plane mirror as shown in the figure.
ç·¤âè â×ÌÜ ÎÂüæ ·ð¤ ª¤ÂÚU ÚU¹æ »Øæ ãñÐ Üð´â ·¤è
When an object is kept at a distance a
from the lens - mirror combination, its Ȥæð·¤â ÎêÚUè f ãñÐ §â â´ØæðÁÙ âð ç·¤âè ßSÌé ·¤æð a
a ÎêÚUè ÂÚU ÚU¹Ùð âð, ©â·¤æ ÂýçÌçÕÕ â´ØæðÁÙ ·ð¤ âæ×Ùð
image is formed at a distance in front
3 a
of the combination. The value of a is : 3
ÎêÚUè ÂÚU ÕÙÌæ ãñÐ Ìæð, a ·¤æ ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
(1) f (1) f
(2) 2f (2) 2f
(3) 3f (3) 3f
3 3
(4) f (4) f
2 2
25. In a Youngs double slit experiment with 25. Ø´» ·ð¤ ç·¤âè çm-çÛæÚUè ÂýØæð» ×ð´, ÂýØéÌ Âý·¤æàæ ·¤è
light of wavelength l the separation of slits
is d and distance of screen is D such that
ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü l, çÛæçÚUØæð´ (çSÜÅUæð´) ·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤è ÎêÚUè d,
D > > d > > l. If the Fringe width is b, the ÌÍæ ÂÎð ü ·¤è çÛæçÚUØæð ´ âð Îê Ú Uè D ãñ Ð
distance from point of maximum intensity Áãæ¡, D > > d > > lÐ ØçÎ, çÈý´¤Á ¿æñǸæ§ü b ãñ Ìæð,
to the point where intensity falls to half of ¥çÏ·¤Ì× ÌèßýÌæ ·ð¤ çÕÎé âð, ÎæðÙæð´ ¥æðÚU ·ð¤ ©Ù çÕÎé¥æð´
maximum intensity on either side is :
·¤è ÎêÚUè, Áãæ¡ ÌèßýÌæ, ¥çÏ·¤Ì× âð ¥æÏè ãæð ÁæÌè ãñ,
b ãæð»è Ñ
(1)
2
b
b (1)
(2) 2
4
b
b (2)
(3) 4
3
b
b (3)
(4) 3
6
b
(4)
6
Page 15 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
26. Unpolarized light of intensity I0 is incident 26. I0 ÌèßýÌæ ·¤æ ¥ÏýéçßÌ Âý·¤æàæ, ·¤æ¡¿ ·ð¤ Üæò·¤ (»éÅU·ð¤)
on surface of a block of glass at Brewsters
angle. In that case, which one of the ·¤è âÌã (ÂëcÆU) ÂÚU, ÕýêSÅUÚU ·¤æðæ ÂÚU, ¥æÂçÌÌ ãæðÌæ
following statements is true ? ãñÐ §â çSÍçÌ ·ð¤ çÜØð çÙÙçÜç¹Ì ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙâæ
(1) transmitted light is partially ·¤ÍÙ âãè (âØ) ãñ?
polarized with intensity I0/2.
(1) ÂæÚU»Ì Âý·¤æàæ, ¥æ´çàæ·¤ ÏýéçßÌ ãæð»æ ¥æñÚU ©â·¤è
(2) transmitted light is completely
ÌèßýÌæ I0/2 ãæð»èÐ
polarized with intensity less than
I0/2. (2) ÂæÚU»Ì Âý·¤æàæ ÂêæüM¤Â âð Ïýçé ßÌ ãæð»æ ¥æñÚU ©â·¤è
(3) reflected light is completely polarized ÌèßýÌæ I0/2 âð ·¤× ãæð»èÐ
with intensity less than I0/2.
(3) ÂÚUæßçÌüÌ Âý·¤æàæ ÂêæüÌÑ ÏýéçßÌ ãæð»æ ¥æñÚU ©â·¤è
(4) reflected light is partially polarized
with intensity I0/2.
ÌèßýÌæ I0/2 âð ·¤× ãæð»èÐ
(4) ÂÚUæßçÌüÌ Âý·¤æàæ ÂêæüÌÑ ÏýéçßÌ ãæð»æ ¥æñÚU ©â·¤è
27. The de - Broglie wavelength associated ÌèßýÌæ I0/2 ãæð»èÐ
with the electron in the n54 level is :
(1) two times the de-Broglie wavelength 27. n54 SÌÚU ÂÚU, ç·¤âè §ÜðÅþUæòÙ âð â´Õh Îð-ÕýæòÜè
of the electron in the ground state
ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ãæð»è Ñ
(2) four times the de-Broglie wavelength
of the electron in the ground state (1) ØêÙÌ× ª¤Áæü SÌÚU ÂÚU §ÜðÅþUæòÙ ·¤è Îð-ÕýæòÜè
(3) half of the de-Broglie wavelength of ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü âð Îæð »éÙæÐ
the electron in the ground state
(2) ØêÙÌ× ª¤Áæü SÌÚU ÂÚU §ÜðÅþUæòÙ ·¤è Îð-ÕýæòÜè
(4) 1/4th of the de-Broglie wavelength ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ·¤è ¿æÚU »éÙæÐ
of the electron in the ground state
(3) ØêÙÌ× ª¤Áæü SÌÚU ÂÚU §ÜðÅþUæòÙ ·¤è Îð-ÕýæòÜè
28. Let Nb be the number of b particles emitted ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ·¤è ¥æÏèÐ
24 (4) ØêÙÌ× ª¤Áæü SÌÚU ÂÚU §ÜðÅþUæòÙ ·¤è Îð-ÕýæòÜè
by 1 gram of Na radioactive nuclei
(half life515 hrs) in 7.5 hours, Nb is close
ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ·¤è 1/4.
to (Avogadro number 56.023310 23/g.
mole) :
24
(1) 6.2310 21 28. ØçÎ 1 »ýæ× Na ÚðUçÇUØæð°çÅUß ÙæçÖ·¤ (¥Ïü ¥æØé
(2) 7.5310 21 15 æ´ÅðU) mæÚUæ 7.5 æ´ÅðU ×ð´ ©âçÁüÌ b ·¤ææð´ ·¤è
(3) 1.25310 22 â´Øæ Nb ãæð Ìæð, Nb ·¤æ ×æÙ çÙ·¤ÅU ãæð»æ
(4) 1.75310 22 (¥æßæð»æÎýUæð â´Øæ 6.02331023/g. mol) :
(1) 6.2310 21
(2) 7.5310 21
(3) 1.25310 22
(4) 1.75310 22
Page 16 PHYSICS : English & Hindi 01
29. A 2V battery is connected across AB as 29. ¥æÚðU¹ ×ð´ 2V ·¤è °·¤ ÕñÅUÚUè A ß B ·ð¤ Õè¿ ÁéǸè ãñÐ
shown in the figure. The value of the
ØçÎ ÂãÜè Îàææ ×ð´ ÕñÅUÚUè ·¤æ ÏÙæ×·¤ ÅUç×üÙÜ A âð
current supplied by the battery when in
one case batterys positive terminal is ÌÍæ ÎêâÚUè Îàææ ×ð´ ÏÙæ×·¤ ÅUç×üÙÜ B âð ÁéǸæ ãæð Ìæð,
connected to A and in other case when §Ù ÎæðÙæð´ Îàææ¥æð´ ×ð´ ÕñÅUÚUè mæÚUæ ÂýÎæ çßléÌ ÏæÚUæ ·¤æ
positive terminal of battery is connected ×æÙ ·ý¤×àæÑ ãæð»æ Ñ
to B will respectively be :
10. Under ambient conditions, which among 10. ÂçÚUßðàæ çSÍçÌ ÂÚU, ·¤æñÙ-ÂëcÆU â´ç·ý¤Ø·¤ ÁÜèØ çßÜØÙ
the following surfactants will form micelles
in aqueous solution at lowest molar ×ð´ âÕâð ·¤× ×æðÜèØ âæ´Îýæ ×ð´ ç×âðÜ ÕÙæ°»æ?
concentration ?
(1)
(1)
(2) CH32(CH2)132 OSO2
3 Na
1
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
11. Ìß X ·ð¤ ¿æÚU Øæñç»·¤æð´ ·ð¤ âêææð´ ×ð´ âð »ÜÌ âêæ
11. Choose the incorrect formula out of the ¿éçÙ° Ñ
four compounds for an element X below :
(1) X2Cl3
(1) X2Cl3
(2) X2O3
(2) X 2O3
(3) X2(SO4)3
(3) X2(SO4)3
(4) XPO4
(4) XPO4
19. Which of the following complex ions has 19. çÙÙçÜç¹Ì â´·é¤Ü ¥æØÙæð´ ×ð´ âð 緤⠥æØÙ ·¤è t2g
electrons that are symmetrically filled in
both t2g and eg orbitals ?
¥æñÚU eg ·¤ÿæ·¤æð´ ×ð´ §ÜðÅþUæòÙ â×ç×Ì M¤Â âð ÖÚðU ãñ´?
(1) [CoF6]32 (1) [CoF6]32
20. Addition of phosphate fertilisers to water 20. ȤæòSÈð¤ÅU ØéÌ ©ßüÚU·¤æð´ ·ð¤ ç×ÜæÙð âð ÁÜæàæØæð´ ×ð´ Ñ
bodies causes : (1) àæñßæÜæð´ ·¤è ¥ØæçÏ·¤ ßëçh ãæðÌè ãñÐ
(1) enhanced growth of algae
(2) ÁÜ ×ð´ çßÜèÙ ¥æòâèÁÙ ·¤è ×æææ ÕɸÌè ãñÐ
(2) increase in amount of dissolved
oxygen in water (3) ·ñ¤çËâØ× È¤æòSÈð¤ÅU ·¤æ çÙÿæðÂæ ãæðÌæ ãñÐ
(3) deposition of calcium phosphate (4) ×ÀUçÜØæð´ ·¤è Áèß â´Øæ ×ð´ ßëçh ãæðÌè ãñÐ
(4) increase in fish population
(2) and
(2) ¥æñÚU
(3) and
(3) ¥æñÚU
(4) and
(4) ¥æñÚU
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
25. In the reaction sequence 25. çÙÙçÜç¹Ì ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ·ý¤× ×ð´ ©ÂæÎ B ãñ Ñ
OH2
D OH2 D
2 CH 3 CHO → A → B ; the 2 CH 3 CHO → A → B
product B is : (1) CH32CH22CH22CH22OH
(1) CH32CH22CH22CH22OH (2) CH32CH5CH2CHO
(2) CH32CH5CH2CHO
(3)
(3)
(4) CH32CH22CH22CH3
(4) CH32CH22CH22CH3
Page 8 CHEMISTRY : English & Hindi 01
26. Which compound exhibits maximum 26. çÙÙçÜç¹Ì ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ-âæ Øæñç»·¤ âßæüçÏ·¤ çmÏýéß
dipole moment among the following ?
¥ææêæü ÎàææüÌæ ãñ?
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Page 9 CHEMISTRY : English & Hindi 01
28. Accumulation of which of the following 28. ¥æðÁSßè ÃØæØæ× ·ð¤ ȤÜSßM¤Â, ×æ´âÂðçàæØæð´ ×ð´ ç·¤â
molecules in the muscles occurs as a result
Øæñç»·¤ ·¤æ â´¿ØÙ ãæðÌæ ãñ?
of vigorous exercise ?
(1) Glucose (1) Üê·¤æð$Á
(2) Glycogen (2) Üñ·¤æð$ÁÙ
(3) L-lactic acid (3) L-ÜñçÅU·¤ ¥Ü
(4) Pyruvic acid
(4) ÂñM¤çß·¤ ¥Ü
29. Which artificial sweetener contains
chlorine ? 29. 緤⠷ë¤çæ× ×ÏéÚU·¤ ×ð´ ÜæðÚUèÙ ãñ?
(1) Aspartame (1) °ðSÂæÅðüU×
(2) Saccharin (2) âñ·¤ÚUèÙ
(3) Sucralose
(3) âê·ý¤æÜæðâ
(4) Alitame
(4) °ðçÜÅðU×
30. A pink coloured salt turns blue on heating.
The presence of which cation is most 30. °·¤ »éÜæÕè Üßæ, »ÚU× ·¤ÚUÙð ÂÚU ÙèÜæ ãæð ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
likely ?
Üßæ ×ð´ ç·¤â ÏÙæØÙ ·ð¤ ãæðÙð ·¤è âßæüçÏ·¤ â´ÖæßÙæ
(1) Cu 21 ãñ?
(2) Fe21
(1) Cu 21
(3) Zn21
(2) Fe21
(4) Co21
(3) Zn 21
(4) Co21
-o0o-
-o0o-
Page 1 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 01
1. Let A5{x1, x2, ..., x7} and B5{y1, y2, y3} 1. ×æÙæ A5{x1, x2, ..., x7} ÌÍæ B5{y1, y2, y3}
be two sets containing seven and three
°ðâð Îæð â×éæØ ãñ´ çÁÙ×ð´ ·ý¤×àæÑ âæÌ ÌÍæ ÌèÙ çßçÖóæ
distinct elements respectively. Then the
total number of functions f : A ® B that ¥ßØß ãñ´ ; Ìæð °ðâð ȤÜÙæð´ f : A ® B ·¤è ·é¤Ü
are onto, if there exist exactly three â´Øæ, Áæð ç·¤ ¥æÀUæη¤ ãñ´, ØçÎ A ×ð´ °ðâð ÆUè·¤ ÌèÙ
elements x in A such that f (x)5y2, is equal x ¥ßØß ãñ´ çÁÙ·ð¤ çÜ° f (x)5y2 ãñ, ãñ Ñ
to :
(1) 14 . 7C2
(1) 14 . 7C2
(2) 16 . 7C3
(2) 16 . 7C3
(3) 12 . 7C2
(3) 12 . 7C2
(4) 14 . 7C3
(4) 14 . 7C3
Im z 5 Im z 5
the minimum value of is : ·¤æ ØêÙÌ× ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
(Im z ) 5 (Im z )5
(1) 21 (1) 21
(2) 22 (2) 22
(3) 24 (3) 24
(4) 25 (4) 25
(3) 61 (2) 65
(3) 61
1
(4) 6
25 1
(4) 6
25
Page 2 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 01
(2) 2y 2 3 x 5 0 (2) 2y 2 3 x 5 0
(3) 2y 1 3 x 5 0 (3) 2y 1 3 x 5 0
(4) 2x 2 3 y 5 0 (4) 2x 2 3 y 5 0
Page 4 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 01
12. Let k and K be the minimum and the
(1 1 x )0.6
maximum values of the function 12. ×æÙæ k ÌÍæ K, ȤÜÙ f (x) 5 ·ð ¤
0.6 1 1 x 0.6
(1 1 x )
f (x) 5 in [0, 1] respectively, [0, 1] ×ð´·ý¤×àæÑ ØêÙÌ× ÌÍæ ¥çÏ·¤Ì× ×æÙ ãñ´, Ìæð
1 1 x 0.6
·ý¤ç×Ì Øé× (k, K) ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
then the ordered pair (k, K) is equal to :
(1) (1, 20.6)
(1) (1, 20.6)
(2) (220.4, 20.6)
(2) (220.4, 20.6)
(3) (220.6, 1)
(3) (220.6, 1)
(4) (220.4, 1)
(4) (220.4, 1)
13. From the top of a 64 metres high tower, a 13. 64 ×èÅUÚU ª¡¤¿è °·¤ ×èÙæÚU ·ð¤ çàæ¹ÚU âð 48 ×è./âð.
stone is thrown upwards vertically with ·¤è »çÌ âð ©ßæüÏÚU ª¤ÂÚU ·¤è çÎàææ ×ð´ °·¤ ÂÍÚU
the velocity of 48 m/s. The greatest height Èð´¤·¤æ »ØæÐ Øã ×æÙÌð ãé° ç·¤ »éL¤ßæ·¤áüæ ßÚUæ
(in metres) attained by the stone, assuming
g532 ×è. / âð . 2 ãñ , ßã ¥çÏ·¤Ì× ª¡ ¤ ¿æ§ü
the value of the gravitational acceleration
g532 m/s2, is : (×èÅUÚUæð´ ×ð´) Áãæ¡ Ì·¤ ÂÍÚU Âã¡é¿Ìæ ãñ, ãñ Ñ
(1) 100 (1) 100
(2) 88 (2) 88
(3) 128 (3) 128
(4) 112 (4) 112
(
log t 1 1 1 t 2 ) dt 5 1 ( g (t))21 C , ØçÎ ∫
(
log t 1 1 1 t 2 ) dt 5 1 ( g (t))21 C
14. If ∫ 2
14.
1 1 t2 2
1 1 t2
where C is a constant, then g(2) is equal ãñ, Áãæ¡ C °·¤ ¥¿ÚU ãñ, Ìæð g(2) ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
to :
(1) 2 log ( 2 1 5 )
(1) 2 log ( 2 1 5 )
(2) log ( 2 1 5 )
(2) log ( 2 1 5 )
1
1 (3) log ( 2 1 5 )
(3) log ( 2 1 5 ) 5
5
1
1 (4) log ( 2 1 5 )
(4) log ( 2 1 5 ) 2
2
Page 5 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 01
15. Let f : R ® R be a function such that 15. ×æÙæ f : R ® R °·¤ °ðâæ ȤÜÙ ãñ, ç·¤ âÖè x e R
f (22x)5f (21x) and f (42x)5f (41x),
·ð¤ çÜ°, f (22x)5f (21x) ÌÍæ f (42x)5
2
2 50
for all x e R and ∫ f (x ) dx 5 5 . Then the
f (41x) ãñ ¥æñÚU ∫ f (x ) dx 5 5 ãñ, Ìæð ∫ f ( x ) dx
0
0 10
50
·¤æ ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
value of ∫ f ( x ) dx is :
(1) 80
10
(4) 200
16. ×æÙæ f : (21, 1) ® R °·¤ â´ÌÌ È¤ÜÙ ãñÐ ØçÎ
16. Let f : (21, 1) ® R be a continuous sin x
3 3
sin x ∫ f (t) dt 5 x ãñ, Ìæð f ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
3 0
2 2
function. If ∫ f (t) dt 5
2
x, then
0
3
(1)
3 2
f is equal to :
2 (2) 3
3 3
(1) (3)
2 2
(2) 3 1
(4)
2
3
(3)
2
17. x5f (y) ¥ß·¤Ü â×è·¤ÚUæ
1
(4) ydx2(x12y2)dy50 ·¤æ ãÜ ãñÐ
2
ØçÎ f (21)51 ãñ, Ìæð f (1) ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
(1) 4
17. The solution of the differential equation
ydx2(x12y2)dy50 is x5f (y). (2) 3
If f (21)51, then f (1) is equal to : (3) 2
(1) 4 (4) 1
(2) 3
(3) 2
(4) 1
Page 6 MATHEMATICS : English & Hindi 01
18. A straight line L through the point (3, 22) 18. çÕ´Îé (3, 22) âð ãæð·¤ÚU ÁæÙð ßæÜè °·¤ âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ L,
is inclined at an angle of 608 to the line
ÚUð¹æ 3 x 1 y 5 1 ·ð¤ âæÍ 608 ·¤æ ·¤æðæ ÕÙæÌè
3 x 1 y 5 1 . If L also intersects the
ãñÐ ØçÎ L, x-¥ÿæ ·¤æð Öè ·¤æÅUÌè ãñ, Ìæð L ·¤æ
x-axis, then the equation of L is :
â×è·¤ÚUæ ãñ Ñ
(1) y 1 3 x 1 2 23 3 50
(1) y 1 3 x 1 2 23 3 50
(2) y 2 3 x 1 2 13 3 50
(2) y 2 3 x 1 2 13 3 50
(3) 3 y 2x 1 312 3 50
(3) 3 y 2x 1 312 3 50
(4) 3 y 1x 2 312 3 50
(4) 3 y 1x 2 312 3 50
25. In a parallelogram ABCD, 5a, 25. °·¤ â×æ´ÌÚU ¿ÌéÖéüÁ ABCD ×ð´, 5a, 5b
5b and 5c, then has the ÌÍæ 5c ãñ, Ìæð ·¤æ ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
value :
(1)
1
( 2
a 2b 1c2 2
) (1)
1
2
( a2 2 b2 1 c2 )
2
(2)
1
(a 2 2
1b 2c 2
) (2)
1
4
( a2 1 b2 2 c2 )
4
(3)
1
( 2
b 1c 2a2 2
) (3)
1
3
( b2 1 c2 2 a2 )
3
(4)
1
(a 2 2
1b 1c 2
) (4)
1
2
( a2 1 b2 1 c2 )
2
3 1 3
28. If cosa 1 cosb 5 and sin a 1 sinb 5 28. ØçÎ cosa 1 cosb 5 ÌÍæ
2 2 2
and u is the arithmetic mean of a and b, 1
then sin2u1cos2u is equal to : sin a 1 sinb 5 ãñ´, ÌÍæ a ÌÍæ b ·¤æ â×æ´ÌÚU
2
3 ×æØ u ãñ, Ìæð sin2u1cos2u ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
(1)
5
3
4 (1)
5
(2)
5
4
7 (2)
5
(3)
5
7
8 (3)
5
(4)
5
8
(4)
5
29. Let 10 vertical poles standing at equal
distances on a straight line, subtend the
same angle of elevation a at a point O on 29. ×æÙæ °·¤ âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ ÂÚU â×æÙ ÎêçÚUØæð´ ÂÚU ¹Ç¸ð 10
this line and all the poles are on the same ©ßæüÏÚU ¹´Öð §â âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ ·ð¤ °·¤ çÕ´Îé O ÂÚU
side of O. If the height of the longest pole
is h and the distance of the foot of the
â×æÙ ©óæØÙ ·¤æðæ a ÕÙæÌð ãñ´, ÁÕç·¤ âÖè ¹´Öð O
smallest pole from O is a ; then the ·ð¤ °·¤ ãè ¥æðÚU çSÍÌ ãñ´Ð ØçÎ âÕâð ÕǸ𠹴Öð ·¤è
distance between two consecutive poles, ª¡¤¿æ§ü h ãñ ÌÍæ âÕâð ÀUæðÅðU ¹´Öð ·ð¤ ÂæÎ ·¤è O âð
is : ÎêÚUè a ãñ ; Ìæð Îæð ·ý¤×æ»Ì ¹´Öæð´ ·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤è ÎêÚUè ãñ Ñ
h sin a 1 a cosa
(1) h sin a 1 a cosa
9 sin a (1)
9 sin a
h cosa 2 a sin a
(2) h cosa 2 a sin a
9 cosa (2)
9 cosa
-o0o-
-o0o-
JEE Main 2015 Answer Key Paper 1 Online (April 11, 2015) - Code-11
JEE Main 2014 Question Paper 1 Online April 9, 2014
PART A PHYSICS Öæ» A ÖæñçÌ·¤ çßææÙ
1. An experiment is performed to obtain the 1. ÜÕæ§ü L ·ð¤ °·¤ âÚUÜ ÜæðÜ·¤ ·¤æ ÂýØæð» ·¤ÚU »éL¤ßèØ
value of acceleration due to gravity g by ßÚUæ g ·¤æ ×æÙ çÙ·¤æÜÙð ·¤æ °·¤ ÂýØæð» ç·¤Øæ ÁæÌæ
using a simple pendulum of length L. In ãñÐ §â ÂýØæð» ×ð´ 100 ÎæðÜÙæð´ ·¤æ â×Ø 1 âð·´¤ÇUU
this experiment time for 100 oscillations is ¥ËÂÌ×æ¡·¤ ßæÜè æǸUè âð ×æÂæ ÁæÌæ ãñ ¥æñÚ ×æÙ
measured by using a watch of 1 second 90.0 âð·´¤ÇU ãñÐ ÜÕæ§ü L 1 mm ¥ËÂÌ×æ¡·¤ ßæÜð
least count and the value is 90.0 seconds. ×èÅUÚU Âñ×æÙð âð ×æÂè ÁæÌè ãñ ¥æñÚU §â·¤æ ×æÙ
The length L is measured by using a meter 20.0 cm ãñÐ g ·ð¤ ×æÙ ·ð¤ çÙÏüæÚUæ ×ð´ æéçÅU ãæð»è Ñ
scale of least count 1 mm and the value is
20.0 cm. The error in the determination
(1) 1.7%
of g would be :
(2) 2.7%
(1) 1.7%
(3) 4.4%
(2) 2.7%
(4) 2.27%
(3) 4.4%
(4) 2.27%
2. ×êÜ çÕÎé âð t50 ÂÚU ÂýÿæðçÂÌ °·¤ Âýÿæð ·¤è çSÍçÌ
→ ∧ ∧
2. The position of a projectile launched from t52s ÂÚU r 5(40 i 1 50 j ) m âð Îè ÁæÌè ãñÐ
the origin at t50 is given by ØçÎ Âýÿæð ÿæñçÌÁ âð u ·¤æðæ ÂÚU ÂýÿæðçÂÌ ç·¤Øæ »Øæ
→ ∧ ∧ Íæ, ÌÕ u ãñ (g510 ms22 Üð´).
r 5(40 i 1 50 j ) m at t52s. If the
projectile was launched at an angle u from
the horizontal, then u is (take g510 ms22). (1) tan21 2 3
(4) tan21 4 5
4. A block A of mass 4 kg is placed on 4. ÎýÃØ×æÙ 4 kg ·ð¤ °·¤ Üæ·¤ A ·¤æð °·¤ ÎêâÚðU ÎýÃØ×æÙ
another block B of mass 5 kg, and the block 5 kg ·ð¤ °·¤ Üæ·¤ B ·ð¤ ª¤ÂÚU ÚU¹æ ãñ ¥æñÚU Üæ·¤ B
B rests on a smooth horizontal table. If °·¤ ç¿·¤Ùè ÿæñçÌÁ ×ðÁ ÂÚU çßææ× ¥ßSÍæ ×ð´ ÚU¹æ
the minimum force that can be applied on ãñÐ ØçÎ Üæ·¤ A ÂÚU ßã ØêÙÌ× ÕÜ, çÁââð ç·¤
A so that both the blocks move together is ÎæðÙæ´ð Üæ·¤ °·¤ âæÍ »çÌàæèÜ ãæð´, 12 N ãñ ÌÕ
12 N, the maximum force that can be Üæ·¤ B ÂÚU Ü»æØæ »Øæ ¥çÏ·¤Ì× ÕÜ, çÁââð ç·¤
applied on B for the blocks to move ÎæðÙæ´ð Üæ·¤ »çÌàæèÜ ãæð´, ãæð»æ Ñ
together will be :
(1) 30 N (1) 30 N
(2) 25 N (2) 25 N
(3) 27 N (3) 27 N
(4) 48 N (4) 48 N
(1) 20 N
(2) 10 N
(1) 20 N
(3) 60 N
(2) 10 N
(4) 40 N
(3) 60 N
(4) 40 N
8
(1)
8 7
(1)
7
15
(2)
15 14
(2)
14
8
(3)
8 7
(3)
7 15
(4)
15 14
(4)
14
9. The amplitude of a simple pendulum, 9. ßæØé ×ð´ ÎæðÜÙ ·¤ÚU ÚUãð °·¤ ÌÙé »æðÜèØ ÕæÕ ßæÜð âÚUÜ
oscillating in air with a small spherical bob, ÜæðÜ·¤ ·¤æ ¥æØæ× 40 âð·´¤ÇU ×ð´ 10 cm âð 8 cm
decreases from 10 cm to 8 cm in 40 seconds. Ì·¤ æÅU ÁæÌæ ãñ Ð Øã ×æÙ Üð´ ç·¤ SÅUæð·¤ ·¤æ çÙØ×
Assuming that Stokes law is valid, and âãè ãñ ¥æñÚU ßæØé ·¤æ ·¤æÕüÙ ÇUæ§ü¥æòâæ§Ç âð àØæÙÌæ
ratio of the coefficient of viscosity of air to »éææ´·¤ ·¤æ ¥ÙéÂæÌ 1.3 ãñ, ÌÕ ·¤æÕüÙ ÇUæ§ü ¥æòâæ§ÇU
that of carbon dioxide is 1.3, the time in ×ð´ §â ÜæðÜ·¤ ·ð¤ ¥æØæ× ·¤æð 10 cm âð 5 cm Ì·¤
which amplitude of this pendulum will æÅUÙð ×ð ´ Ü»æ â×Ø Ü»Ö» ãæð » æ
reduce from 10 cm to 5 cm in (ln 551.601, ln 250.693).
carbondioxide will be close to (ln 551.601,
ln 250.693).
(1) 231 s (1) 231 s
(2) 208 s (2) 208 s
(3) 161 s (3) 161 s
(4) 142 s (4) 142 s
2d 2d
(2) 12 (2) 12
R R
R 2d R 2d
(3) R 1d (3) R 1d
R 1d R 1d
(4) R 2d (4) R 2d
11. Water of volume 2 L in a closed container 11. °·¤ ÕÎ Âææ ×ð´ 2 L ¥æØÌÙ ÂæÙè ·¤æð 1 kW ·¤è
is heated with a coil of 1 kW. While water ·é¤ÇUÜè âð »×ü ç·¤Øæ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ ÁÕ ÂæÙè »×ü ãæð ÚUãæ
is heated, the container loses energy at a ãñ, ÌÕ Âææ 160 J/s ·¤è ÎÚU â𠪤Áæü ·¤æ ÿæØ ·¤ÚU ÚUãæ
rate of 160 J/s. In how much time will the ãñÐ ç·¤ÌÙð â×Ø ×ð´ ÂæÙè ·¤æ ÌæÂ×æÙ 278C âð
temperature of water rise from 278C to 778C Âãé ¡ ¿ ð » æ? ( ÂæÙè ·¤è çßçàæcÅU ª¤c×æ
778C ? (Specific heat of water is 4.2 kJ/kg ãñ ¥æñÚU Âææ ·¤è çßçàæcÅU ª¤c×æ Ù»Ø ãñ)
4.2 kJ/kg and that of the container is
negligible).
(1) 8 min 20 s (1) 8 ç×ÙÅU 20 âð·´¤ÇU
(2) 6 min 2 s (2) 6 ç×ÙÅU 2 âð·´¤ÇUU
(3) 7 min (3) 7 ç×ÙÅU
(4) 14 min (4) 14 ç×ÙÅU
Po To R Po To R
(1) (1)
Po 2a Po 2a
Po To R Po To R
(2) (2)
Po 1a Po 1a
(3) Po To R ln 2 (3) Po To R ln 2
(4) P o To R (4) Po To R
13. Modern vacuum pumps can evacuate a 13. ¥æÏéçÙ·¤ çÙßæüÌ Â ·¤×ÚðU ·ð¤ ÌæÂ×æÙ (300 K) ÂÚU
vessel down to a pressure of 4.0310215 atm. 4.0310215 °ÅUU×æSȤèØÚU ÎæÕ Ì·¤ °·¤ ÕÌüÙ ·¤æð
at room temperature (300 K). Taking çÙßæüçÌÌ ·¤ÚU â·¤Ìæ ãñÐ R58.3 JK21 ×æðÜ21,
R58.3 JK21 mole21, 1 atm5105 Pa and 1 °ÅU×æSȤèØÚU5105 ÂæS·¤Ü ¥æñÚU °ßæð»ðÇþUæð â´Øæ
N Avogadro 56310 23 mole 21 , the mean 5631023 ×æðÜ21 ÜðÌð ãéØð °·¤ çÙßæüçÌÌ ÕÌüÙ ×ð´
distance between molecules of gas in an »ñ⠷𤠥æé¥æ´ð ·ð¤ Õè¿ ×æØ ÎêÚUè ·¤æ ×æ٠ֻܻ
evacuated vessel will be of the order of : §ÌÙæ ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) 0.2 mm (1) 0.2 mm
(2) 0.2 mm (2) 0.2 mm
(3) 0.2 cm (3) 0.2 cm
(4) 0.2 nm (4) 0.2 nm
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
16. The magnitude of the average electric field 16. Âëßè ·ð¤ ÂëcÆU âð ÁÚUæ ª¤ÂÚU ßæÌæßÚUæ ×ð´ âæÏæÚUæÌØæ
normally present in the atmosphere just ©ÂçSÍÌ ¥æñ â Ì çßlé Ì ÿæð æ ·¤æ ÂçÚU×ææ
above the surface of the Earth is about 150 N/C ·ð¤ ֻܻ ãñ çÁâ·¤è çÎàææ Âëßè ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý
150 N/C, directed inward towards the ·¤è ¥æðÚU ¥ÌÚU×é¹è ãñÐ Øã Âëßè mæÚUæ ßæã·¤ ÂçÚUææ×è
center of the Earth. This gives the total ÂëcÆU ¥æßðàæ Îð»æ Ñ
net surface charge carried by the Earth to [ çÎØæ ãñ e o 58.85310 212 C 2 /N-m 2 ,
be : RE56.373106 m]
[Given e o 58.85310 212 C 2 /N-m 2 ,
RE56.373106 m]
(1) 1670 kC (1) 1670 kC
(2) 2670 kC (2) 2670 kC
(3) 2680 kC (3) 2680 kC
(4) 1680 kC (4) 1680 kC
18. A d.c. main supply of e.m.f. 220 V is 18. çßléÌ ßæã·¤ ÕÜ 220 V ·¤è °·¤ çÎcÅU ÏæÚUæ ×éØ
connected across a storage battery of âÜæ§ü ·¤æð °·¤ 1 V ·¤ð¤ ÂýçÌÚUæðÏ mæÚUæ çßléÌ ßæã·¤
e.m.f. 200 V through a resistance of 1 V. ÕÜ 200 V ·¤è °·¤ â´ÖæçÚUÌ ÕñÅUÚè âð ÁæðǸæ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
The battery terminals are connected to an ÕñÅUÚUè ·ð¤ ÅUç×üÙÜ ·¤æð °·¤ Õæ±Ø ÂýçÌÚUæðÏ R âð ÁæðǸæ
external resistance R. The minimum ÁæÌæ ãñÐ R ·¤æ ØêÙÌ× ×æÙ, çÁââð ç·¤ ÕñÅUÚUè ×ð´
value of R, so that a current passes ÏæÚUæ ÂýßæçãÌ ãæð·¤ÚU ©âð ¥æßðçàæÌ ·¤ÚðU, ãñ Ñ
through the battery to charge it is :
(1) 7V (1) 7V
(2) 9V (2) 9V
(3) 11 V (3) 11 V
(4) Zero (4) àæêØ
(1) 1
(2) 2
(1) 1
(3) 3
(2) 2
(4) 4
(3) 3
(4) 4
20. Öê × Ø Úð U ¹ æ ÂÚU Âë ßè ·ð ¤ ¿é Õ·¤èØ ÿæð æ ·¤æ
×æ٠ֻܻ 431025 T ãñÐ Âëßè ·¤è çæØæ
20. The magnetic field of earth at the equator 6.43106 m ãñÐ ÌÕ Âëßè ·¤æ çmÏýéß ¥ææêæü ֻܻ
is approximately 431025 T. The radius §â ·¤æðçÅU ·¤æ ãæð»æ Ñ
of earth is 6.43106 m. Then the dipole
moment of the earth will be nearly of the (1) 1023 A m2
order of :
(2) 1020 A m2
(1) 1023 A m2
(3) 1016 A m2
(2) 1020 A m2
(4) 1010 A m2
(3) 1016 A m2
(4) 1010 A m2
153 7 153 7
(3) cm (3) cm
3 3
153 3 153 3
(4) cm (4) cm
7 7
34. At a certain temperature, only 50% HI is 34. °·¤ Ìæ çßàæðá âæØÂÚU ·ð¤ßÜ 50% HI, H2 ¥æñÚU
dissociated into H2 and I2 at equilibrium. I2 ×ð´ çßÖæçÁÌ ãæðÌæ ãñÐ âæØ çSÍÚUæ´·¤ ·¤æ ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
The equilibrium constant is :
(1) 1.0 (1) 1.0
(2) 3.0 (2) 3.0
(3) 0.5 (3) 0.5
(4) 0.25 (4) 0.25
35. Dissolving 120 g of a compound of 35. °·¤ Øæñç»·¤ (¥æéÖæÚU 60) ·¤è 120 »ýæ× ×æææ ·¤æð
(mol. wt. 60) in 1000 g of water gave a 1000 »ýæ× ÁÜ ×ð´ ææðÜÙð ÂÚU ÂýæÌ ãé° çßÜØÙ ·¤æ
solution of density 1.12 g/mL. The æÙß 1.12 »ýæ× ÂýçÌ ç×çÜ çÜÅUÚU ãñÐ çßÜØÙ ·¤è
molarity of the solution is : ×æðÜñçÚUÅUè ãæð»è Ñ
(1) 1.00 M (1) 1.00 M
(2) 2.00 M (2) 2.00 M
(3) 2.50 M (3) 2.50 M
(4) 4.00 M (4) 4.00 M
37. A current of 10.0 A flows for 2.00 h 37. ÏæÌé X ·ð¤ çÂæÜð ãé° Üßæ ÏæÚU·¤ §ÜñÅþUæðçÜçÅU·¤
through an electrolytic cell containing a âñÜ ×ð´ âð 2.00 æÅðU ·ð¤ çÜØð 10.0 A ·¤è çßléÌ
molten salt of metal X. This results in the ÏæÚUæ ¿ÜæÙð ÂÚU 0.250 ×æðÜ X ÏæÌé ·¤æ Á×æß ãé¥æÐ
decomposition of 0.250 mol of metal X at çÂæÜð ãé° Üßæ ×ð´ ÏæÌé X ·¤è ¥æâè·ë¤Ì ¥ßSÍæ
the cathode. The oxidation state of X in ãæð»è Ñ (ÁÕç·¤ F596,500 C)
the molten salt is : (F596,500 C)
(1) 11 (1) 11
(2) 21 (2) 21
(3) 31 (3) 31
(4) 41 (4) 41
39. The temperature at which oxygen 39. ÌæÂ, çÁâ ÂÚU ¥æòâèÁÙ ¥æé¥æð´ ·¤è ß»ü ×æØ×êÜ
molecules have the same root mean square SÂèÇU ·¤æ ×æÙ ßãè ãæðÌæ ãñ Áæð ãèçÜØ× ÂÚU×ææé¥æð´ ·¤æ
speed as helium atoms have at 300 K is : 300 K ÂÚU ãæðÌæ ãñ,
(Atomic masses : He54 u, O516 u) (ÂÚU×ææé ÎýÃØ×æÙ Ñ He54 ×ææ·¤, O516 ×ææ·¤)
ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) 300 K (1) 300 K
(2) 600 K (2) 600 K
(3) 1200 K (3) 1200 K
(4) 2400 K (4) 2400 K
40. The standard enthalpy of formation of 40. NH3 ÕÙÙð ·¤è ×æÙ·¤ ª¤Áæü 246.0 kJ/×æðÜ ãñÐ
NH3 is 246.0 kJ/mol. If the enthalpy of ØçÎ ¥ÂÙð ÂÚU × ææé ¥ æð ´ âð H 2 ÕÙÙð ·¤è ª¤Áæü
formation of H 2 from its atoms is 2436 kJ/×æðÜ ¥æñÚU N2 ·¤è 2712 kJ/×æðÜ ãæð Ìæð
2436 kJ/mol and that of N 2 is N2H ·¤è NH3 ×ð´ ¥æñâÌ Õæ¡ÇU ª¤Áæü ãæð»è Ñ
2712 kJ/mol, the average bond enthalpy
of N2H bond in NH3 is :
(1) 21102 kJ/mol (1) 21102 kJ/×æðÜ
(2) 2964 kJ/mol (2) 2964 kJ/×æðÜ
(3) 1352 kJ/mol (3) 1352 kJ/×æðÜ
(4) 11056 kJ/mol (4) 11056 kJ/×æðÜ
42. The gas evolved on heating CaF2 and SiO2 42. CaF2 ¥æñÚU SiO2 ·¤æð âæÎý H2SO4 ·ð¤ âæÍ »ÚU×
with concentrated H2SO4, on hydrolysis ·¤ÚUÙð âð ÂýæÌ ãé§ü »ñâ ãæ§ÇþUæÜðçââ ÂÚU °·¤ â$Èð¤Î
gives a white gelatinous precipitate. The ÁñÜ Áñâæ ¥ßÿæð ÎðÌè ãñÐ Øã ¥ßÿæð ãæð»æ Ñ
precipitate is :
(1) hydrofluosilicic acid (1) ãæ§ÇþUæðÜæðçâçÜçâ·¤ °ðçâÇU
(2) silica gel (2) çâçÜ·¤æ ÁñÜ
(3) silicic acid (3) çâçÜçâ·¤ °ðçâÇ
(4) calciumfluorosilicate (4) ·ñ¤çËàæØ×ÜæðÚUæðçâçÜ·ð¤ÅU
43. Chloro compound of Vanadium has only 43. ßñÙðçÇUØ× ·¤æ °·¤ ÜæðÚUæð Øæñç»·¤ 1.73 BM ·¤æ ·ð¤ßÜ
spin magnetic moment of 1.73 BM. This çSÂÙ ×ñ Ùð ç ÅU·¤ ×æð × ñ ÅU ÚU¹Ìæ ãñ
Vanadium chloride has the formula : (V ·¤æ ÂÚU×ææê ·ý¤×æ´·¤523) §â ßñÙðçÇUØ× ÜæðÚUæ§ÇU
(at. no. of V523) ·¤æ âêæ ãæðÌæ ãñ Ñ
(1) VCl2 (1) VCl2
(2) VCl4 (2) VCl4
(3) VCl3 (3) VCl3
(4) VCl5 (4) VCl5
45. Which of the following is not formed when 45. ¥ÜèØ K2Cr2O7 ææðÜ ·¤è H2S ·ð¤ âæÍ ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ
H 2S reacts with acidic K 2 Cr 2 O 7 ãæðÙð ÂÚU çÙÙæð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ Ùãè´ ÕÙÌæ?
solution ? (1) CrSO 4
(1) CrSO 4 (2) Cr2(SO4)
3
(2) Cr2(SO4) (3) K2SO 4
3
(3) K2SO 4 (4) S
(4) S
48. The number and type of bonds in C 222 ion 48. CaC2 ·ð C 222 ¥æØÙ ×ð´ ¥æÕÏæð´ ·¤è â´Øæ °ß´
in CaC2 are : Âý·¤æÚU çÙÙ ·¤æñÙâè ãñ?
(1) One s bond and one p2bond (1) °·¤ s ¥æÕÏ ¥æñÚU °·¤ p2¥æÕÏ
(2) One s bond and two p2bonds (2) °·¤ s ¥æÕÏ ¥æñÚU Îæð p2¥æÕÏ
(3) Two s bonds and two p2bonds (3) Îæð s ¥æÕÏ ¥æñÚU Îæð p2¥æÕÏ
(4) Two s bonds and one p2bond (4) Îæð s ¥æÕÏ ¥æñÚU °·¤ p2¥æÕÏ
49. The form of iron obtained from blast 49. Ûææð´·¤æ Ö^è âð ÂýæÌ ãé° Üæðãð ·¤æ M¤Â ·¤ãÜæÌæ ãñ Ñ
furnace is :
(1) Steel (1) §SÂæÌ (Steel)
(2) Cast Iron (2) ÉUÜßæ¡ Üæðãæ (Cast Iron)
(3) Pig Iron (3) ·¤¿æ Üæðãæ (Pig Iron)
(4) Wrought Iron (4) çÂÅUßæ´ Üæðãæ (Wrought Iron)
51. Which one of the following reactions will 51. §Ù ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ¥æð´ ×ð´ âð ç·¤â ×ð´ ·¤æÕüÙ - ·¤æÕüÙ
not result in the formation of carbon- ¥æÕÏ Ùãè´ ÂýæÌ ãæð»æ?
carbon bond ?
(1) Reimer-Tieman reaction (1) ÚUæð×ÚU - ÅUè×Ù ¥çÖç·ý¤ØæÐ
(2) Friedel Crafts acylation (2) Èý¤èÇUÜ ·ý¤æȤÅU °ðâèÜðàæÙÐ
(3) Wurtz reaction (3) ßéÅüU$Á ¥çÖç·ý¤ØæÐ
(4) Cannizzaro reaction (4) ·ñ¤Ùè$ÁñÚUæð ¥çÖç·ý¤ØæÐ
52. In the hydroboration - oxidation reaction 52. ÂýæðÂèÙ ·ð¤ ÇUæ§ÕæðÚðUÙ, H2O2 ¥æñÚU NaOH ·ð¤ âæÍ
of propene with diborane, H 2 O 2 and ãæ§ÇþUæðÕæðÚðUàæÙ-¥æòâè·¤ÚUæ ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ×ð́ ÕÙæ ·¤æÕüçÙ·¤
NaOH, the organic compound formed is : Øæñç»·¤ ãñ Ñ
(1) CH3CH2OH (1) CH3CH2OH
(2) CH3CHOHCH3 (2) CH3CHOHCH3
(3) CH3CH2CH2OH (3) CH3CH2CH2OH
(4) (CH3) COH (4) (CH3) COH
3 3
NaNO /H SO NaNO /H SO
2 2 4
→
2 2 4
→ ·¤æ ×éØ
is : ç·ý¤Øæ È¤Ü ãñ Ñ
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
56. In a nucleophilic substitution reaction : 56. ØêçÜØâ SÙðãè ¥ÎÜ ÕÎÜ ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ Ñ
DMF DMF
R2Br1Cl2 → R_Cl1Br2, R2Br1Cl2 → R_Cl1Br2,
which one of the following undergoes ×ð´ çÙÙ ÂÎæÍæðZ âð ·¤æñÙ ÃØßSÍæ ·¤æ â´ÂêUæü ÕÎÜ ·¤ÚU
complete inversion of configuration ? ÜðÌæ ãñ ?
(1) C6H5CHC6H5Br (1) C6H5CHC6H5Br
(2) C6H5CH2Br (2) C6H5CH2Br
(3) C6H5CH CH3Br (3) C6H5CH CH3Br
(4) C6H5CCH3C6H5Br (4) C6H5CCH3C6H5Br
57. In which of the following pairs A is more 57. çÙÙ Øé×æð´ ×ð´ âð ç·¤â×ð´ A, ¥çÏ·¤ SÍæ§ü ãñ B âð ?
stable than B ?
A B A B
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
• • • •
(4) Ph3C , (CH3) C (4) Ph3C , (CH3) C
3 3
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
59. Which is the major product formed when 59. ·¤æñÙ âè ÕǸè ×æææ ×ð´ ç·ý Øæ È¤Ü ÂýæÌ ãæðÌæ ãñ ÁÕ
acetone is heated with iodine and °ðâèÅUæðÙ ·¤æð ¥æØæðÇUèÙ ¥æñÚU ÂæðÅñUçàæØ× ãæ§ÇþUæâæ§ÇU
potassium hydroxide ? ·ð¤ âæÍ »ÚU× ç·¤Øæ ÁæÌæ ãñ?
(1) Iodoacetone (1) ¥æØæðÇUæð°ðâèÅUæðÙ
(2) Acetic acid (2) °âèçÅU·¤ °ðçâÇU
(3) Iodoform (3) ¥æØæðÇUæð$Ȥæ×ü
(4) Acetophenone (4) °ðâèÅUæð çȤÙæðÙ
60. Which one of the following class of 60. °çâçÅUÜèÙ ·ð¤ ÕãéÜ·¤è·¤ÚUæ âð ·¤æñÙâæ çÙÙ Âý·¤æÚU
compounds is obtained by polymerization ·¤æ Øæñç»·¤ ÂýæÌ ãæðÌæ ãñ?
of acetylene ?
(1) Poly-yne (1) ÂæòÜè-¥æ§Ù
(2) Poly-ene (2) ÂæòÜè-§üÙ
(3) Poly-ester (3) ÂæòÜè-°ðSÅUÚU
(4) Poly-amide (4) ÂæòÜè-°×æ§ÇU
62. Let w(Im w ¹ 0) be a complex number. 62. ×æÙæ w(Im w ¹ 0) °·¤ âç×æ â´Øæ ãñ, Ìæð âÖè
Then the set of all complex numbers z âç×æ â´Øæ¥æð´ z ·¤æ â×éæØ, Áæð ç·¤âè ßæSÌçß·¤
satisfying the equation w2 w z5k (12z), â´Øæ k ·ð¤ çÜ°, â×è·¤ÚUæ w2 w z5k (12z)
for some real number k, is : ·¤æð â´ÌécÅU ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ, ãñ Ñ
(1) {z : ?z?51} (1) {z : ?z?51}
(2) {z : z5 z } (2) {z : z5 z }
(3) {z : z ¹ 1} (3) {z : z ¹ 1}
(4) {z : ?z?51, z ¹ 1} (4) {z : ?z?51, z ¹ 1}
1 1 1 1
(2) a b 2 and a 2 b (2) ab 2 ÌÍæ a 2 b
65. If a, b, c are non - zero real numbers and if 65. ØçÎ a, b, c àæêØðÌÚU ßæSÌçß·¤ â´Øæ°¡ ãñ´ ÌÍæ ØçÎ
the system of equations â×è·¤ÚUæ çÙ·¤æØ
(a21)x5y1z, (a21)x5y1z,
(b21)y5z1x, (b21)y5z1x,
(c21)z5x1y, (c21)z5x1y,
has a non-trivial solution, then ·¤æ °·¤ ¥ÌéÀU ãÜ ãñ, Ìæð ab1bc1ca ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
ab1bc1ca equals :
(1) a1b1c (1) a1b1c
(2) abc (2) abc
(3) 1 (3) 1
(4) 21 (4) 21
67. The number of terms in the expansion of 67. (11x)101 (11x22x)100 ·ð¤ x ·¤è ææÌæð´ ×ð´ ÂýâæÚU
(11x)101 (11x22x)100 in powers of x is : ×ð´ ÂÎæð´ ·¤è â´Øæ ãñ Ñ
(1) 302 (1) 302
(2) 301 (2) 301
(3) 202 (3) 202
(4) 101 (4) 101
68. The sum of the digits in the units place of 68. â´Øæ¥æð´ 3, 4, 5 ÌÍæ 6 ·ð¤ ÂýØæð» âð, çÕÙæ ·¤æð§ü â´Øæ
all the 4-digit numbers formed by using the ÎæðãÚUæ°, ÕÙÙð ßæÜè âÖè ¿æÚU ¥´·¤æð´ ·¤è â´Øæ¥æð´ ·ð¤
numbers 3, 4, 5 and 6, without repetition, §·¤æ§ü ·ð¤ SÍæÙ ÂÚU ¥æÙð ßæÜð ¥´·¤æð´ ·¤æ Øæð» ãñ Ñ
is :
(1) 432 (1) 432
(2) 108 (2) 108
(3) 36 (3) 36
(4) 18 (4) 18
k k
20 terms is equal to , then k is equal to : ÂÎæð´ Ì·¤ ·¤æ Øæð» ·ð¤ ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ, Ìæð k ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
21 21
(1) 120 (1) 120
(2) 180 (2) 180
(3) 240 (3) 240
(4) 60 (4) 60
71. ( )
If f(x) is continuous and f 9 2 5 2 9 , then 71. ØçÎ f(x) âÌÌ ãñ ÌÍæ ( )
f 9 2 52 9 ãñ, Ìæð
12 cos 3x 12 cos 3x
lim f is equal to : lim f ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
x→0 x2 x→0 x2
(1) 9/2 (1) 9/2
(2) 2/9 (2) 2/9
(3) 0 (3) 0
(4) 8/9 (4) 8/9
73. If the Rolles theorem holds for the 73. ØçΠȤÜÙ f(x)52x31ax21bx ·ð¤¤ çÜ° ¥´ÌÚUæÜ
function f(x)52x31ax21bx in the interval 1
[21, 1] ×ð´çÕ´Îé c5 ÂÚU ÚUæðÜð ·¤æ Âý×ðØ Üæ»ê ãñ,
1 2
[21, 1] for the point c5 , then the value
2 Ìæð 2a1b ·¤æ ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
of 2a1b is :
(1) 1 (1) 1
(2) 21 (2) 21
(3) 2 (3) 2
(4) 22 (4) 22
3 x 4 x x x
74. If f (x )5 1 2 1 , x Î R, then the 74.
5 5
ØçÎ f (x )5 3 4
1 2 1 , x Î R ãñ,
5
Ìæð
5
equation f(x)50 has : â×è·¤ÚUæ f(x)50 ·¤æ/·ð¤ Ñ
(1) no solution (1) ·¤æð§ü ãÜ Ùãè´ ãñÐ
(2) one solution (2) °·¤ ãÜ ãñÐ
(3) two solutions (3) Îæð ãÜ ãñ´Ð
(4) more than two solutions (4) Îæð âð ¥çÏ·¤ ãÜ ãñ´Ð
1 1
(1) sin 2x1c (1) sin 2x1c
2 2
1 1
(2) 2 sin 2x1c (2) 2 sin 2x1c
2 2
1 1
(3) 2 sin x1c (3) 2 sin x1c
2 2
(4) 2sin2 x1c (4) 2sin2 x1c
1 1
2 l n (11 2 x ) 2 l n (11 2 x )
76. The integral ∫0 2
d x , equals : 76. â×æ·¤Ü ∫ d x , ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
11 4 x 0 11 4 x 2
p p
(1) ln 2 (1) ln 2
4 4
p p
(2) ln 2 (2) ln 2
8 8
p p
(3) ln 2 (3) ln 2
16 16
p p
(4) ln 2 (4) ln 2
32 32
77. Let A5{(x, y) : y2 [ 4x, y22x/24}. The 77. ×æÙæ A5{(x, y) : y2 [ 4x, y22x/24} ãñÐ
area (in square units) of the region A is : ÿæðæ A ·¤æ ÿæðæÈ¤Ü (ß»ü §·¤æ§üØæð´ ×ð´) ãñ Ñ
(1) 8 (1) 8
(2) 9 (2) 9
(3) 10 (3) 10
(4) 11 (4) 11
84. A line in the 3-dimensional space makes 84. çæçß×èØ ¥æ·¤æàæ (space) ×ð´ °·¤ ÚðU¹æ x ÌÍæ y,
p
an angle u 0 < u [ with both the ÎæðÙæ´ð ¥ÿææð´ ·ð¤ âæÍ ·¤æðæ u 0 < u [ p
ÕÙæÌè ãñ,
2
2
x and y axes. Then the set of all values of Ìæð u ·ð¤ âÖè ×æÙæð´ ·¤æ â×é¿Ø çÙÙ ¥´ÌÚUæÜ ãñ Ñ
u is the interval :
p p
(1) 0 , (1) 0 ,
4 4
p p p p
(2) 6 , 3 (2) 6 , 3
p p p p
(3) 4 , 2 (3) 4 , 2
p p p p
(4) , (4) ,
3 2 3 2
86. In a set of 2n distinct observations, each of 86. 2n çßçÖóæ Âýðÿæææð´ ·ð¤ â×é¿Ø ×ð´, ©Ù âÖè Âýðÿæææð´,
the observation below the median of all the Áæð âÖè Âýðÿæææð´ ·ð¤ ×æØ·¤ âð ·¤× ãñ´, ÂýØð·¤ ·¤æð 5 âð
observations is increased by 5 and each of Õɸæ çÎØæ »Øæ ÌÍæ àæðá âÖè Âðýÿæææð´ ×´ð ÂýØð·¤ ·¤æð 3
the remaining observations is decreased by âð ·¤× ·¤ÚU çÎØæ »Øæ, Ìæð Âýðÿæææð´ ·ð¤ Ù° â×é¿Ø ·¤æ
3. Then the mean of the new set of ×æØ Ñ
observations :
(1) increases by 1. (1) 1 âð Õɸ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
(2) decreases by 1. (2) 1 âð æÅU ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
(3) decreases by 2. (3) 2 âð æÅU ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
(4) increases by 2. (4) 2 âð Õɸ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ
87. If A and B are two events such that 87. A ÌÍæ B Îæð °ðâè æÅUÙæ°¡ ãñ´ ç·¤ P(AÈB)5P(AÇB)
P(AÈB)5P(AÇB), then the incorrect ãñ, Ìæð çÙÙ ·¤ÍÙæð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ âæ ·¤ÍÙ »ÜÌ ãñ ?
statement amongst the following
statements is : (1) A ÌÍæ B â×â´ÖæçßÌ ã´ñ
(1) A and B are equally likely (2) P(AÇB9)50
(2) P(AÇB9)50 (3) P(A9ÇB)50
(3) P(A9ÇB)50 (4) P(A)1P(B)51
(4) P(A)1P(B)51
p1q p1q
89. If cosec u5
p2q
(p¹q¹0), then 89. ØçÎ cosec u5 (p¹q¹0) ãñ , Ìæð
p2q
p u p u
cot 1 is equal to :
4 2 cot 1
4 2
ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
p p
(1) (1)
q q
q q
(2) (2)
p p
(3) pq (3) pq
(4) pq (4) pq
90. The contrapositive of the statement I go 90. ·¤ÍÙ ÒÒ×ñ´ S·ê¤Ü ÁæÌæ ã¡ê ØçÎ ßáæü Ùãè´ ãæðÌèÓÓ ·¤æ
to school if it does not rain is : ÂýçÌÏÙæ×·¤ (Contrapositive) ·¤ÍÙ ãñ Ñ
(1) If it rains, I do not go to school. (1) ØçÎ ßáæü ãæðÌè ãñ, ×ñ´ S·ê¤Ü Ùãè´ ÁæÌæÐ
(2) If I do not go to school, it rains. (2) ØçÎ ×ñ´ S·ê¤Ü Ùãè´ ÁæÌæ, ßáæü ãæðÌè ãñÐ
(3) If it rains, I go to school. (3) ØçÎ ßáæü ãæðÌè ãñ, ×ñ´ S·ê¤Ü ÁæÌæ ã¡êÐ
(4) If I go to school, it rains. (4) ØçÎ ×ñ´ S·ê¤Ü ÁæÌæ ã¡ê, ßáæü ãæðÌè ãñÐ
-o0o- -o0o-
2. The initial speed of a bullet fired from a 2. °·¤ ÚUæ§È¤Ü âð Îæ»è »§ü ÕéÜðÅU ·¤è ÂýæÚUçÖ·¤ ¿æÜ
rifle is 630 m/s. The rifle is fired at the 630 m/s ãñÐ ÜÿØ ·ð¤ SÌÚU ÂÚU ÜÿØ âð 700 m ÎêÚU
centre of a target 700 m away at the same ÜÿØ ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý ÂÚU ÚUæ§È¤Ü Îæ»è ÁæÌè ãñÐ ÜÿØ ·¤æð
level as the target. How far above the Îæ»Ùð ·ð¤ çÜØð ÚUæ§È¤Ü ·¤æ çÙàææÙæ ÜÿØ ·ð¤ ·ð¤Îý âð
centre of the target the rifle must be aimed ç·¤ÌÙæ ª¤ÂÚU Ü»æÙæ ¿æçã°?
in order to hit the target ?
(1) 1.0 m (1) 1.0 m
(2) 4.2 m (2) 4.2 m
(3) 6.1 m (3) 6.1 m
(4) 9.8 m (4) 9.8 m
(1) (23 i 14 j ) N
∧ ∧
(1) (23 i 14 j ) N
∧ ∧
3 ∧ 4 ∧ 3 ∧
(2) 2 i1 j N 4 ∧
5 5 (2) 2 i1 j N
5 5
(3) (3 i 2 4 j ) N
∧ ∧
(3) (3 i 2 4 j ) N
∧ ∧
3∧ 4 ∧ 3∧
(4) i 2 j N 4 ∧
5 5 (4) i 2 j N
5 5
2h v2
(1) 1 o
2h v2 m 2m g
(1) 1 o
m 2m g
h v2
(2) 1 o
h v2 m 2m g
(2) 1 o
m 2m g
h v2
(3) 1 o
h v2 2m mg
(3) 1 o
2m mg
h v2
(4) 1 o
h v2 2m 2m g
(4) 1 o
2m 2m g
41 GM 2
(1)
3600 R 2
41 GM 2
41 GM 2 (2)
(1) 450 R 2
3600 R 2
59 GM 2
41 GM 2 (3)
(2) 450 R 2
450 R 2
GM 2
59 GM 2 (4)
(3) 2 225 R 2
450 R
GM 2
(4)
225 R 2
9. A tank with a small hole at the bottom has 9. ÌÜè ×ð´ °·¤ ÀUæðÅðU çÀUÎý ßæÜð Åñ´U·¤ ·¤æð ÂæÙè °ß´ ç×^è ·ð¤
been filled with water and kerosene ÌðÜ (¥æÂðçÿæÌ æÙß 0.8) âð ÖÚUæ »Øæ ãñÐ ÂæÙè ·¤è
(specific gravity 0.8). The height of water ª¡¤¿æ§ü 3 m ãñ ¥æñÚU ç×^è ·ð¤ ÌðÜ ·¤è 2 mÐ ÁÕ çÀUÎý
is 3 m and that of kerosene 2 m. When the ·¤æð ¹æðÜ çÎØæ ÁæÌæ ãñ, ÌÕ çÙ·¤ÜÙð ßæÜð Îýß ·¤è
hole is opened the velocity of fluid coming ¿æÜ Ü»Ö» ãæð » è : (g510 ms 22 Üð ¥æñ Ú U
out from it is nearly : (take g510 ms22 ÂæÙè ·¤æ æÙß 5103 kg m23)
and density of water 5103 kg m23)
(1) 10.7 ms21 (1) 10.7 ms21
(2) 9.6 ms21 (2) 9.6 ms21
(3) 8.5 ms21 (3) 8.5 ms21
(4) 7.6 ms21 (4) 7.6 ms21
(1) 300 K
(2) 800 K
(3) 500 K
(4) 1000 K
(1) 300 K
(2) 800 K
(3) 500 K
(4) 1000 K
r2
r is the damping constant. If the ratio ØçÎ ¥ÙéÂæÌ 5 8% ãñ, ÌÕ ¥Ùß×çÎÌ ÎæðÜ·¤
mk
r2
·ð¤ ×é·¤æÕÜð ¥æßÌü ·¤æÜ ×ð´ ÂçÚUßÌü٠ֻܻ ãæð»æ Ñ
is 8%, the change in time period
mk
compared to the undamped oscillator is
approximately as follows :
(1) increases by 1% (1) 1%âð ßëçh ãæð»è
(2) increases by 8% (2) 8%âð ßëçh ãæð»è
(3) decreases by 1% (3) 1%âð æÅðU»æ
(4) decreases by 8% (4) 8%âð æÅðU»æ
15. Two factories are sounding their sirens 15. Îæð Èñ¤ÅUçÚUØæ¡ ¥ÂÙð âæØÚUÙ 800 Hz ÂÚU ßçÙÌ ·¤ÚUÌè
at 800 Hz. A man goes from one factory ãñ´Ð °·¤ ÃØçÌ 2 m/s ·¤è ¿æÜ âð °·¤ Èñ¤ÅUÚUè âð
to other at a speed of 2 m/s. The velocity Îê â ÚU è Èñ ¤ ÅÚè Ì·¤ ÁæÌæ ãñ Ð ßçÙ ·¤æ ßð »
of sound is 320 m/s. The number of beats 320 m/s ãñÐ °·¤ âð·´¤ÇU ×ð´ ÃØçÌ mæÚUæ âéÙè »§ü
heard by the person in one second will çßSÂÎæð´ ·¤è â´Øæ ãñ Ñ
be :
(1) 2 (1) 2
(2) 4 (2) 4
(3) 8 (3) 8
(4) 10 (4) 10
1 1
(1) EhR (1) EhR
2 2
Q2 d
(1) K
2 wl 2 eo
Q2 d
(1) K Q2 w
2 wl 2 eo (2) ( K21)
2 dl 2 eo
Q2 w
(2) ( K21) Q2 d
2 dl 2 eo (3) ( K21)
2 wl 2 eo
Q2 d
(3) ( K21) Q2 w
2 wl 2 eo (4) K
2 dl 2 eo
Q2 w
(4) K
2 dl 2 eo
Make the correspondence of these bars §Ù ÀUÇæ¸ ´ð ·ð¤ ÂÎæÍæðZ ·¤æð ÂýçÌ¿éÕ·¤èØ (D), Üæðã ¿éÕ·¤èØ
with their material being diamagnetic (D), (F) °ß´ ¥Ùé¿éÕ·¤èØ (P) ¥æÏæÚU ÂÚU â´»Ì ·¤ÚðU´ :
ferromagnetic (F) and paramagnetic (P) :
(1) A ↔ D, B ↔ P, C ↔ F (1) A ↔ D, B ↔ P, C ↔ F
(2) A ↔ F, B ↔ D, C ↔ P (2) A ↔ F, B ↔ D, C ↔ P
(3) A ↔ P, B ↔ F, C ↔ D (3) A ↔ P, B ↔ F, C ↔ D
(4) A ↔ F, B ↔ P, C ↔ D (4) A ↔ F, B ↔ P, C ↔ D
21. A coil of circular cross-section having 21. 1000 Èð¤ÚðU °ß´ 4 cm2 Ȥܷ¤ ÿæðæÈ¤Ü ßæÜè °·¤
1000 turns and 4 cm2 face area is placed ßëæèØ ¥ÙéÂýSÍ ·¤æÅU ·¤è ·é´¤ÇUÜè ·¤æð §â·ð¤ ¥ÿæ ·ð¤
with its axis parallel to a magnetic field â×æÌÚU °·¤ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÿæðæ ×ð´ ÚU¹æ »Øæ ãñ Áæð ç·¤
which decreases by 10 22 Wb m 22 in 1022 Wb m22 0.01 s ×ð´ æÅU ÁæÌæ ãñÐ ·é´¤ÇUÜè
0.01 s. The e.m.f. induced in the coil is : ×ð´ ÂýðçÚUÌ çßléÌ ßæã·¤ ÕÜ ãñ Ñ
(1) 400 mV (1) 400 mV
(2) 200 mV (2) 200 mV
(3) 4 mV (3) 4 mV
(4) 0.4 mV (4) 0.4 mV
4 4
(2) (2)
3 3
7 7
(3) (3)
1 1
49 49
(4) (4)
1 1
25. In a compound microscope the focal length 25. °·¤ â´ØéÌ âêÿ×Îàæèü ×ð´ ¥çÖÎëàØ·¤ Üðâ ·¤è Ȥæð·¤â
of objective lens is 1.2 cm and focal length ÜÕæ§ü 1.2 cm ¥æñÚU Ùðçæ·¤æ ·¤è Ȥæð·¤â ÜÕæ§ü
of eye piece is 3.0 cm. When object is kept 3.0 cm ãñ´Ð ÁÕ ßSÌé ·¤æð ¥çÖÎëàØ·¤ ·ð¤ âæ×Ùð
at 1.25 cm in front of objective, final image 1.25 cm ·¤è ÎêÚUè ÂÚU ÚU¹æ ÁæÌæ ãñ, ÌÕ ¥çÌ×
is formed at infinity. Magnifying power ÂýçÌçÕÕ ¥ÙÌ ÂÚU ÕÙÌæ ãñÐ â´ØéÌ âêÿ×Îàæèü ·¤è
of the compound microscope should be : ¥æßÏüÙ àæçÌ ãæðÙè ¿æçã° Ñ
(1) 200 (1) 200
(2) 100 (2) 100
(3) 400 (3) 400
(4) 150 (4) 150
27. A radioactive nuclei with decay constant 27. 100 ÙæçÖ·¤ ÂýçÌ âñç·¤ÇU ·¤è çSÍÚU ÎÚU âð ÿæØçSÍÚUæ¡·¤
0.5/s is being produced at a constant rate 0.5/s ßæÜð ÚðUçÇUØæðâç·ý¤Ø ÙæçÖ·¤ ©ÂÙ ãæð ÚUãð ãñ´Ð
of 100 nuclei/s. If at t50 there were no ØçÎ t50 ÂÚU °·¤ Öè Ùæç×·¤ ©ÂçSÍÌ Ùãè´ Íæ, ÌÕ
nuclei, the time when there are 50 nuclei 50 ÙæçÖ·¤ ©ÂÙ ãæðÙð ×ð´ Ü»æ â×Ø ãñ Ñ
is :
(1) 1s (1) 1s
4 4
(2) 2 ln s (2) 2 ln s
3 3
(3) ln 2 s (3) ln 2 s
4 4
(4) ln s (4) ln s
3 3
(2) 15 mA, 7.5 mA, 7.5 mA (2) 15 mA, 7.5 mA, 7.5 mA
(3) 12.5 mA, 5 mA, 7.5 mA (3) 12.5 mA, 5 mA, 7.5 mA
(4) 12.5 mA, 7.5 mA, 5 mA (4) 12.5 mA, 7.5 mA, 5 mA
Wavelength
corresponding to ǧÏøËá ǼÌcªU ¼Õ Ǽ³ÖÌÅË
II temperature associated B Microwave II ÌÄÌ¿UøË Õ»¿UÕU ÈËÕ¾Õ ÇÕ ÇºÌh± B ÇÏÏä¼ ±¿UU
with the isotropic
±Ë§¼Ë¾ Õ Ç ± ±¿UU ³Öç½á
radiation filling all space
(1) (I)-(A), (II)-(B), (III)-(B), (IV)-(C) (1) (I)-(A), (II)-(B), (III)-(B), (IV)-(C)
(2) (I)-(A), (II)-(B), (III)-(C), (IV)-(C) (2) (I)-(A), (II)-(B), (III)-(C), (IV)-(C)
(3) (I)-(D), (II)-(C), (III)-(A), (IV)-(B) (3) (I)-(D), (II)-(C), (III)-(A), (IV)-(B)
(4) (I)-(B), (II)-(A), (III)-(D), (IV)-(A) (4) (I)-(B), (II)-(A), (III)-(D), (IV)-(A)
(A)
(A)
(B)
(B)
(C)
(C)
RS
(1) Circuit A with G5 ( RS
R 2 S)
(1) G5 (
R 2 S)
·ð¤ âæÍ ÂçÚUÂÍ A
(2) Circuit B with G5S
(2) G5S ·ð¤ âæÍ ÂçÚUÂÍ B
(3) Circuit C with G5S
(3) G5S ·ð¤ âæÍ ÂçÚUÂÍ C
RS
(4) Circuit D with G5 RS
R2 S (4) G5 ·ð¤ âæÍ ÂçÚUÂÍ D
R2 S
2h 2h
(1) ( lo 2 l ) (1) ( lo 2 l )
m m
2hc 2hc
(2) ( lo 2 l ) (2) ( lo 2 l )
m m
2 h c lo 2 l 2 h c lo 2 l
(3) m l lo (3) m l lo
2h 1 1 2h 1 1
(4) 2 (4) 2
m lo l m lo l
32. The appearance of colour in solid alkali 32. ÆUæðâ ÿææÚU ÏæÌé ãðÜæ§ÇUæð´ ×ð´ Ú´U» ·ð¤ Îð¹ð ÁæÙð ·¤æ ·¤æÚUæ
metal halides is generally due to : ÂýæØÑ ãæðÌæ ãñ Ñ
(1) Schottky defect (1) àææòÅU·¤è Îæðá
(2) Frenkel defect (2) $Èýñ´¤·¤Ü Îæðá
(3) Interstitial position (3) ¥ÌÚUæÜè SÍæÙ
(4) F-centres (4) F-·ð¤Îý
(4) 18Ar ® 54Xe Noble character increases (4) 18Ar® 54Xe ©·ý¤C SßÖæß ÕɸÌæ ãñ
2
42. The correct order of bond dissociation 42. çÙÙ ÃØßSÍæ¥æð´ ×ð´ âð ç·¤â ×ð´ N2, O2, O2 ·¤è
energy among N2, O2, O2 2
is shown in ¥æÕÏ çßØæðÁÙ ª¤Áæü ·ð¤ âãè ·ý¤× ·¤æð çιæØæ »Øæ
which of the following arrangements ? ãñ ?
(1) N2 > O2
2
> O2 (1) N2 > O2
2
> O2
2 2
(2) O 2 > O 2 > N2 (2) O 2 > O2 > N2
(4) O2 > O2
2
> N2 (4) O2 > O2
2
> N2
44. Which of the following statements about 44. ¥æðÁæðÙ SÌÚU ·ð¤ æÅUÙð âÕÏè çÙÙ ·¤ÍÙæð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ
the depletion of ozone layer is correct ? âæ âãè ãñ?
(1) The problem of ozone depletion is less (1) Ïýéßè ÿæðææð´ ×ð´ ¥æð$ÁæðÙ æÅUÙð ·¤è â×SØæ ·¤×
serious at poles because NO 2 ×ãß ÚU¹Ìè ãñ Øæð´ç·¤ NO2 Á×·¤ÚU ÆUæðâ ÕÙ
solidifies and is not available for ÁæÌè ãñ ¥æñÚU ClO ×êÜ·¤æð´ ·¤æð ãÅUæÙð ·ð¤ çÜØð
consuming ClO radicals. ©ÂÜÏ Ùãè´ ãæðÌèÐ
(2) The problem of ozone depletion is (2) Ïýß é è ÿæðææð́ ×ð́ ¥æðÁ
$ æðÙ ·ð¤ æÅUÙð ·¤è â×SØæ ¥çÏ·¤
more serious at poles because ice ×ãß ÚU¹Ìè ãñ Øæð´ç·¤ Ïýéßæð´ ÂÚU ÕæÎÜæð´ ×ð´ ÕÈü¤
crystals in the clouds over poles act ·ð¤ ç·ý¤SÅUÜæð´ ·ð¤ ãæðÙð âð Cl ¥æñÚU ClO
as catalyst for photochemical ÚðUçÇU·¤Üæð´ mæÚUæ ©ÂýðçÚUÌ ¥æð$ÁæðÙ çßØæðÁÙ ·¤è
reactions involving the Âý·¤æàæ-ÚUæâæØçÙ·¤ ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ°¡ ãæð â·¤Ìè ãñÐ
decomposition of ozone by Cl and
ClO radicals.
(3) Freons, chlorofluorocarbons, are (3) çÈý¤¥æÙð´ (ÜæðÚUæðÜæðÚUæð ·¤æÕüÙ) ÚUæâæØçÙ·¤ M¤Â
inert chemically, they do not react ×ð´ ¥ç·ý¤Ø ãæðÌè ãñ´Ð ß𠪤ÂÚUè ßæØé×ÇUÜ ×ð´
with ozone in stratosphere. ©ÂçSÍÌ ¥æð$ÁæðÙ âð ç·ý¤Øæ Ùãè´ ·¤ÚUÌè´Ð
(4) Oxides of nitrogen also do not react (4) ª¤ÂÚUè ßæØé×ÇUÜ ·¤è ¥æð$ÁæðÙ âð Ùæ§ÅUþUæðÁÙ ·ð¤
with ozone in stratosphere. ¥æâæ§ÇU Öè ç·ý¤Øæ Ùãè´ ·¤ÚUÌðÐ
White precipitate of AgCl appears on ·¤æð ØæÙ ÎèçÁ°Ð çÙÙæð´ ×ð´ âð ç·¤âð ÇUæÜÙð ÂÚU AgCl
adding which of the following ? ·¤æ àßðÌ ¥ßÿæð ÕÙð»æ?
(1) NH3 (1) NH3
(2) aqueous NaCl (2) ÁÜèØ NaCl
(3) aqueous HNO3 (3) ÁÜèØ HNO3
(4) aqueous NH4Cl (4) ÁÜèØ NH4Cl
(2) [Mn(CN)5]22 Pentacyanomagnate (II) ion (2) [Mn(CN)5]22 §ÖüªUËÇ˽¾ËÕ ¼Ö ˾ժU(II) ˽¾
Potassium diammine §ËÕªÖUÌÅ˽¼
(3) K[Cr(NH3)2Cl4] (3) K[Cr(NH3)2Cl4]
tetrachlorochromate (III)
¬UËá¼Í¾ªÖUªãUËþÁËÕ¿UËÕâËÕ¼ÕªU(III)
Tetraammine aquaiodo ªÖUªãUË Õ¼Í¾ËÕþÄË˽ËÕ¬UËÕËպ˰ªU
(4) [Co(NH3)4(H2O)I]SO4 (4) [Co(NH3)4(H2O)I]SO4
cobalt (III) sulphate
(III) Ç°$$ÕªU
49. Consider the coordination compound, 49. â×ßØè Øæñç»·¤ [Co(NH3)6]Cl3 ·¤æð ØæÙ ÎèçÁ°Ð
[Co(NH3)6]Cl3. In the formation of this §â â´·¤ÚUU ·ð¤ ÕÙæÙð ×ð´ ÂýØéÌ ÂÎæÍü Áæð ËØé§â °ðçâÇU
complex, the species which acts as the (Lewis acid) ãñ, ãæð»æ Ñ
Lewis acid is :
(1) [Co(NH3)6]31 (1) [Co(NH3)6]31
(2) Cl2 (2) Cl2
(3) Co31 (3) Co31
(4) NH3 (4) NH3
50. Which one of the following does not have 50. çÙÙæð´ ×ð´ âð 緤⠷¤æ M¤Â çÂÚUæç×ÇUèØ Ùãè´ ãñ?
a pyramidal shape ?
(1) (CH3)3 N (1) (CH3)3 N
(2) (SiH3)3 N (2) (SiH3)3 N
(3) P(CH3)3 (3) P(CH3)3
(4) P(SiH3)3 (4) P(SiH3)3
A is : A ãñ Ñ
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
55. In allene (C 3 H 4 ), the type(s) of 55. C3H4 (°ÜèÙ) ×ð´ ·¤æÕüÙ ÂÚU×ææé (ÂÚU×ææé¥æð´) ·ð¤
hybridization of the carbon atoms is (are): â´·¤ÚUæ ·¤è çßçÏ ãæðÌè ãñ Ñ
(1) sp and sp3 (1) sp ¥æñÚU sp3
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
57. Tischenko reaction is a modification of : 57. çÅUâ¿ñ·¤æð ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ °·¤ ÕÎÜæ ãé¥æ M¤Â ãñ Ñ
(1) Aldol condensation (1) °ðËÇUæðÜ â´æÙÙ ·¤æ
(2) Claisen condensation (2) Üð$ÁÙ â´æÙÙ ·¤æ
(3) Cannizzaro reaction (3) ·ñ¤Ùè$ÁæÚUæð ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ·¤æ
(4) Pinacol-pinacolon reaction (4) çÂÙæ·¤æðÜ - çÂÙæ·¤æðÜæðÙ ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ·¤æ
59. Which one of the following statements is 59. çÙÙ ·¤ÍÙæð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ âæ âãè Ùãè´ ãñ?
not correct ?
(1) Alcohols are weaker acids than (1) °ðË·¤æðãæÜð´ ÂæÙè ·¤è ÌéÜÙæ ×ð´ ÎéÕüÜ ¥Ü ãñ´
water
(2) Acid strength of alcohols decreases (2) °ðË·¤æðãæÜæð´ ·¤è ¥Ü àæçÌ §â ·ý¤× ×ð´ æÅUÌè
in the following order ÁæÌè ãñ -
RCH2OH > R2CHOH > R3COH RCH2OH > R2CHOH > R3COH
(3) Carbon-oxygen bond length in (3) ×ñÍðÙæÜ, CH3OH ×ð´ ·¤æÕüÙ - ¥æâèÁÙ
methanol, CH3OH is shorter than ¥æÕÏ ·¤è ÜÕæ§ü ç$ȤÙæÜ ×ð´ C2O ¥æÕÏ
that of C2O bond length in phenol. ·¤è ÜÕæ§ü âð ÀUæðÅUè ãæðÌè ãñÐ
(4) The bond angle in methanol (4) ×ðÍðÙæÜ ×ð´ ¥æÕÏ ·¤æðæ 108.98
is 108.98 ãæðÌæ ãñÐ
60. The gas liberated by the electrolysis of 60. ÇUæ§ÂæðÅñUçàæØ× ââèÙðÅU ·ð¤ çßÜØÙ ·ð¤ ßñléÌ çßÖæÁÙ
Dipotassium succinate solution is : ×ð´ ÂýæÌ »ñâ ãæðÌè ãñ Ñ
(1) Ethane (1) §üÍðÙ
(2) Ethyne (2) §üÍæ§Ù
(3) Ethene (3) §üÍèÙ
(4) Propene (4) ÂýæðÂèÙ
1 2 3 0 0 1 1 2 3 0 0 1
A 0 2 3 5 1 0 0 A 0 2 3 5 1 0 0
ãñ, Ìæð
0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0
3 1 2 3 1 2
3 0 2 3 0 2
(1) (1)
1 0 1 1 0 1
3 2 1 3 2 1
3 2 0 3 2 0
(2) (2)
1 1 0 1 1 0
0 1 3 0 1 3
0 2 3 0 2 3
(3) (3)
1 1 1 1 1 1
1 2 3 1 2 3
0 1 1 0 1 1
(4) (4)
0 2 3 0 2 3
and B(x) = [A(x)]T A(x). Then determinant ÌÍæ B(x) = [A(x)] T A(x) ãñ , Ìæð B(x) ·¤æ
of B(x) : âæÚUçæ·¤ Ñ
(1) is a polynomial of degree 6 in x. (1) x ×ð´ ææÌ 6 ·¤æ °·¤ ÕãéÂÎ ãñÐ
(2) is a polynomial of degree 3 in x. (2) x ×ð´ ææÌ 3 ·¤æ °·¤ ÕãéÂÎ ãñÐ
(3) is a polynomial of degree 2 in x. (3) x ×ð´ ææÌ 2 ·¤æ °·¤ ÕãéÂÎ ãñÐ
(4) does not depend on x. (4) x ÂÚU çÙÖüÚU Ùãè´ ·¤ÚUÌæÐ
66. An eight digit number divisible by 9 is to 66. 0 âð 9 Ì·¤ ·ð¤ ¥´·¤æð´ ·ð¤ ÂýØæð» âð, ¥´·¤æð´ ·¤æð ÎæðãÚUæ°
be formed using digits from 0 to 9 without çÕÙæ, °·¤ 9 âð ÖæØ, ¥æÆU ¥´·¤æð´ ·¤è â´Øæ ÕÙæÙè
repeating the digits. The number of ways ãñÐ Øã çÁÌÙð ÌÚUè·¤æð´ âð ç·¤Øæ Áæ â·¤Ìæ ãñ, ßð ãñ´ Ñ
in which this can be done is :
(1) 72 (7!) (1) 72 (7!)
(2) 18 (7!) (2) 18 (7!)
(3) 40 (7!) (3) 40 (7!)
(4) 36 (7!) (4) 36 (7!)
(1000) ! (1000) !
(1) (1)
(50) ! (950) ! (50) ! (950) !
(1000) ! (1000) !
(2) (2)
(49) ! (951) ! (49) ! (951) !
(1001) ! (1001) !
(3) (3)
(51) ! (950) ! (51) ! (950) !
(1001) ! (1001) !
(4) (4)
(50) ! (951) ! (50) ! (951) !
68. In a geometric progression, if the ratio of 68. °·¤ »éææðæÚU oýðɸè ×ð´ ØçÎ ÂãÜð 5 ÂÎæð´ ·ð¤ Øæð» ·¤æ
the sum of first 5 terms to the sum of their ©Ù·ð¤ ÃØé·ý¤×æð´ ·ð¤ Øæð» âð ¥ÙéÂæ̤ 49 ãñ ÌÍæ §â·ð¤
reciprocals is 49, and the sum of the first ÂãÜð ÌÍæ ÌèâÚðU ÂÎæð´ ·¤æ Øæð»U 35 ãñ, Ìæð §â »éææðæÚU
and the third term is 35. Then the first term oýðÉ¸è ·¤æ ÂýÍ× ÂÎ ãñ Ñ
of this geometric progression is :
(1) 7 (1) 7
(2) 21 (2) 21
(3) 28 (3) 28
(4) 42 (4) 42
71. Let f(x)5x?x?, g(x) = sin x and 71. ×æÙæ f(x)5x?x?, g(x) = sin x ÌÍæ
h(x) 5(gof )(x). Then h(x) 5(gof ) (x) ãñ, Ìæð
(1) h(x) is not differentiable at x50. (1) h(x), x50 ÂÚU ¥ß·¤ÜÙèØ Ùãè´ ãñÐ
(2) h(x) is differentiable at x50, but (2) h(x), x50 ÂÚU ¥ß·¤ÜÙèØ ãñ ÂÚUÌé h(x),
h(x) is not continuous at x50. x50 ÂÚU âÌÌ Ùãè´ ãñÐ
(3) h(x) is continuous at x50 but it is (3) h(x), x50 ÂÚU âÌÌ ãñ, ÂÚUÌé Øã x50 ÂÚU
not differentiable at x50. ¥ß·¤ÜÙèØ Ùãè´ ãñÐ
(4) h(x) is differentiable at x50. (4) h(x), x50 ÂÚU ¥ß·¤ÜÙèØ ãñÐ
(2) p (2) p
2 2
(3) p (3) p
4 4
(4) p (4) p
6 6
73. Two ships A and B are sailing straight 73. Îæð Áãæ$Á A ÌÍæ B, °·¤ çÙçà¿Ì çÕ´Îé O âð ÎêÚU âèÏð
away from a fixed point O along routes ×æ»æðZ ÂÚU §â Âý·¤æÚU Áæ ÚUãð ãñ´ ç·¤ ÐAOB âÎæ 1208
such that ÐAOB is always 1208. At a ÚU ã Ìæ ãñ Ð ç·¤âè ÿææ, OA = 8 ç·¤×è ÌÍæ
certain instance, OA = 8 km, OB = 6 km OB = 6 ç·¤×è ãñ ÌÍæ Áãæ$Á A, 20 ç·¤×è/æ´ÅUæ ·¤è
and the ship A is sailing at the rate of ¿æÜ âð ¿Ü ÚUãæ ãñ ÁÕç·¤ Áãæ$Á B, 30 ç·¤×è/æ´ÅUæ
20 km/hr while the ship B sailing at the ·¤è ¿æÜ âð ¿Ü ÚUãæ ãñ, Ìæð A ÌÍæ B ·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤è ÎêÚUè
rate of 30 km/hr. Then the distance çÁâ ÎÚU (ç·¤×è/æ´ÅUæ ×ð´) âð ÕÎÜ ÚUãè ãñ, ßã ãñ Ñ
between A and B is changing at the rate
(in km/hr) :
(1) 260 37
(1) 260 37
(2) 260 37
(2) 260 37
(3) 80 37
(3) 80 37
(4) 80 37
(4) 80 37
2 2
21 1 2 x
75. The integral ∫ x cos dx (x > 0) 75. â×æ·¤Ü ∫ x cos21 1 2 x 2 dx , (x > 0) ÕÚUæÕÚU
1 1 x2 11x
is equal to : ãñ Ñ
(1) 2 x1(11x2) tan21 x1c (1) 2 x1(11x2) tan21 x1c
(2) x2 (11x2) cot21 x1c (2) x2 (11x2) cot21 x1c
(3) 2 x1(11x2) cot21 x1c (3) 2 x1(11x2) cot21 x1c
(4) x2 (11x2) tan21 x1c (4) x2 (11x2) tan21 x1c
e e
n
76. If for n/1, Pn 5 ∫ (log x ) d x , then 76. ØçÎ n/1 ·ð¤ çÜ°, Pn 5 ∫ (log x )n d x ãñ, Ìæð
1 1
P10290P8 is equal to : P10290P8 ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
(1) 29 (1) 29
(2) 10e (2) 10e
(3) 29e (3) 29e
(4) 10 (4) 10
78. A stair-case of length l rests against a 78. Ü´Õæ§ü l ·¤è °·¤ âèÉ¸è °·¤ ©ßæüÏÚU ÎèßæÚU ÌÍæ ·¤×ÚðU
vertical wall and a floor of a room,. Let P ·ð¤ Ȥàæü ·ð¤ âæÍ ¹Ç¸è ãñÐ ×æÙæ §â âèɸè ÂÚU °·¤
be a point on the stair-case, nearer to its çÕ´Îé P, Áæð §â·ð¤ ÎèßæÚU ·ð¤ âæÍ Ü»Ùð ßæÜð çâÚðU ·ð¤
end on the wall, that divides its length in çÙ·¤ÅU ãñ, §â Âý·¤æÚU ãñ ç·¤ Øã âèÉ¸è ·¤è Ü´Õæ§ü ·¤æð
the ratio 1 : 2. If the stair-case begins to 1 : 2 ·ð¤ ¥ÙéÂæÌ ×ð´ Õæ´ÅUÌæ ãñÐ ØçÎ âèɸè Ȥàæü ÂÚU
slide on the floor, then the locus of P is : âÚU·¤Ùð Ü»Ìè ãñ, Ìæð P ·¤æ çÕ´Îé ÂÍ ãñ Ñ
1 1
(1) an ellipse of eccentricity (1) ©·ð´¤ÎýÌæ ßæÜæ °·¤ ÎèæüßëÌÐ
2 2
3 3
(2) an ellipse of eccentricity (2) ©·ð´¤ÎýÌæ ßæÜæ °·¤ ÎèæüßëÌ
2 2
l l
(3) a circle of radius
2
(3) çæØæ 2
ßæÜæ °·¤ ßëÌÐ
3 3
(4) a circle of radius
2
l (4) çæØæ l ßæÜæ °·¤ ßëÌÐ
2
2 3 2 3
(1) (1)
15 15
4 3 4 3
(2) (2)
15 15
4 3 4 3
(3) (3)
5 5
2 3 2 3
(4) (4)
5 5
80. The set of all real values of l for which 80. l ·ð¤ âÖè ßæSÌçß·¤ ×æÙæð´ ·¤æ â×é¿Ø, çÁÙ·ð¤ çÜ°
exactly two common tangents can be ßëææð´ x21y224x24y1650 ÌÍæ
drawn to the circles x 2 1y 2 210x210y1l50 ÂÚU ÆUè·¤ Îæð
x21y224x24y1650 and ©ÖØçÙcÆU SÂàæüÚðU¹æ°¡ ¹è´¿è Áæ â·¤Ìè ãæð´, ·¤æ Áæð
x21y2210x210y1l50 is the interval : ¥´ÌÚUæÜ ãñ, ßã ãñ Ñ
(1) (12, 32)
(1) (12, 32)
(2) (18, 42)
(2) (18, 42)
(3) (12, 24)
(3) (12, 24)
(4) (18, 48)
(4) (18, 48)
11 11
(2) 2 (2) 2
3 3
13 13
(3) (3)
2 2
13 13
(4) 2 (4) 2
2 2
87. If X has a binomial distribution, B(n, p) 87. ØçÎ X ·¤æ °ð â æ çmÂÎ Õ´ Å UÙ, B(n, p) ãñ ,
with parameters n and p such that Áãæ¡ n, p §â·ð¤ Âýæ¿Ü ãñ´, ¥æñÚU P(X52)5P(X53)
P(X52)5P(X53), then E(X), the mean of ãñ, Ìæð ¿ÚU X ·¤æ ×æØ E(X) ãñ Ñ
variable X, is :
(1) 22p (1) 22p
(2) 32p (2) 32p
p p
(3) 2 (3) 2
p p
(4) 3 (4) 3
(2) 2 (2) 2
11 11
(3) (3)
2 2
46 46
(4) (4)
5 5
89. The angle of elevation of the top of a 89. â×ÌÜ Öêç× ÂÚU °·¤ çÕ´Îé P âð °·¤ ª¤ßæüÏÚU ×èÙæÚU
vertical tower from a point P on the ·ð¤ çàæ¹ÚU ·¤æ ©ÙØÙ ·¤æðæ a ÂæØæ »ØæÐ P âð ×èÙæÚU
horizontal ground was observed to be a. ·ð¤ ÂæÎ ·¤è ¥æðÚU 2 ×è. ÁæÙð ÂÚU, ©ÙØÙ ·¤æðæ ÕÎÜ
After moving a distance 2 metres from P ·¤ÚU b ãæð ÁæÌæ ãñ, Ìæð (×è.×ð´) ×èÙæÚU ·¤è ª¡¤¿æ§ü ãñ Ñ
towards the foot of the tower, the angle of
elevation changes to b. Then the height (in
metres) of the tower is :
-o0o- -o0o-
e2 e2
(2) (me5 mass of electron) (2) (me5§ÜðÅþUæòÙ ·¤æ ÎýÃØ×æÙ)
2peo Gm e 2 2peo Gm e 2
mo e o G mo eo G
(3) (3)
c2 h e2 c2 h e2
2 p mo eo h 2 p mo eo h
(4) (4)
ce 2 G ce 2 G
2. A person climbs up a stalled escalator 2. °·¤ ÃØçæ °·¤ SÍæçÂÌ °S·¤ÜðÅUÚU ·¤è ÎêÚUè 60 s ×ð´
in 60 s . If standing on the same but ¿É¸Ìæ ãñÐ ØçÎ ©â ÂÚU ¹Ç¸ð ãæð·¤ÚU ÂÚUÌé çSÍÚU ßð» âð
escalator running with constant velocity °S·¤ÜðÅUÚU ·ð¤ ¿ÜÙð ÂÚU ßã 40 s ÜðÌæ ãñÐ ÃØçæ
he takes 40 s. How much time is taken by »çÌàæèÜ °S·¤ÜðÅUÚU ÂÚU ¿Ü·¤ÚU §âè ÎêÚUè ·¤æð ÌØ
the person to walk up the moving ·¤ÚUÙð ×ð´ ç·¤ÌÙæ â×Ø Üð»æ?
escalator ?
(1) 37 s (1) 37 s
(2) 27 s (2) 27 s
(3) 24 s (3) 24 s
(4) 45 s (4) 45 s
(1) (
u ∧ ∧
i 1 3j )
(1)
u ∧
i1( ∧
3j ) 12
12
(2) (
u ∧
i 2 3j
∧
)
(2)
u ∧
i2( ∧
3j ) 12
12
(3) (
u ∧
2i 1 3j
∧
)
(3)
u ∧
(
2i 1 3j
∧
) 12
12
(4) (
u ∧
2i 2 3j
∧
)
(4)
u ∧
12
(
2i 2 3j
∧
) 12
6. A particle is moving in a circular path of 6. °·¤ ·¤æ çæØæ a ·ð¤ °·¤ ßëæèØ ÂÍ ÂÚU °·¤ çSÍÚU
radius a, with a constant velocity v as ßð» v âð »çÌàæèÜ ãñ Áñâæ ç·¤ ç¿æ ×ð´ ÎàææüØæ »Øæ ãñÐ
shown in the figure. The center of circle is ßëæ ·¤æ ·ð¤Îý C âð ç¿çãÌ ç·¤Øæ »Øæ ãñÐ ×êÜ çÕÎé
marked by C. The angular momentum O âð ·¤æðæèØ â´ßð» §â Âý·¤æÚU çܹæ Áæ â·¤Ìæ ãñ Ñ
from the origin O can be written as :
Two hypothetical planets of masses m1 and ÎýÃØ×æÙ m1 °ß´ m2 ·ð¤ Îæð ÂçÚU·¤çËÂÌ ©Â»ýã çßææ×
m 2 are at rest when they are infinite ¥ßSÍæ ×ð´ ãñ´ ÁÕ ßð °·¤ ÎêâÚðU âð ¥æÌ ÎêÚUè ÂÚU ãñ´Ð
distance apart. Because of the gravitational »éL¤ßæ·¤áüæ ÕÜ ·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ ©Ù·ð¤ ·ð¤Îýæð´ ·¤æð ç×ÜæÙð
force they move towards each other along ßæÜè ÚðU¹æ ÂÚU °·¤ ÎêâÚðU ·¤è ¥æðÚU »çÌ ·¤ÚUÙæ ÂýæÚUÖ
the line joining their centres. What is their ·¤ÚUÌð ãñ´Ð ÁÕ ©æ·ð¤ Õè¿ ÎêÚUè d ãñ, ÌÕ ©Ù·¤è ¿æÜ
speed when their separation is d ? Øæ ãñ?
(Speed of m1 is v1 and that of m2 is v2) ( m1 ·¤è ¿æÜ v1 °ß´ m2 ·¤è ¿æÜ v2 ãñ )
(1) v 15v 2 (1) v 15v 2
2G 2G
(2) v1 5 m 2 (2) v1 5 m 2
d(m 11m 2 ) d(m 11m 2 )
2G 2G
v2 5 m 1 v2 5 m 1
d(m 11m 2 ) d(m 11m 2 )
2G 2G
(3) v1 5 m 1 (3) v1 5 m 1
d(m 11m 2 ) d(m 11m 2 )
2G 2G
v2 5 m 2 v2 5 m 2
d(m 11m 2 ) d(m 11m 2 )
2G 2G
(4) v1 5 m 2 (4) v1 5 m 2
m1 m1
2G 2G
v2 5 m 1 v2 5 m 1
m2 m2
2A h 2A h
(2) (2)
pa 2 g pa 2 g
2 2A h 2 2A h
(3) 2 g (3) 2 g
pa pa
A h A h
(4) 2 g (4) 2 g
2 pa 2 pa
11. Hot water cools from 608C to 508C in the 11. »×ü ÂæÙè 608C âð 508C ÂãÜð 10 ç×ÙÅU ×ð´ Æ´UÇUæ ãæðÌæ
first 10 minutes and to 428C in the next ãñ ¥æñÚU 428C Ì·¤ ÎêâÚðU 10 ç×ÙÅU ×ð´ Æ´UÇUæ ãæðÌæ ãñÐ
10 minutes. The temperature of the ßæÌæßÚUæ ·¤æ ÌæÂ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
surroundings is :
(1) 258C (1) 258C
(2) 108C (2) 108C
(3) 158C (3) 158C
(4) 208C (4) 208C
12. A Carnot engine absorbs 1000 J of heat 12. °·¤ ·¤æÙæðü §´ÁÙ °·¤ ·é´¤ÇU âð 1278C ÂÚU 1000 J
energy from a reservoir at 1278C and rejects ª¤c×èØ ª¤Áæü ¥ßàææðçáÌ ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ ¥æñÚU ÂýØð·¤ ¿·ý¤
600 J of heat energy during each cycle. The ×ð´ 600 J ª¤c×èØ ª¤Áæü ¥Sßè·¤æÚU ·¤ÚU ÎðÌæ ãñÐ §´ÁÙ
efficiency of engine and temperature of ·¤è ÎÿæÌæ ¥æñÚU çâ´·¤ ·¤æ ÌæÂ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
sink will be :
(1) 20% and 2438C (1) 20% °ß´ 2438C
(2) 40% and 2338C (2) 40% °ß´ 2338C
(3) 50% and 2208C (3) 50% °ß´ 2208C
(4) 70% and 2108C (4) 70% °ß´ 2108C
14. Which of the following expressions 14. çÙÙçÜç¹Ì ÃØ´Á·¤æð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ âæ °·¤ âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ
corresponds to simple harmonic motion ÂÚU âÚUÜ ¥æßÌü »çÌ ·ð¤ â´»Ì ãñ, Áãæ¡ x çßSÍæÂÙ ãñ
along a straight line, where x is the ¥æñÚU a, b, c ÏÙæ×·¤ çSÍÚUæ´·¤ ãñ ?
displacement and a, b, c are positive
constants ?
(1) a1bx2cx 2 (1) a1bx2cx 2
(2) bx2 (2) bx2
(3) a2bx1cx 2 (3) a2bx1cx 2
(4) 2bx (4) 2bx
15. A source of sound A emitting waves of 15. ¥æßëçæ 1800 Hz ·¤è Ì´ÚU»ð´ ©âçÁüÌ ·¤ÚU ÚUãæ ßçÙ
frequency 1800 Hz is falling towards dæðÌ A °·¤ âè×æÌ ßð» v âð ÏÚUÌè ·¤è ¥æðÚU ç»ÚU ÚUãæ
ground with a terminal speed v. The ãñÐ dæðÌ ·ð¤ ÆUè·¤ Ùè¿ð ÏÚUÌè ÂÚU °·¤ Âýðÿæ·¤ B
observer B on the ground directly beneath ¥æßëçæ 2150 Hz ·¤è ÌÚ´U»ð´ Âýææ ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñÐ dæðÌ A,
the source receives waves of frequency ÏÚUÌè âð ÂÚUæßçÌüÌ Ü»Ö» §â ¥æßëçæ ·¤è ÌÚ´U»ð´ Âýææ
2150 Hz. The source A receives waves, ·¤ÚðU»æ Ñ ( ßçÙ ·¤è ¿æÜ 5343 m/s)
reflected from ground, of frequency
nearly : (Speed of sound 5343 m/s)
(1) 2150 Hz (1) 2150 Hz
(2) 2500 Hz (2) 2500 Hz
(3) 1800 Hz (3) 1800 Hz
(4) 2400 Hz (4) 2400 Hz
ld ld
(3) C5 Co (3) C5 Co
l n (1 1 ld/K o ) l n (1 1 ld/K o )
l l
(4) C5 Co (4) C5 Co
d. l n (1 1 K o /ld) d. l n (1 1 K o /ld)
How much is the current I in the circuit in SÍæØè ¥ßSÍæ ×ð´ ÂçÚUÂÍ ×ð´ ÏæÚUæ I ·¤æ ×æÙ Øæ ãñ?
steady state ?
(1) 1.6 A (1) 1.6 A
(2) 0.67 A (2) 0.67 A
(3) 2.5 A (3) 2.5 A
(4) 0.25 A (4) 0.25 A
19. A positive charge q of mass m is moving 19. ÎýÃØ×æÙ m ·¤æ °·¤ ÏÙæ×·¤ ¥æßðàæ q, 1x ¥ÿæ
along the 1x axis. We wish to apply a ÂÚU »çÌàæèÜ ãñÐ ã× °·¤ °·¤â×æÙ ¿éÕ·¤èØ ÿæðæ B
uniform magnetic field B for time Dt so that â×Ø Dt ·ð¤ çÜ° Ü»æÙæ ¿æãÌð ãñ´ çÁââð ç·¤ ¥æßðàæ
the charge reverses its direction crossing ·¤è çÎàææ d ÎêÚUè ÂÚU y - ¥ÿæ ·¤æð ·¤æÅUÌð ãé° ÂýçÌÜæðç×Ì
the y axis at a distance d. Then : ãæð Áæ°, ÌÕ Ñ
mv pd mv pd
(1) 5 DQGDW5 (1) 5 Ä D W5
qd v qd v
mv pd mv pd
(2) 5 DQG D W5 (2) 5 Ä D W5
2 qd 2v 2 qd 2v
2 mv pd 2 mv pd
(3) 5 DQG D W5 (3) 5 Ä D W5
qd 2v qd 2v
2 mv pd 2 mv pd
(4) 5 DQG D W5 (4) 5 Ä D W5
qd v qd v
(1) (1)
(2) (2)
(3) (3)
(4) (4)
2 nl
(1) l5
2 nl 321
(1) l5
321 (2n21)l
(2) l5
(2n21)l 2 ( 3 2 1)
(2) l5
2 ( 3 2 1)
(2n21)l 3
(3) l5
(2n21)l 3 4 ( 22 3 )
(3) l5
4 ( 22 3 )
(2n21)l
(4) l5
(2n21)l 3 21
(4) l5
3 21
25. °·¤Ü çSÜÅU çßßÌüÙ ç¿æ ·ð¤ ÂýØæð» ×ð´, ÜæÜ Âý·¤æàæ
25. In an experiment of single slit diffraction ·¤æ ÂýÍ× ØêÙÌ× °·¤ ÎêâÚUè ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ·ð¤ ÂýÍ× ×ãæ×
pattern, first minimum for red light â´ÂæÌè ãñÐ ØçÎ ÜæÜ Âý·¤æàæ ·¤è ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü 6600 Å
coincides with first maximum of some ãñ, ÌÕ ÂýÍ× ×ãæ× ·ð¤ â´»Ì ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ãæð»è Ñ
other wavelength. If wavelength of red
light is 6600 Å , then wavelength of first
maximum will be : (1) 3300 Å
(1) 3300 Å (2) 4400 Å
(2) 4400 Å (3) 5500 Å
(3) 5500 Å (4) 6600 Å
(4) 6600 Å
27. A piece of bone of an animal from a ruin 27. °·¤ ¹ÇUãÚU âð Âýææ °·¤ Âàæé ·¤è ãaè ·ð¤ ÅéU·¤Ç¸ð ·¤è
is found to have 14 C activity of 14C âç·ý¤ØÌæ §â·ð¤ ·¤æÕüÙ ¥´àæ ·¤è ÂýçÌ »ýæ× ÂýçÌ
12 disintegrations per minute per gm of ç×ÙÅU 12 çßæÅUÙ ãñÐ °·¤ çæÎæ Âàæé ·¤è 14C âç·ý¤ØÌæ
its carbon content. The 14C activity of a 16 çßæÅUÙ ÂýçÌ ç×ÙÅU ÂýçÌ »ýæ× ãñ Рֻܻ ç·¤ÌÙð
living animal is 16 disintegrations per ßáü ÂãÜð Âàæé ·¤è ×ëØé ãé§ü? (çÎØæ ãñ 14C ·¤è ¥hü
minute per gm. How long ago nearly did ¥æØé t1/255760 ßáü)
the animal die ? (Given half life of
14Cis t1/255760 years)
(1) 1672 years (1) 1672 ßáü
(2) 2391 years (2) 2391 ßáü
(3) 3291 years (3) 3291 ßáü
(4) 4453 years (4) 4453 ßáü
30. In the experiment of calibration of 30. °·¤ ßæðËÅU×æÂè ·ð¤ ¥´àæàææðÏÙ ·ð¤ ÂýØæð» ×ð´, 1.1 ßæðËÅU
voltmeter, a standard cell of e.m.f. 1.1 volt çßléÌßæã·¤ ÕÜ ·ð¤ °·¤ ×æÙ·¤ âñÜ ·ð¤ â´ÌéçÜÌ
is balanced against 440 cm of 440 cm ·¤æ çßÖß×æÂè ÌæÚU ÂæØæ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ °·¤
potentiometer wire. The potential ÂýçÌÚUæðÏ ·ð¤ çâÚUæð´ ÂÚU çßÖßæÌÚU ÌæÚU ·ð¤ 220 cm ·ð¤
difference across the ends of resistance is â´ÌéçÜÌ ÂæØæ ÁæÌæ ãñÐ ßæðËÅU×æÂè ·¤æ â´»Ì ÂÆUÙ
found to balance against 220 cm of the 0.5 ßæðËÅU ãñÐ ßæðËÅU×æÂè ·ð¤ ÂÆUÙ ×ð´ æéçÅU ãæð»è Ñ
wire. The corresponding reading of
voltmeter is 0.5 volt. The error in the
reading of voltmeter will be :
(1) 20.15 volt (1) 20.15 ßæðËÅU
(2) 0.15 volt (2) 0.15 ßæðËÅU
(3) 0.5 volt (3) 0.5 ßæðËÅU
(4) 20.05 volt (4) 20.05 ßæðËÅU
1 e2 1 e2
(1) (1)
2 r 2 r
e2 e2
(2) 2 (2) 2
r r
me 2 me 2
(3) (3)
r r
1 e2 1 e2
(4) 2 (4) 2
2 r 2 r
32. The de-Broglie wavelength of a particle of 32. ÎýÃØ×æÙ 6.63 g ·ð¤ ·¤æ ·¤æ ¥æßð» 100 ms21 âð
mass 6.63 g moving with a velocity of »çÌ×æÙ ãæðÙð ÂÚU Îè-ÕýæÜè ÌÚ´U»ÎñØü ãæð»è Ñ
100 ms21 is :
(1) 10233 m (1) 10233 m
(2) 10235 m (2) 10235 m
(3) 10231 m (3) 10231 m
(4) 10225 m (4) 10225 m
33. What happens when an inert gas is added 33. âæØ ÚU¹Ùð ßæÜð ¥æØÌÙ ·¤æð ¥ÂçÚUßçÌüÌ ÚU¹Ùð ßæÜè
to an equilibrium keeping volume çSÍçÌ ×ð´ °·¤ ¥ç·ý¤Ø »ñâ ÇæÜÙð ÂÚU Øæ ãæð»æ?
unchanged ? (1) ¥çÏ·¤ ç·ý¤Øæ È¤Ü Âýææ ãæð»æÐ
(1) More product will form (2) ·¤× ç·ý¤Øæ È¤Ü Âýææ ãæð»æÐ
(2) Less product will form (3) ¥çÏ·¤ ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ ãæð»èÐ
(3) More reactant will form (4) âæØ ¥ÂçÚUßçÌüÌ ÚUãð»æÐ
(4) Equilibrium will remain unchanged
37. The entropy (S o ) of the following 37. çÙÙ ÂÎæÍæðZ ·ð¤ °ðÅþUæÂè ×æÙ ãñ (So) ãñ´ Ñ
substances are : CH4 (g) 186.2 J K21 ×æðÜ21
CH4 (g) 186.2 J K21 mol21 O 2 (g) 205.0 J K21 ×æðÜ21
O2 (g) 205.0 J K21 mol21 CO 2 (g) 213.6 J K21 ×æðÜ21
CO 2 (g) 213.6 J K21 mol21 H2O (l) 69.9 J K21 ×æðÜ21
H2O (l) 69.9 J K21 mol21 ¥çÖç·ý¤Øæ
The entropy change (DSo) for the reaction CH 4 (g)12O 2 (g) ® CO 2 (g)12H 2 O(l)
CH4(g)12O2(g) ® CO2(g)12H2O(l) is : ·ð¤ çÜØð °ðÅþUæÂè ÂçÚUßÌüÙ (DSo) ·¤æ ×æÙ ãæð»æ Ñ
(1) 2312.5 J K21 mol21 (1) 2312.5 J K21 ×æðÜ21
(2) 2242.8 J K21 mol21 (2) 2242.8 J K21 ×æðÜ21
(3) 2108.1 J K21 mol21 (3) 2108.1 J K21 ×æðÜ21
(4) 237.6 J K21 mol21 (4) 237.6 J K21 ×æðÜ21
(3) N2
2 (3) N2
2
(4) HN2
3 (4) HN2
3
39. In a monoclinic unit cell, the relation of 39. °·¤ ×æðÙæðçÜçÙ·¤ °·¤·¤ âñÜ ×ð´ Âÿææ𴠷𤠷¤æðÙæ çÕÎé¥æð´
sides and angles are respectively : âð âÕÏ ·ý¤×æÙéâæÚU ãæðÌð ã´ñ Ñ
(1) a5b ¹ c and a5b5g5908 (1) a5b ¹ c ¥æñÚU a5b5g5908
(2) a ¹ b ¹ c and a5b5g5908 (2) a ¹ b ¹ c ¥æñÚU a5b5g5908
(3) a ¹ b ¹ c and b5g5908 ¹ a (3) a ¹ b ¹ c ¥æñÚU b5g5908 ¹ a
(4) a ¹ b ¹ c and a ¹ b ¹ g ¹ 908 (4) a ¹ b ¹ c ¥æñÚU a ¹ b ¹ g ¹ 908
40. The standard enthalpy of formation 40. ×èÍðÙ, CH4,ÕÙÙð ·¤è ×æÙ·¤ °ðÍñËÂè (DfHo298)
(D f H o 298 ) for methane, CH 4 is 274.9 kJ ×æðÜ21 ãæðÌè ãñÐ §ââð C2H ¥æÕÏ
274.9 kJ mol21. In order to calculate the ·¤è ×Ø×æÙ ª¤Áæü ·¤æ ¥æ·¤ÜÙ ·¤ÚUÙð ·ð¤ çÜØð çÙÙæð´
average energy given out in the formation âð 緤⠰·¤ ·¤æð ÁæÙÙæ ¥æßàØ·¤ ãæð»æ?
of a C2H bond from this it is necessary to
know which one of the following ?
(1) the dissociation energy of the (1) H2 ¥æé ·¤è çßØæðÁÙ ª¤ÁæüÐ
hydrogen molecule, H2.
(2) the first four ionisation energies of (2) ·¤æÕüÙ ·¤è ÂãÜè ¿æÚU ¥æØÙÙ ª¤Áæü°¡Ð
carbon.
(3) the dissociation energy of H2 and (3) H2 ·¤è çßØæðÁÙ ª¤Áæü ¥æñÚU ·¤æÕüÙ (»ýð$Ȥæ§Å)U
enthalpy of sublimation of carbon ·¤è ª¤ßüÂæÌÙ ª¤ÁæüÐ
(graphite).
(4) the first four ionisation energies of (4) ·¤æÕüÙ ·¤è ÂýÍ× ¿æÚU ¥æØÙÙ ª¤Áæü°¡ ¥æñÚ
carbon and electron affinity of ãæ§ÇþUæðÁÙ ·¤è §ÜñÅþUæòÙ ÕÏéÌæÐ
hydrogen.
43. Which one of the following exhibits the 43. çÙÙæð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ °·¤ ¥çÏ·¤Ì× â´Øæ ×ð´ ¥æòâè·¤ÚUæ
largest number of oxidation states ? ¥ßSÍæ°¡ çιæÌæ ãñ?
(1) Ti (22) (1) Ti (22)
(2) V(23) (2) V(23)
(3) Cr (24) (3) Cr (24)
(4) Mn (25) (4) Mn (25)
45. Among the following species the one 45. çÙÙ ÂÎæÍæðZ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ °·¤ çÜ»ñÇU M¤Â ×ð´ ¥çÏ·¤Ì×
which causes the highest CFSE, Do as a CFSE, Do ·¤æ ·¤æÚUæ ÕÙÌæ ãñ?
ligand is :
(1) CN2 (1) CN2
(2) NH3 (2) NH3
(3) F2 (3) F2
(4) CO (4) CO
46. Similarity in chemical properties of the 46. ¥æßÌü âæÚUæè ·ð¤ ç·¤âè »ýé ×ð´ Ìß ·ð¤ ÂÚU×ææé¥æð´ ·ð¤
atoms of elements in a group of the ÚUæâæØçÙ·¤ »éææð´ ×ð´ ¥çÏ·¤Ì× â×æÙÌæ ·ð¤ ·¤æÚUæ ãæðÌð
Periodic table is most closely related to : ãñ´ Ñ
(1) atomic numbers (1) ÂÚU×ææé·¤ ÙÕÚU
(2) atomic masses (2) ÂÚU×ææé·¤ ÎýÃØ×æÙ
(3) number of principal energy levels (3) ÕǸð (Principal) ª¤Áæü SÌÚUæð´ ·¤è â´Øæ
(4) number of valence electrons (4) ßñÜðâè §ÜñÅþUæòÙæð´ ·¤è â´Øæ
48. Global warming is due to increase of : 48. â´âæçÚU·¤ ©ææÂÙ ·¤æ ·¤æÚUæ ãæðÌæ ãñ ßæØé×ÇUÜ ×ð´
ÕɸÙæ Ñ
(1) methane and nitrous oxide in (1) ×èÍðÙ ¥æñÚU Ùæ§ÅþUâ ¥æòâæ§ÇU ·¤æÐ
atmosphere
(2) methane and CO2 in atmosphere (2) ×èÍðÙ ¥æñÚU CO2 ·¤æÐ
(3) methane and O3 in atmosphere (3) ×èÍðÙ ¥æñÚU O3 ·¤æÐ
(4) methane and CO in atmosphere (4) ×èÍðÙ ¥æñÚU CO ·¤æÐ
49. Hydrogen peroxide acts both as an 49. ãæ§ÇþUæðÁÙ ÂÚU¥æòâæ§ÇU ¥Â¿æØ·¤ ÌÍæ ©Â¿æØ·¤ ÎæðÙæð´
oxidising and as a reducing agent Âý·¤æÚU âð ÃØßãæÚU ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ ¥æñÚU Øã çÙÖüÚU ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ
depending upon the nature of the reacting ¥çæç·ý¤Øæ ·¤ÚUÙð ßæÜð SÂèàæè$Á ·ð¤ SßæÖæß ÂÚUÐ çÙÙ
species. In which of the following cases ×ð́ âð ç·¤â·ð¤ âæÍ H2O2 ¥ÜèØ ×æØ× ×ð́ ¥Â¿æØ·¤
H 2 O 2 acts as a reducing agent in acid ·ð¤ M¤Â ×ð´ ç·ý¤Øæ ·¤ÚUÌæ ãñ?
medium ?
(1) MnO42 (1) MnO42
22 22
(2) Cr2 O 7 (2) Cr2 O 7
22 22
(3) SO 3 (3) SO 3
(4) KI (4) KI
51. on mercuration-
51. ×ÚUØêÚðUàæÙ-¥×ÚUØêÚðUàæÙ ÂÚ
demercuration produces the major
U âð Âýææ ×éØ ç·ý¤ØæȤÜ
product :
ãæðÌæ ãñ Ñ
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
55. The major product obtained in the photo 55. 2- ×ðçÍÜØéÅðUÙ ·ð¤ Âý·¤æàæ mæÚUæ ©ÂýðçÚUÌ Õýæð×èÙðàæÙ ×ð´
catalysed bromination of 2-methylbutane ÕǸæ ç·ý¤ØæÈ¤Ü ãæðÌæ ãñ Ñ
is :
(1) 1-bromo-2-methylbutane (1) 1-Õýæð×æð-2-×ðçÍÜØéÅðUÙ
(2) 1-bromo-3-methylbutane (2) 1-Õýæð×æð-3-×ðçÍÜØéÅðUÙ
(3) 2-bromo-3-methylbutane (3) 2-Õýæð×æð-3-×ðçÍËæØéÅðUÙ
(4) 2-bromo-2-methylbutane (4) 2-Õýæð×æð-2-×ðçÍÜØéÅðUÙ
57. Which one of the following acids does not 57. çÙÙ ¥Üæð´ ×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ Âý·¤æàæèØ â×æßØßÌæ Ùãè´
exhibit optical isomerism ? çιæÌæ?
(1) Lactic acid (1) ÜñçÅU·¤ °ðçâÇU
(2) Tartaric acid (2) ÅUæÚUÅñUçÚU·¤ °çâÇU
(3) Maleic acid (3) ×ñÜè·¤ °çâÇU
(4) a-amino acids (4) a- °×æØÙæð´ °ðçâÇU
58. Aminoglycosides are usually used as : 58. ¥×æØÙæðÜ槷¤æðâæ§ÇUæð´ ·¤æð ÂýæØÑ çÙÙ ç·¤â Âý·¤æÚU
ÂýØæð» ç·¤Øæ ÁæÌæ ãñ?
(1) antibiotic (1) °ðÅUè ÕæØæðçÅU·¤ M¤Â ×ð´ (ÂýçÌ Áñçß·¤)
(2) analgesic (2) °ðÙÜÁñçâ·¤ M¤Â ×ð´ (ÂèǸæ Ùæàæ·¤)
(3) hypnotic (3) çãÂÙæçÅU·¤ M¤Â ×ð´ (çÙÎýæ ÂýÎ)
(4) antifertility (4) °ðÅUè ȤÚUçÅUçÜÅUè M¤Â ×ð´ (°ðÅUè çÙáð¿·¤)
59. Which of the following will not show 59. §Ù×ð´ âð ·¤æñÙ ØêÅUæÚUæðÅðUàæÙ Ùãè´ çιæØð»æ?
mutarotation ?
(1) Maltose (1) ×æËÅUæð$Á
(2) Lactose (2) ÜñÅUæð$Á
(3) Glucose (3) Üê·¤æð$Á
(4) Sucrose (4) âê·ý¤æð$Á
62. Let z ¹ 2i be any complex number such 62. ×æÙæ z ¹ 2i ·¤æð§ü °ðâè âç×æ â´Øæ ãñ ç·¤
z2 i z2 i
that
z1 i
is a purely imaginary number.
z1 i
°·¤ àæé h ·¤æËÂçÙ·¤ â´ Øæ ãñ , Ìæð
1 1
Then z1
z
is : z1
z
ãñ Ñ
(1) 0 (1) 0
(2) any non-zero real number other (2) 1 ·ð¤ ¥çÌçÚUæ ·¤æð§ü àæêØðæÚU ßæSÌçß·¤ â´ØæÐ
than 1.
(3) any non-zero real number. (3) ·¤æð§ü àæêØðæÚU ßæSÌçß·¤ â´ØæÐ
(4) a purely imaginary number. (4) °·¤ àæéh ·¤æËÂçÙ·¤ â´ØæÐ
63. The sum of the roots of the equation, 63. â×è·¤ÚU æ x21?2x23?2450, ·ð ¤ ×ê Ü æð ´ ·¤æ
x21?2x23?2450, is : Øæð»È¤Ü ãñ Ñ
(1) 2 (1) 2
(2) 22 (2) 22
(3) 2 (3) 2
(4) 2 2 (4) 2 2
y y
1 2 x 1 2 x
65. If A 5 and B 5 x be such 65. ØçÎ A5 ÌÍæ B 5 x °ðâð ãñ´ ç·¤
3 21 2
1 3 21 2 1
6 6
that AB 5 , then : AB 5 , ãñ, Ìæð Ñ
8 8
(1) y52x (1) y52x
(2) y522x (2) y522x
(3) y5x (3) y5x
(4) y52x (4) y52x
66. 8 - digit numbers are formed using the 66. ¥´·¤æð´ 1, 1, 2, 2, 2, 3, 4, 4 ·ð¤ ÂýØæð» âð, ¥æÆU ¥´·¤èØ
digits 1, 1, 2, 2, 2, 3, 4, 4. The number of â´Øæ°¡ ÕÙæ§ü »§ü ãñд °ðâè â´Øæ¥æð´ ·¤è â´Øæ çÁÙ×ð´
such numbers in which the odd digits do çßá× ¥´·¤ çßá× SÍæÙæð´ ÂÚU Ù ¥æØð,´ ãñ Ñ
not occupy odd places, is :
(1) 160 (1) 160
(2) 120 (2) 120
(3) 60 (3) 60
(4) 48 (4) 48
68. Let G be the geometric mean of two 68. ×æÙæ Îæð ÏÙ â´Øæ¥æð´ a ÌÍæ b ·¤æ »éææðæÚU ×æØ G ãñ
positive numbers a and b, and M be the 1 ÌÍæ 1
ÌÍæ ·¤æ â×æÌÚU ×æØ M ãñÐ ØçÎ
1 1 a b
arithmetic mean of 1 and . If : G is
a b M 1
: G 5 4 : 5 ãñ, Ìæð a : b ãæð â·¤Ìð ãñ´ Ñ
4 : 5, then a : b can be : M
(1) 1:4 (1) 1 : 4
(2) 1:2 (2) 1:2
(3) 2:3 (3) 2:3
(4) 3:4 (4) 3:4
69. The least positive integer n such that 69. ÏÙ ÂêææZ·¤ n ·¤æ ßã ØêÙÌ× ×æÙ çÁâ·ð¤ çÜØð
2 2 2 1 2 2 2 1
12 2 22........ 2 n21 < , is : 12 2 2 2........ 2 n21 < , ãñ, ãñ Ñ
3 3 3 100 3 3 3 100
(1) 4 (1) 4
(2) 5 (2) 5
(3) 6 (3) 6
(4) 7 (4) 7
sin 3 x sin 3 x
(3) 1c (3) 1c
( 1 1 cos3 x ) ( 1 1 cos3 x )
cos 3 x cos 3 x
(4) 2 1c (4) 2 1c
3 ( 1 1 sin 3 x ) 3 ( 1 1 sin 3 x )
76. If for a continuous function f(x), 76. ØçÎ °·¤ âÌÌ È¤ÜÙ f(x) ·ð¤ çÜ°, âÖè
t t /2p ·ð¤ çÜ°
2 2
∫ ( f ( x ) 1 x)d x 5 p 2 t , for all t
2 2
2p
∫ ( f ( x ) 1 x)d x 5 p 2 t ãñ , Ìæð
2p
p
t/2p, then f 2 is equal to :
3 p
f 2
3
ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
(1) p
(1) p p
(2)
p 2
(2)
2 p
(3)
p 3
(3)
3 p
(4)
p 6
(4)
6
79. If the three distinct lines x12ay1a50, 79. ØçÎ ÌèÙ çßçÖóæ Úð U ¹æ°¡ x12ay1a50,
x13by1b50 and x14ay1a50 are x13by1b50 ÌÍæ x14ay1a50 â´»æ×è ã´ñ,
concurrent, then the point (a, b) lies on a : Ìæð çÕ´Îé (a, b) °·¤ Ñ
(1) circle (1) ßëæ ÂÚU çSÍÌ ãñ
(2) hyperbola (2) ¥çÌ ÂÚUßÜØ ÂÚU çSÍÌ ãñ
(3) straight line (3) âÚUÜ ÚðU¹æ ÂÚU çSÍÌ ãñ
(4) parabola (4) ÂÚUßÜØ ÂÚU çSÍÌ ãñ
81. Two tangents are drawn from a point 81. °·¤ çÕ´Îé (22, 21) âð °·¤ ß·ý¤ y254x ÂÚU Îæð
(22, 21) to the curve, y254x. If a is the SÂàæü ÚðU¹æ°¡ ¹è´¿è »§ü ãñ, ØçÎ ©Ù·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤æ ·¤æðæ a
angle between them, then ?tan a? is equal ãñ, Ìæð ?tan a? ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
to :
1 1
(1) (1)
3 3
1 1
(2) (2)
3 3
(3) 3 (3) 3
(4) 3 (4) 3
82. The minimum area of a triangle formed
x2 y2
by any tangent to the ellipse 82. Îèæüßëæ 1 51 ÂÚU ¹è´¿è »§ü ç·¤âè SÂàæü
16 81
x2 y2 ÚðU¹æ ÌÍæ çÙÎðüàææ´·¤ ¥ÿææð´ mæÚUæ ÕÙè çæÖéÁ ·¤æ ØêÙÌ×
1 5 1 and the co-ordinate axes
16 81 ÿæðæÈ¤Ü ãñ Ñ
is :
(1) 12 (1) 12
(2) 18 (2) 18
(3) 26 (3) 26
(4) 36 (4) 36
84. If the distance between planes, 84. ØçÎ â×ÌÜæð ´ 4x22y24z1150 ÌÍæ
4x22y24z1150 and 4x22y24z1d50 ·ð¤ Õè¿ ·¤è ÎêÚUè 7, Ìæð d ãñ Ñ
4x22y24z1d50 is 7, then d is :
(1) 41 or 242 (1) 41 ¥Íßæ 242
(2) 42 or 243 (2) 42 ¥Íßæ 243
(3) 241 or 43 (3) 241 ¥Íßæ 43
(4) 242 or 44 (4) 242 ¥Íßæ 44
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
85. If x , y and z are three unit vectors in 85. ØçÎ çæ-çß×èØ ¥æ·¤æàæ ×ð´ x, y ÌÍæ z ÌèÙ ×ææ·¤
three-dimensional space, then the ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧
âçÎàæ ãñ´, Ìæð ?x 1 y?2 1 ?y 1 z?2 1 ?z 1 x?2
minimum value of
∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ∧ ·¤æ ØêÙÌ× ×æÙ ãñ Ñ
?x 1 y?2 1 ?y 1 z?2 1 ?z 1 x?2 is :
3 3
(1) (1)
2 2
(2) 3 (2) 3
(3) 3 3 (3) 3 3
(4) 6 (4) 6
87. A number x is chosen at random from the 87. â×éæØ {1, 2, 3, 4, ....., 100} ×ð´ âð °·¤ â´Øæ x
set {1, 2, 3, 4, ....., 100}. Define the ØæÎëÀUØæ ¿éÙè »§üÐ æÅUÙæ A ·¤æð ÂçÚUÖæçáÌ ·¤èçÁ° Ñ
event : A5 the chosen number x satisfies A5 ¿éÙè »§ü â´Øæ x
21 p 2 9p2 21 p 2 9p2
0 [ sin x2 [ . 0 [ sin x2 [ .
4 16 4 16
(1) Both statements I and II are true. (1) ·¤ÍÙ I ÌÍæ II ÎæðÙæð´ âØ ãñ´Ð
(2) Both statements I and II are false. (2) ·¤ÍÙ I ÌÍæ II ÎæðÙæð´ ¥âØ ãñ´Ð
(3) Statement I is true and (3) ·¤ÍÙ I âØ ãñ ÌÍæ ·¤ÍÙ II ¥âØ ãñÐ
statement II is false.
(4) Statement I is false and (4) ·¤ÍÙ I ¥SæØ ãñ, ÌÍæ ·¤ÍÙ II âØ ãñÐ
statement II is true.
1 cos u 1 1 cos u 1
89. If f (u) 5 2sin u 1 2cos u and 89. ØçÎ f (u) 5 2sin u 1 2cos u ãñ,
21 sin u 1 21 sin u 1
A and B are respectively the maximum and ÌÍæ A ÌÍæ B ·ý¤×àæÑ f (u) ·ð¤ ¥çÏ·¤Ì× ÌÍæ
the minimum values of f (u), then ØêÙÌ× ×æÙ ãñ´, Ìæð (A, B) ÕÚUæÕÚU ãñ Ñ
(A, B) is equal to :
(1) (3, 21)
(2) (4, 22 2 ) (1) (3, 21)
(4) ( 21 2 , 21 )
(3) ( 21 2, 22 2)
(4) ( 21 2 , 21 )
-o0o- -o0o-
1. 1 4 2 3 2 3 2 1
2. 3 4 2 4 3 3 3 1
3. 2 4 3 1 2 1 4 4
4. 1 1 3 3 3 2 2 4
5. 3 3 1 3 3 2 4 3
6. 3 1 1 2 4 4 1 2
7. 4 4 4 3 3 1 2 *
8. 1 1 4 4 3 1 3 3
9. 3 2 1 2 3 2 2 1
10. 1 2 1 1 1 1 2 4
11. 3 1 3 2 1 2 2 3
12. 4 4 3 1 1 3 2 1
13. 1 3 2 3 2 2 1 4
14. 4 3 3 1 1 1 4 3
15. 3 2 2 1 1 4 2 2
16. 3 4 1 4 3 2 2 1
17. 1 1 3 2 4 3 3 4
18. 3 4 3 1 3 3 2 3
19. 2 1 3 4 4 1 3 2
20. 3 3 4 1 1 2 2 2
21. 3 3 3 1 3 1 2 1
22. 3 1 3 1 4 3 2 3
23. 2 2 3 4 4 4 1 3
24. 2 2 2 1 2 4 3 3
25. 4 4 2 4 4 1 2 3
26. 2 4 4 3 4 3 2 2
27. 3 1 4 1 2 2 2 3
28. 1 4 4 3 1 3 4 1
29. 4 3 3 2 2 2 2 2
30. 2 1 4 1 1 4 4 2
31. 1 1 4 1 4 3 4 4
32. 2 2 4 4 1 4 1 2
33. 3 2 4 1 3 4 4 2
34. 2 1 2 4 4 4 2 3
35. 1 3 4 2 2 2 2 2
36. 1 2 2 4 3 4 3 4
37. 3 3 4 4 3 2 2 2
38. 1 2 3 1 3 1 2 1
ANSWER KEY PAPER - 1 JEE (MAIN) - 2014
39. 2 4 2 2 4 2 3 3
40. 4 2 4 2 3 1 3 4
41. 3 1 1 2 2 3 4 3
42. 2 1 4 4 3 3 3 2
43. 2 3 2 3 2 4 4 2
44. 1 3 2 4 3 2 2 3
45. 4 2 4 4 1 4 4 2
46. 2 1 3 3 2 2 4 2
47. 2 1 1 4 2 3 1 1
48. 1 1 3 1 2 2 2 4
49. 4 4 4 4 3 3 1 4
50. 2 4 3 1 1 2 3 4
51. 2 1 1 3 4 4 1 4
52. 4 1 1 2 3 3 2 4
53. 4 1 3 4 2 1 3 2
54. 3 4 2 4 1 3 1 3
55. 1 4 4 3 2 2 4 2
56. 1 1 2 4 2 3 4 3
57. 4 4 4 3 4 3 3 4
58. 1 2 4 1 2 3 1 4
59. 1 3 3 1 3 3 4 3
60. 3 1 1 3 2 3 4 2
61. 2 4 2 3 4 3 2 4
62. 4 2 2 4 4 1 3 2
63. 3 1 2 4 2 2 3 1
64. 2 2 2 3 1 1 3 2
65. 1 2 2 1 2 4 1 4
66. 4 1 3 3 1 4 2 2
67. 2 1 4 2 3 4 2 2
68. 1 4 3 4 2 3 1 2
69. 2 2 3 4 3 2 3 4
70. 2 1 4 4 1 4 2 4
71. 2 3 2 1 2 3 3 2
72. 2 4 2 4 4 3 2 4
73. 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 3
74. 4 3 4 3 2 3 2 2
75. 2 4 1 2 2 1 4 4
76. 3 3 1 4 3 3 1 1
ANSWER KEY PAPER - 1 JEE (MAIN) - 2014
77. 3 2 1 4 2 4 4 3
78. 4 2 3 2 3 2 2 4
79. 1 3 3 2 3 2 3 2
80. 1 2 3 2 4 2 4 1
81. 2 1 4 3 4 3 4 1
82. 3 4 3 3 1 4 4 1
83. 3 4 3 3 3 3 2 2
84. 3 3 1 1 3 2 3 3
85. 2 4 2 3 3 4 2 3
86. 1 1 4 4 1 2 2 1
87. 4 2 2 3 4 2 1 2
88. 2 2 2 1 3 2 4 3
89. 2 2 3 3 2 1 3 3
90. 3 2 1 2 2 3 2 3